Home
        PDW-1500 Manual
         Contents
1.                                                                                                                a   i      I      amp        I  Page   Num      i       lille Hs Weel le  7 Ja I  n     je 2 Inset Home  lup      Lock  Tab   Q IW IE IR IT WY JU   O   P     Enter Page   7 8 9  oI           PN Delete    End naan Home  4   PgUp  Caps Lock   S  p  F Js H JJ NK IIL      4 51          P   gt   Shift      Z   X   C IV IB  N IM   lt        J  Shift   1 2  3  A       End         PgDn  cui Alt Alt Gr Cui 0      5   i 4   gt  Ins Del  English  United States       Q      I  I   amp  d   Page   Num             Ji J2 js   4 Jis Je Iiz j E l       _ inser Home  lug   Lock  Tab   Q IW  E R T Y U l O P     Page 7 8 9   gt              Delete Eid Down Home    4 j PgUp  Caps Lock P S  D  F  e H  J  K WL Il  I    Enter 4 5 l6         lt       gt   Shift Z X C V B N M     gt    Shift 4 1 2 3  a   i   ga End J     J PgDn Ets  Ctrl Alt Al Ctrl 0        4   gt  Ins Del  French  France   ORBARA  i m Nr U a   aa r num  Tab CES y ze Js 2m Suppr   Fin F A ie 2  EEIEIEE EL Aa        gt   Shift  gt  IW IX IC        2m 4 1 2 3      lt     e JEJU En   IF T  Ctrl Alt Alt Gr Ctr 0    a 4 UE Inser Suppr  German  Germany   5 1 T 8   oc  amp            2      Bild Num    x      JH ll ellela Jis lle E diE dalle sla le il Eintg Post j 4   o  Tab   Q  W IE R T Z U l O P V   Enter Bild 7 8   gt  al           U     ae Entf Ende 4    Posi    4    Bild     9   S D F   G H J K l    IIA s 4 5 6       gt   Shi
2.                                                                                         5      I   amp          Page   Num            i Ja Ja l    s le   lis 2 IF   ea   Insert  Home   up   Lock  Tab   Q IW IE R T Y U l O P           Enter Deletel  End Page 7 8 9   gt I     e     l1  4 eee End   Down   Home    j PgUp  Caps Lock  A  S  P JF GH lv IK IL lic 8 4  s 61     Qj             gt   Shift      Z X C V B N M   i   Shift 4 1 2 3    I lt          t End j       PgDn ER  Ctrl Alt Alt Gr Ctrl 0          Y   Ins Del  Polish  Programmers   Poland       Q   9o     amp      Page   Num      E        i  de i l   is le I7 le E n z     baad Insert  Home  p     Lock  Tab   Q IW IIE R T Y U l O P     Page 7 8 9  rete Jw JE Je  p    e  t Je JF TEI Jel ene ee  ansa Bu  uA  S D  F  6  W  j WK pt IE  T  me 4 Js Ife      i  P  gt   Shift Z X C V B N M     gt    Shift t 1 2 3  A   f   Les End     PgDn      Ctrl Alt Al Ctrl 0          Y t Ins Del  Russian  Russia     d       INS   96       amp     HT Page   Num              El Ile Jia lla lis je Jl lls E n   Jj nt   ser Home  pi    Lock  Tab   Q IW HE IR IT HY IU l O  IP     Enter Delete   End    Page 7  8 19   gt   n yl kl ell HL ril uj ul SLE xU el  lt   eee End   Down   Home  4 j PgUp    Capslok A  S  D   F IG MH IJ K  L   g um 4 I5 I6  oll b  Bil all noll Pil oj A al xl e allia    gt   Shift      Iz IK Cc  V  B JIN JIM   lt  I   I  7  shit 4 1 l    3     all uL ciL MI nll TIL bib  sf ol   End      j PgDn ER  Ctrl Alt Alt Gr Ctrl 0        
3.                              emm    leo     s O a    E   8885  oos   So Cj                         132  5 1   4                       210  8 3 9  in mm  inches     Mass 6 5 kg  14 Ib  5 oz    Power requirements  100 V to 240 V AC  50 60 Hz  12 V DC  Power consumption  AC operation  80 W  DC operation  65 W   Power saving mode  55 W   Peak inrush current   1  Power ON  current probe method   45 A  240 V   18 A  100 V    2  Hot switching inrush current   measured in accordance with  European standard EN55103 1  11 A   230 V   Operating temperature  5  C to 40  C  41  F to 104  F   Storage temperature     20  C to  60  C   4  F to  140  F   Operating relative humidity  25 to 90     System    Recording playback format  Video MPEG HD 422  50 Mbps  Proxy video MPEG 4    Audio  Proxy audio    24 bits  48 KHz  8 channels  A law 8 bits  8 kHz  8 channels    Recording playback times  PFD23A discs Approx  43 minutes  PFD50DLA discs   Approx  95 minutes    The recording and playback times listed above are  approximate  Maximum recording times may vary  depending on recording conditions     Search speed  Jog mode      to  1 times normal speed  Variable speed mode     2 to  2 times normal speed     20 to  20 times normal speed or  maximum speed  as selected by an  extended menu setting  1   Fast forward mode   35 times normal speed or maximum  speed  as selected by an extended  menu setting  p  Fast reverse mode     35 times normal speed or maximum  speed  as selected by an extended  menu 
4.                 Item number   Item name Settings  329 F1600 Select methods for setting the edit presets of the digital audio channels  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET CH5 to CH8 of this unit  Make these settings when using an editor  REPLACE FOR CH5  PVE 500  BVE 600  etc   or remote control unit without a function to  control digital audio edit presets   330 AN AUDIO EDIT PRESET The edit presets of the digital audio channels of this unit are turned on  REPLACE FOR CH6 and off according to the specified analog audio presets of the editor or  remote control unit   331 F1600 nodef  no definition   No definition  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET ch 1  analog ch1   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 1   REPLACE FOR CH7 ch 2  analog ch2   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 2   332  E1600  ee  analog ch1 ch2   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 1 or  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET    REPLACE FOR CH8  344 ASSEMBLE AUTO EDIT Set whether to record 2 seconds of postroll when an additional clip is  POSTROLL RECORDING recorded by sending the AUTO EDIT command  9 pin protocol 20 42   from a nonlinear editing system connected to the REMOTE 9P   connector on the rear panel   Linear editing systems follow the settings made on the linear editing  systems   off  Do not record postroll   on  Records approximately 2 seconds of postroll   Menu items in the 400s  relating to preroll  Item number   Item name Settings  401 FUNCTION MODE AFTER CUE UP   Select the state that the unit goes into after a cu
5.                The Extended UMID is metadata that provides additional  information such as location  time date  company ID and    so on   The UMID is applied as follows        Material No     Source Pack    Instance No     ID generated when  shooting  Same as the above    Shooting  information  when   where and who              Same as the above                Original material  00 00 00  Copied material  generation number  1 byte     random number  2 bytes     t    Distinguish between the  original material and copied  material    Using the Extended UMID   You have to enter a country code  organization code and  user code  Set the country code referring to the table in ISO  3166  and set the organization code and user code  according to the guidelines of your organization     For details  see  Setting UMID ownership information    page 177      Using UMID Data    t    Material source ID   detecting material    t    Metadata pack that  identifies the source of  material unit by defining the  when  where and who of  the material unit with which  it is associated     Functions of UMID data   UMID data enables the following    e Addition of a globally unique ID to every clip of audio   visual material  The unique ID is used to detect the  material source and to link it with the original source  material    e Distinguishing between original material and copied  material  00 is added to the Instance Number for original  material     Recording with UTC time  UTC  coordinated univer
6.               ere reeeeeneenes 188  MPEG 4 visual patent portfolio license                          eeeeee 188  MPEG   video patent portfolio license                           eee 188  About IJG  Independent JPEG Group                        e 188  Character display software  1T ype  inicie etus 188  About netsimpd 4 6 xe chiedi e bid pad ae te db Seas 188  About lDUDHD uerbo aet aU tte tt eni EDS  191  GIOSSALY                                      192   ilr eu                                                     P 194    Overview       Marks for Model Specific  Functions    In this manual  functions that are supported only by the  PDW F1600 or only by the PDW HD1500 are indicated  by the following marks    F1600   PDW F1600   HD1500  PDW HD1500                         Chapter       Features    The PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 is a professional disc  recorder supporting full HD  1920 x 1080 and 1280 x 720   playback and recording with Professional Disc U media   When you use this unit in combination with a nonlinear  editing system  the FAM 2 function enables data file  transfers between the unit and computers over the  i LINK     interface  allowing the unit to be used like an  external hard drive  The unit can be used as a player for  video editing and program output  and as a recorder for  nonlinear editing    For these applications  it can be connected to Sony  nonlinear editors  monitors  and video equipment with  HDSDI interfaces via its standard HDSDI I O connectors   It has
7.             Cek     Professional Discs    LYS  PDW 700 EN                   PFD23A    PFD50DLA              a  0 zke e eese  t     HKDV 900 video control unit 9                HDSDI       DIGITAL  AUDIO  AES EBU   OUT IN                         ANALOG  AUDIO          SDSDI il    OUTPUT                                                                 VIDEO INPUT  CONTROL   RM 280 editing   controller REMOTE             B    ou s O     OOS    Ste C  E    ome mre C  p    REMOTE  9P           REMOTE  9P                            DC IN 12V   N AC IN                             BVE 700 ANALOG AUDIO INPUT    wn     2c oe m RR m um   C  PHONES    a Hegh  A DIGITAL    ANALOG    AUDIO AUDIO  Microph  ISIOPnone  AES EBU     OUTPUT   OUT IN INPUT  Headphones    REMOTE   9P  9                                     E 3D ogo   mami  ooog oO OO O    HDW 2000 series                                              t   9 oo  OF    E e020  iO     ru   eEBBHc e                      PDW F75    a  If an HKDV 900 is connected  be sure to check that the  version of the HKDV 900 is 2 00 or higher   b  For HDW 2000 series only                  HDSDI  OUTPUT    AUDIO  MONITOR           i LINK  S400    SDSDI  OUTPUT                   600                                  OUTPUT INPUT EE          PDW 1500    Sony BP L80S GL95  battery         BKP L551 battery    adaptor    DC power source  AC power source    COMPOSITE  OUTPUT                               SD video monitor                            HEHA        
8.            File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create  Delete  P  MXF 2  Audio clip files  MXF files  generated   Yes Yes D      No9    No       No  when you execute voice over editing  on the PDW HR1     0001 to 0099  Other files Files other than the above     No     No                       a  The    P     part can be handled like a file with a user defined name    b  Only files which are 2 seconds or longer in length and which can be written  by XDCAM    c  Overwriting is not possible    d  Multiple files cannot be opened at the same time    e  Only when sub item NAMING FORM of setup menu item 036 is set to   free      Edit directory    f  Selection and deletion of any specified clip is possible     Directories cannot be created in the Component directory                                         File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create   Delete  E E01 SMI 9 Clip list file Yes Yes P Yes   Yes    Yes     0001 to 0099  1 08 Overview                         File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create   Delete  E MO1 XML 9 Metadata file generated automatically   Yes Yes P No9 No   No 9   when E E01 SMI file is created      0001 to 0099  Other files Files other than the above     No     No                          a  The    E     part can be changed to a user defined name    b  Only files which can be written by XDCAM  Partial writing is not  pos
9.         C0002 MXF       C0002M01 XML             uu pu  ug pug ii    C0002M02 KLV          Q    omponent       P0001 MXF 9       Ili                m  2          E0001E01 SMI          E0001M01 XML          E0002E01 SMI          E0002M01 XML    uu pug pug  ug                  C    b             C0001S01 MXF          C0002S01 MXF          J My  ug          C0003S01 MXF          UserData             General        a    TN        Continued           a  Root directory   b  Only when sub item NAMING FORM of setup menu item 036 is set to   free    c  Files generated when voice over editing is executed on the PDW HRI            Continued         PROAV  B ALIAS XML             J ALIAS BUP     E CLPR    M  CMPTR          J         DISCINFO XML          DISCINFO BUP          pug   ug  i    DISCMETA XML       1 EDTR    INDEX XML          ug  ug       INDEX BUP                    M USERDATA                File operation restrictions    This section explains which operations are possible on   files stored in each directory    When required  the following operation tables distinguish   reading and writing from partial reading and writing    Read  Read data sequentially from the start to the end of  the file    Partial read  Read only a part of the data in the file     Root directory    Write  Write data sequentially from the start to the end of  the file   Partial write  Write data to a part of the file only     Operations other than Read and Partial read are possible  only when the Write I
10.       E    TC 00 24 46 22    F    TC 00 24 24 29 TC 00 24 34 27  00 13 48 24  m    Scene Selection       To display the total duration after addition of the  selected clip  Press the SHIFT button     4 In the Scene Selection window  move the I cursor to  the location where you want to insert the clip   The  existing thumbnails arrange themselves to the left and  right of the I cursor      D Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The selected clip is inserted as a sub clip and a          mark appears on the thumbnail in the Scene Selection  window     To check the addition results  Move the cursor     6 Press the RESET RETURN button     This returns you to the Clip thumbnail screen   7 Repeat steps 1 to 6 as required to add more clips     8 save the clip list  see page 92      In step 1  you can hold down the SHIFT button when you  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob  This is a shortcut that  displays the Add Sub Clip screen immediately  You can  also save the clip list immediately in step 5 by executing  the Save Clip List command in the Disc Menu     Adding sub clips from the clip list thumbnail  screen    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Display the Thumbnail Menu     2 Select Add Sub Clips  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Clip List  Add  screen appears     Clip List  Add     p    TC 00 24 24 29    002  lt  017 035               TC 01 01 28 25 TC 00 09 43 14  E  ft    TC 00 30 40 13        a  TC 00 24 34 27 TC 00 24 46 22 TC 
11.       NO USER SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE     REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL        This symbol is intended to alert the user to  the presence of uninsulated    dangerous  voltage    within the product   s enclosure that  may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute  a risk of electric shock to persons     This symbol is intended to alert the user to  the presence of important operating and  maintenance  servicing  instructions in the  literature accompanying the appliance     WARNING  THIS WARNING IS APPLICABLE FOR USA  ONLY     If used in USA  use the UL LISTED power cord specified  below   DO NOT USE ANY OTHER POWER CORD     Plug Cap Parallel blade with ground pin   NEMA 5 15P Configuration   Cord Type SJT  three 16 or 18 AWG wires  Length Minimum 1 5 m  4 ft  11 in    Less than  2 5 m  8 ft  3 in    Rating Minimum 10 A  125 V    Using this unit at a voltage other than 120 V may require the  use of a different line cord or attachment plug  or both  To  reduce the risk of fire or electric shock  refer servicing to  qualified service personnel     WARNING  THIS WARNING IS APPLICABLE FOR OTHER   COUNTRIES    1  Use the approved Power Cord  3 core mains lead    Appliance Connector Plug with earthing contacts that  conforms to the safety regulations of each country if  applicable    2  Use the Power Cord  3 core mains lead  Appliance  Connector Plug conforming to the proper ratings  Voltage   Ampere      If you have questions on the use of the above Power Cord   Ap
12.       This button is disabled unless either the basic operation  display or the video monitor display is displayed        SHIFT button  Switches between functions for any button with two  functions     O PAGE HOME button   When pressed alone functions as the PAGE switching   button  When pressed together with the SHIFT button    functions as the HOME button    PAGE button  Displays the function menu  if it is not  already visible   The most recently displayed page of  the function menu appears     HOME button  When pressed with the function menu  visible  returns to the HOME page of the function  menu       EXPAND button   When pressed during thumbnail display  divides the  selected clip into 12 blocks and displays a list of  thumbnails of the first frame in each block  expand  function   The division is repeated with each press  up to 3  times  for a total of 1 728 blocks     When this button is pressed together with the SHIFT  button  the unit returns to the previous division level   Press the RESET RETURN button to return to the  thumbnail screen    This button also becomes a function button  F6  when the  function menu is visible     See page 77 for more information about the expand  function      D CHAPTER button   When pressed during thumbnail display  displays a list of  thumbnails of the frames where essence marks are  recorded  chapter function   When this is pressed again   returns to normal thumbnail display  The chapter function  can be useful when essence mark th
13.       snue wN 4 Jejdeuj    142    Menu items in the 800s  relating to audio control                                                                            Item number   Item name Settings  807 AUDIO OUTPUT PHASE Set the output timing of digital audio playback signals  HDSDI  SDI  AES   EBU only   with 80H as a reference position  Output timing is earlier for  values smaller than 80H and later for values greater than 80H   80H  128  samples   approx  2 7 ms  80H  1 sample   approx  20 us   0  0  HEX      80  80  HEX      FF  FF  HEX    Values can be set in this  range   808 INTERNAL AUDIO SIGNAL Select the operation of the internal audio test signal generator   GENERATOR silnc  silence   Silent signal   1kHz  1kHz sine   1 kHz     20 dB FS sine wave signal   When you set the A1 INPUT item on page P2 AUDIO of the function  menu to    SG     the internal signal generator operates and outputs  simultaneous test signals to channels 1 to 8  see page 49    815 AUDIO SAMPLING RATE Select the mode of operation of the sampling rate converter for AES   CONVERTER EBU input to channels 1 to 4   off  Do not operate   on  Operate   819 AUDIO INPUT ARRANGE 2  Set up mixing of audio signals   For details  see    To set up mixing of audio input signals     page 62    823 NON AUDIO FLAG PB Control non audio flags in digital audio output   Sub item  1  CH1 CH2 During playback  except E E mode   set non audio flags in digital audio  output to the following states   2   CRBICHS on  Set to on  
14.      VIDEO CONTROL connector  D sub 9 pin   Connect an HKDV 900 video control unit     See page 164 for correspondence between setting items of  HKDYV 900 and setup menu of this unit        REMOTE 9P   remote control 9 pin  connector   D sub 9 pin    To control this unit from a controller or VTR supporting   the RS 422A Sony 9 pin VTR protocol  connect the device   to this connector     Rear Panel       DCIN 12V connector  XLR 4 pin  male   Connect to a DC power source of 12 V    When using the BKP L551 Battery Adaptor to mount a  battery pack  connect the power cable of the BKP L551     For details  see  Supplying power  on page 32     Q REMOTE connector  4 pin   Supplies power to the RM 280 Editing Controller     Q SD HDSDI INPUT  SDSDI HDSDI signal input   connector  BNC type    This inputs an SDSDI or HDSDI format video audio   signal       HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER   HDSDI signal  output 1  2  superimpose   connectors  BNC type   These output HDSDI format video audio signals   When editing with two PDW HD1500 units  connect a  cable between these connectors on the player unit and the  SD HDSDI INPUT connector on the recorder unit   You can superimpose timecodes  menu settings  error  messages  or other information on the output of the HDSDI  OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector with the setting for  CHAR SEL on the HOME page of the function menu or  with the setting for setup menu item 028 HD  CHARACTER  You can always disable to superimpose  the data independent of the setting for
15.      x DISABLE  gt   ENABLE    snus  z Ja dey9             4 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select     ENABLE     and press the SAVE function button  F5      The message    NOW SAVING       appears on the video  monitor display  and    Saving       appears in the time  data display area  while the new settings are saved in  memory  When the saving operation is completed  the  video monitor display and the time data display area  return to their normal indications     When you next display the menu and change the item    display  the extended menu will appear after the basic  menu     Setup Menu 147             snue wN Z Ja deup    148       Maintenance Menu       Items in the maintenance menu    The following tables show the items in the maintenance   menu      Item names are the names which appear on the video  monitor of this unit and an external monitor to which the  output of the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER   connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector   or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector is input   An abbreviated name appears in the time data display  area when you press the NEXT button     The values in the Settings columns are the values which  appear in the time data display area   The values may  appear in a different format on an external monitor  In  this case  the external monitor values are shown in  parentheses   Underlined values are the factory defaults     This manual does not explain the menu items in MO   CHECK  M1  ADJUST  M2  SERVICE SUPPORT  and
16.     As long as the frame frequency group is the same  clips in  different recording formats can be recorded or written to  the same disc  P   In this manual  this is referred to as    mixed format  recording mode      1  The recording format is regarded as different whenever the system  frequency  video resolution  video codec bit rate  or number of audio  channels or number of bits does not match     Regardless of frame frequency group matching  it is not  possible to mix clips with different video resolutions   number of system lines  in the same clip list    When the unit is in a mode that calls for playback across  clips that were recorded in different recording formats   video and audio playback may stop at the point where  the format changes from one format into another  and  then start again    If a transition point between two clips with different  recording formats exists in the preroll segment  that  segment cannot be edited     Recording       Frame frequency groups   The system frequencies supported by this unit are divided  into frame frequency groups  as shown in the following  table                          Frame frequency group   System frequency  59 94 Hz 59 94P  59 94i  29 97P  50 Hz 50P  50i  25P  23 98 Hz 23 98P                You can record clips with different recording formats  for  example HD422 and HD420SP clips  by putting this unit  into mixed format recording mode     To enable mixed format recording mode  Set maintenance menu item M390  MIXED REC 
17.     No   No   when C  MXF file is created      0001 to 9999  C MO2 KLV 9 User metadata file  This type of file is Yes Yes    No 9 Yes    Yes      generated automatically during recording  via an FTP or FAM connection when the  unit recognizes that an MXF file contains  metadata that was generated by a non   XDCAM device      0001 to 9999  Other files Files other than the above   No   No                              a  The unit can handle files with user defined names in the    C     part    b  Only files which are 2 seconds or longer in length  in a format matching  the format  system frequency  and recording format  MPEG HD and  number of audio channels  of the recorded sections of the disc  and which  can be overwritten by XDCAM   Partial writing is not possible     c  Overwriting is not possible    d  Only when sub item NAMING FORM of setup menu item 036 is set to   free     e  Any clip may be selected and deleted    f  Only files which can be written by XDCAM    Component directory    g  When the    C     part of a C  MXF file name is changed  a C M01 XML  file and a C MO2 KLVV file with the same name in the  C   part is also  changed automatically    h  When a C  MXF file is created  a C MOI XML file with the same name  in the  C   part is created automatically    i  When a C  MXF file is deleted  a C M01 XML file and a C M02 KLV  file with the same name in the    C     part is also deleted automatically     Directories cannot be created in the Clip directory            
18.     lt    001 012   gt    gt  gt        When multiple pages exist  you can switch pages by  clicking  lt  lt   back five pages    lt   back one page    gt    forward one page   or  gt  gt   forward five pages      To display clip properties   In the Thumbnails page  select a clip by clicking its  thumbnail    The properties of that clip appear in the Clip Properties  page    See    Checking clip properties     page 82  for more  information about the various properties     Disc Operations       SU9BINS  ND ul SUOI eJBdO s Ja deyD    97          XDCAM HD    Status Clip Properties  Device Information    Hours Meter    Software Version    Disc Properties    Thumbnails       miei    26619452 byte  Maintenance  Network Teil 1179648 byte                 Tn Seg I CMM  3688 byte  Account       Setup Menu TTT          Software Update C0001          License Registration TITLE00001          Nagano Trekking       MPEGHD422 1080 8ch          59 941          17 54 32 27 0 00 18 03          24 FEB 2009 15 40  09 00          25 FEB 2009 21 05  09 00          PDW 700  SN 03043           16 9       Back to Thumbnails           To download high resolution clip data  HIGH  resolution file   proxy AV data  LOW resolution file    or metadata  Clip NRT metadata   click the FTP  Download or HTTP Download button to the right of  the item that you want  Then click  Save  in the dialog  that appears and specify the save destination    The specified data is downloaded to the specified  location in your 
19.     suoneiedejgd e Jaydeyp    37          suonejedejg e jejdeuj    38    HD video monitor                                             REF VIDEO  INPUT       REF VIDEO    HDW M2000  recorder  INPUT OS    To HDSDI input connector        75Q coaxial cable  not supplied     HDSDI OUTPUT 2                                                                      BCT       OUTPUT1    HDSDI     INPUT                                                                       lol        REF VIDEO  EM     eee  9                                               0000                           HDSDI  OUTPUT 3    To HDSDI input  SUPER     connector    Jesod  B  200000 i BE                                   HD video monitor          If                      9 pin remote control cable  not supplied                PDW F1600 or  PDW HD1500   this unit  player     REF VIDEO    INPUT Reference video signal               PLAYER 1                                                                               REMOTE 1 IN 9P        BVE 700 700A   editing control unit        HDW M2000  recorder  settings    REMOTE 1  9P  button  Lit       REF VIDEO INPUT connector 75 Q  termination switch  OFF       Audio selection function switching button  INPUT button  HDSDI       Function menu HOME  gt F1  VID  IN   SDI       Function menu page 1  gt F1  TCG   INT       Function menu page 1   F2  PR RGN    PRESET          Function menu page 1  gt F3  RUN   FREE       BVE 700 700A  editing control unit   setting    SYNCHRONIZE m
20.     xipueddy    192       Glossary    AES EBU   A standard established jointly by the  AES  Audio Engineering Society   and EBU  European Broadcasting  Union  for serial transmission of  digital audio  Two channels of audio  can be transmitted via a single  connector     Clip  A recording unit  Clips are created  every time recording starts and stops     Clip list   A list of locations in the material  recorded on the disc  arranged in any  order  Clip lists can be created with  the scene selection function of this  unit  and with the PDZ 1 Proxy  Browsing Software     Composite video signal   A video signal in which luminance  and chrominance are combined along  with timing reference    sync     information to make composite  video     Drop frame mode   SMPTE timecode runs at 30 frames   second  while the NTSC color  television system runs at about 29 97  frames second  Drop frame mode  adjusts the running of timecode to  eliminate the discrepancy between  timecode value and actual time by  dropping two frames from the  timecode value at the beginning of  each minute except every tenth  minute     E E mode   Electric to Electric mode  When you  operate a VDR in E E mode  input  video and or audio signals pass  through electric circuits only and  then come out from the output  connectors  without passing through  electromagnetic conversion circuits  such as recording heads     Essence mark  A type of metadata that may be set for  a specified frame     Glossary    For more eff
21.    Multiple  selection frames appear when multiple thumbnails are  selected  see page 75         Clip number total number of clips  Displays the total number of clips on the disc  and the  number of the selected clip        Scrollbar   When not all of the thumbnails can be displayed in the  thumbnail display area  the position of the slider shows the  relative position of the currently displayed clips  and the  length of the slider shows the relative length of currently  displayed clips within all of the clips    When you have a large number of thumbnails  you can  save time by using the Skip Scroll function to jump  directly to the thumbnail you want  see page 76      Overview    Q Recording format   The recording format of the selected clip is displayed as a  combination of the following information      Video format logo     Number of system lines     Recording quality     Number of audio channels       Clip date and time  Displays the date and time when the selected clip was shot  and recorded       Duration   Displays the duration  recording time  of the selected clip   When multiple clips are selected  displays the total  recording time of the selected clips      1  Thumbnail display items            TC 00 26 22 10           Index picture  Displays an image to stand for the content of the clip  The  index picture is normally the first frame of the clip        Index picture changed mark   This mark  like the folded over corner of a page that you  want to remember  appear
22.    Operations on the computer side    Use the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software supplied with  this unit  see page 175    To use the PDZ 1 software  set  the operation mode to Live View mode      Recording    In PDZ 1  you can do the following during Live Logging      Display logging AV data  only in Live View mode      Add clip metadata  XML files  and write it back to the  disc     Create clip lists and write them back to the disc     Set essence marks and write them back to the disc       Handling of discs when recording  does not end normally  salvage  functions     Recording processing does not end normally if  for  example  the POWER switch on the rear panel is turned off  during recording  or if the power cord is disconnected  during recording  Because the file system is not updated   video and audio data recorded in real time is not  recognized as files and clip contents recorded up to that  point are lost    However  this unit has salvage functions which can hold   losses to the minimum by reconstructing clips on such   discs  There is a quick salvage function which executes  automatically and a full salvage function which you can  execute as required    Quick salvage  Clips are reconstructed on the basis of  backup data stored in nonvolatile memory and  markers recorded on the disc  Processing time is about  5 seconds    Quick salvage executes automatically if the unit is  powered on with a disc still loaded after recording  was interrupted by power off    Full salvage 
23.    Set the subcarrier H phase      512     512  DEC      0  0  DEC      511  511  DEC         140    Setup Menu       Menu items in the 700s  relating to video control                                                 Item number   Item name Settings   731 WIDE MODE Specify whether to record and play back with the addition of wide picture  information    Sub Item  1 INPUT 9 Select whether to save wide picture information to the disc when  recording   auto  Automatically save wide picture information when it is detected in  the selected input video signal   on  Always save wide picture information   off  Never save wide picture information   2 OUTPUT Select whether to add wide picture information to the signal output when  down converter output is set to squeeze mode   thru  through   Do not add   auto  Add     To add wide picture information to the output signal  another setting is  required in addition to this item  In setup menu item 703  set line 16   59 94i 59 94P 29 97P 23 98P mode  J    line 20  59 94i 59 94P   29 97P 23 98P mode  UC    or line 23 50i 50P 25P mode  to  thru      In 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P 23 98P mode  J   output of wide picture  information is given priority if the VITC insertion line is set to line 16 in  setup menu item 601 or 602      n 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P 23 98P mode  UC   output of wide picture  information is given priority if the VITC insertion line is set to line 20 in  setup menu item 601 or 602    740 MASTER LEVEL  HD  Adjust the high definition v
24.    Switch off blanking        705    EDGE SUBCARRIER REDUCER  MODE    Select whether to enable the edge subcarrier reducer  ESR    on  Enable    off  Do not enable    When playing back a composite signal  set this to    on           707    FORCED VERTICAL  INTERPOLATION OFF    The  Y add  function is normally switched on automatically during jog or  variable speed playback  This item selects whether to force the  Y add   function off    auto  Automatically switch the  Y add  function on    off  forced YADD off   Force the    Y add    function off    The  Y add  function is off while a disc image is displayed in stop mode   menu item 108 AUTO EE SELECT is    off         The  Y add  function is a circuit operation to interpolate the video signal  vertically during jog or variable speed playback for the purpose of  reducing the vertical movement of the playback picture           710       INTERNAL VIDEO SIGNAL  GENERATOR       Select the test signal to be output from the internal test signal generator   When V INPUT on the P1 VIDEO page of the function menu is set to     SG     the internal test signal generator operates to output the selected  test signal  This signal can also be recorded    CB75  75  Color Bars   75  color bar signal   CB100  100  Color Bars   100  color bar signal   MLTBS  Multi Burst   Multi burst signal   10STEP  10 steps   10 step signal   PLSBR  Pulse and Bar   Pulse and bar signal   RAMP  Ramp   Ramp signal   BLACK  Black   Black signal   ARIB CB  ARIB C
25.    Symbols             lt    gt   2  V       1  The following character codes cannot be used by FAM connections   U 010000  U 020000  U 030000  U 040000  U 050000  U 060000   U 070000  U 080000  U 090000  U 0A0000  U 0B0000  U 0C0000   U 0D0000  U 0E0000  U 0F0000  U 100000    PROAV directory    This directory contains individual files recorded on the  disc    To display the PROAV directory  set maintenance menu  item M33  FILE I F CONFIG  gt  PROAV DISPLAY to     ENABLE                 suonejedo aji4 9 1e1deu     110    Assigning user defined clip titles    By default  clips on each disc are assigned names in the  range C0001 MXF to C9999 MXF  For this reason  two  discs can contain clips with the same names  The  automatic title generation function allows you to assign  titles to all of the clips on several discs  which facilitates  clip management  For example  if the titles TITLEO0001 to  TITLE00020 are assigned to clips CO001 MXF to  C0020 MXF on disc 1  then the titles TTTLEO0021 to  TITLE00037 are assigned to clips CO001 MXF to  C0017 MXF on disc 2     Overview            C0020 MXF              C0001 MXF G G    TITLEO0020           Ul   11 E00002    Clips recorded on Disc 1            mm      TITLE00001                             m  oa  TITLE00021    Clips recorded on Disc 2             Proceed as follows to specify a title and assign it to  recorded clips     1 Press the MENU button     2 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select setup  menu item 035  and press the kno
26.    This can be used as a guide in determining when to replace  the seek motor     H14  SPINDLE RUNNING HOURS mode   resettable    This shows the cumulative spindle rotation time  in units of  hours  The count is resettable     Periodic Maintenance       xipueddy    159          xipueddy    160    This can be used as a guide in determining when to replace  the spindle motor     H15  LOADING COUNTER mode  resettable   Display the total number of times disc has been loaded in  the unit  The count is resettable     H17  SEEK RUNNING HOURS 1 mode  resettable   Same as H13    Of the two optical heads  this shows the cumulative seek  operation time for the other optical head in units of hours   The count is resettable     To display the digital hours meter    Press the MENU button to display the setup menu  then  turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to display the required  item in the time data display area and on the monitor  connected to the unit     To exit from the digital hours meter    Press the RETURN function button  F1  to return to the  setup menu    Press the EXIT function button  F5  to return to the screen  that was displayed before you entered the setup menu     Periodic Maintenance       Troubleshooting       Alarms    An alarm  warning message  appears in the time data  display area when an operation is attempted which is  inappropriate for the settings on this unit or the state of the  disc  Both the alarm message and the action to take to  resolve the problem appear in t
27.    To save clip lists    To save under a specified name    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 mine clip list thumbnail screen  display the Disc  Menu     2 Select Save Clip List as     and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A list of clip lists appears     Disc Menu    liil Save Clip List as    Name  amp  Date Sorted by Name  DVD og Bl    08 AUG2007 11 50   E0003 03 AUG2007 17 51   E0004 03 AUG2007 17 51       E0005 03 AUG2007 17 51    03 AUG2007 17 51  03 AUG2007 17 51  18 MAY2006 10 25  13 JUN2006 13 43    E0006  E0007  E0095    E0098  Display Select       To switch the information displayed for clip lists  Press the   OUT button    With each press  the display changes in the order      Name  amp  Date   gt    Name  amp  Title  2  Name  amp  Sort  Date           To sort clip lists  Select one of the following orders by selecting  Settings  gt Sort Clip List by    in the Disc Menu     Name A  Z   Sort in ascending order by clip list name     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing        Date Newest First   Sort by date and time of clip list  creation  newest first     3 Select the desired clip list name  and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To save under the same name   The following procedure saves the current clip list under  its current name  the name that appears in the clip list  thumbnail screen      See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the Di
28.    a  HD420LP supports playback only     System frequency  Displays the system frequency of  the clips recorded on the disc     O Video format  Displays the video format and bitrate of  the clips recorded on the disc     D  Audio format  Displays the audio format of the clips  recorded on the disc     Q System information          Power status      DEFAULT Jj  Menu setting status  Remote interface     REPEAT    Clip playback mode  EA    Jog shuttle dial mode                        Power status  Displays the status of the power supply          to the unit   Display Power status  AC power  Battery       Battery almost exhausted  Flashes at 1 Hz  Battery exhausted  Flashes at 4 Hz                Front Panel    Syed Jo suonounJ pue sewey zJejdeyo IM    25          Sued Jo suonounJ pue seuieN z Jeideuj    26       Power status  AC power  power saving mode        Battery  power saving mode           Battery  power saving mode low                 Menu setting status  Displays the current setting  status of setup menu                          Display Description   BANK1 The current menu settings are the same  as the settings in menu bank 1    BANK2 The current menu settings are the same  as the settings in menu bank 2    BANK3 The current menu settings are the same  as the settings in menu bank 3    DEFAULT   The current menu settings are the same  as the factory defaults    No display   The current menu settings are different  from all of the above                 Remote interface  
29.    gt   and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     A network settings screen for the remote host appears     Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Select Host 1   Host Name  Port 21   Device Type PDW HD1500    Description   Path  Clip  User Name admin  Password kkhk kk kkk    Cancel  lt  lt  Connect          Item Setting    Host Name  host name  a DNS server must be  available on the connected network   Specification of an IP address is  recommended      Host name or IP address   If this is a       Port Port used by the FTP server  normally     21            Device Type  The type of the remote host      f the remote host is an XDCAM  device  select the model name or   Other XDCAM model     if the model  name is not in the list  from the list of  model names  9       f the remote host is a computer   select    Others PC Server   from the  list of model names        Description Comment about the remote host   UTF   8 encoding  up to 127 bytes  This  setting has no effect on the connection    The setting that you make here appears  as the remote host name in the Select  Remote Host screen  see step 5 of the  procedure         Path If the remote host is a computer  path to  the transfer destination directory   This  is not needed if the remote host is an  XDCAM device         User Name User name for FTP login   If the remote  host is an XDCAM device  the default is     admin          Password Password for FTP login   If the remote  host is an XDCAM device  the default is  the model na
30.    jencoding   UTF 8    3   lt PlanningMetadata   xmIns  http     xmins sony net pro metadata   planningmetadata   assignId    P0001  creationDate    2008 01 20T17 00 00 09 00  plastUpdate    2008 03 28T 10 30 00 09 00    load    false    version  1 00  gt   4   lt Properties  propertyId    assignment    update  2008 01 20T09 00   00 09 00    modifiedBy  Chris  gt    lt Title  usAscii  Typhoon    xml lang    en    Typhoon Strikes Tokyo  lt  Title gt 4    Properties   4     PlanningMetadata   4    In the above example  a carriage return     When creating a file  write each line as a single  statement  inserting carriage returns only at the indicated  carriage return locations  and inserting no unspecified  spaces    If the UTF 8 format string is longer than 52 characters   the ASCII format string is used as the clip name string      gt  sp indicates a space and   indicates    To set clip names    1 Loada planning metadata file containing clip names  into the unit s memory  see page 94      2 Carry out steps 2 to 5 of to set the  To assign clip  names on this unit   page 111      Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to display  PLAN    and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Each time that you start recording  the unit  automatically creates clip names using the names  specified in the planning metadata file  An underscore   _  and a three digit serial number  001 to 999  is  appended to each clip name     Examples of automatically generated clip names  Clip names displayed in the
31.    sub item of setup menu  item 036 is set to    C                rreo               5       1      TITLEO0001    When the  AUTO NAMING     sub item of basic menu item  036 is set to  title     m             N    I    Before you start  set the  TITLE  sub item of setup  menu item 035 CLIP TITLE NAMING SELECT to   enable   and set a title  see the previous section      Press the MENU button     Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select setup  menu item 036     Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the         to  the left of the item names to  NAMING FORM      The         indicates the selected item     RETURN  SELECT    ITEM 036  FILE NAMING    NAMING FORM  AUTO NAMING      Cxxx x    Cxxx x       Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    free     and  press the knob     You are now able to use clips and clip lists with user   defined names     Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the         to  the left of    AUTO NAMING     and press the knob     Overview    7 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    title     and  press the knob     8 Press the SAVE function  F5  button     The same name will now be given to newly recorded  clips     To use clips and clip lists with user defined  names over FAM and FTP connections   Carry out steps 2 to 5 of    To assign clip names on this  unit   and then press the SAVE function  F5  button    It is now possible to write  transfer  and rename clips and  clip lists with user defined names over file access mode   FAM  connections  page 11
32.   MONTH  Month  DAY  Day  TIME  Time    TIME ZONE  Time zone  as a difference in hours  with respect to Coordinated Universal Time   UTC      In the setting screen  you can change the value of the  flashing digit     Press the   IN or    OUT button to make the previous  digit or next digit start flashing    Press the   MARK1 or    MARK2 button  or turn the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob  to increment or decrement  the value of the flashing digit     When you have finished making settings  press the  SET function button  F5     The date  time  and time zone settings are saved  and  the message    NOW SAVING       appears     If you want to save the settings made up to this point   press the SET function button  F5  again     Initial Setup    INITIAL SETUP    Push FS SAVE  Key       CANCEL amp PREV   Fi  RET   SAVE amp REBOOT   FS  SET        The message    NOW SAVING       appears again  and  the setting screen disappears  Then the unit powers  itself off and on again     To return to the original screen without saving  settings  Press the RETURN function button  F1      The time zone is reset to the factory default when you  execute the maintenance menu item M49  RESET ALL  SETUP  You will need to set it again  The date and time  are not reset        Front Panel Tilt  Mechanism    The front panel of this unit has a tilt mechanism that allows  you to pull the front panel out and adjust it to a convenient  angle     To pull the front panel out    Grasp the holds  small protrusions  on b
33.   Mo  DRIVE  Refer to the Maintenance Manual for an  explanation of these items     M3  OTHERS  Other setting items       Item Setting  M30  SOFTWARE VERSION    Display of the software version of this unit       M31  SERIAL NUMBER    Display of the serial number of this unit       M33  FILE I F PROAV DISPLAY  CONFIG    Selects whether or not to display PROAV directory   DISABLE  Do not display PROAV directory   ENABLE  Display PROAV directory        PC REMOTE    Disables or enables a FAM connection   ENALBE  Enable a FAM connection   F KEY SELECT  Enable or disable a FAM connection using the function menu        M36  HOURS METER RESET    Display and reset of the hours meter and the thread counter       M37  AUDIO M370  HEAD ROOM  CONFIG    Select the audio reference level  headroom       20dB     18dB     16dB     12dB  EBUL    EBUL can be selected only when the system frequency is 50i 50P 25P        M371  DATA LEN    Select the audio channel configuration for IMX recording   16bit x 8ch  16 bit  8 channel configuration  24bit x 4ch  24 bit  4 channel configuration       M372  NON AUDIO                   Select whether to handle digital audio signals as non audio signals during                   INPUT recording    E   Supem T a acsi   1 Tr1 Tr2   2 Tr3 Tr4   3 Tr5 Tr6   4 Tr7 Tr8   M373  INPUT LEVEL Set the upper limit for the signal level input to audio channels 1 3 or 2 4   Sub Item  4dB  OdB     3dB   6dB  EBUL   1 CH1 CH3   2 CH2 CH4 EBUL can be selected only when the sys
34.   Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution    Neither the name of Cisco  Inc  Beijing University of  Posts and Telecommunications  nor the names of their  contributors may be used to endorse or promote products  derived from this software without specific prior written  permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS  IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT   INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY   OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE          Part 7  Fabasoft R amp D Software GmbH  amp  Co KG  copyright notice  BSD           Copyright  c  Fabasoft R amp D Software GmbH  amp  Co KG   2003  oss   fabasoft com    Author  Bernhard Penz   bernhard penz   fabasoft com gt     Redistribution and use in source a
35.   WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM THE LOSS OF  USE  DATA OR PROFITS  WHETHER IN AN ACTION  OF CONTRACT  NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER  TORTIOUS ACTION  ARISING OUT OF OR IN  CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE  OF THIS SOFTWARE          Part 2  Networks Associates Technology  Inc  copyright notice  BSD           Copyright  c  2001 2003  Networks Associates  Technology  Inc  All rights reserved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or  without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution    Neither the name of the Networks Associates  Technology  Inc nor the names of its contributors may be  used to endorse or promote products derived from this  software without specific prior written permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS  IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT   INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY   OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING   BU
36.   When the transfer of all files has finished  the  Uploading Result Report screen appears    Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob  This returns you to  the clip thumbnail screen     Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Uploading Result Report  Uploaded  3 3 Clips  0 0 ClipLists    Not Uploaded  0 3 Clips  0 0 ClipLists      All Clips Uploaded Successfully     To upload part of a clip    You can select part of a clip in the expand thumbnail  screen or the chapter thumbnail screen and upload that  part    Expand thumbnail screen  The clip is divided arbitrarily  into parts of equal length  regardless of content  Use  this method if you do not need to specify the transfer  range precisely    Chapter thumbnail screen  Use this method if you want  to transfer a specific range   By setting essence marks  at the start point and end point of the transfer range   you can specify the range with a precision of one  frame      1 Inthe clip thumbnail screen  select a clip and press the  EXPAND or CHAPTER button     The expand thumbnail screen or the chapter thumbnail  screen appears     2 Select the transfer range     To select multiple thumbnails  While holding the SHIFT key down  turn the PUSH    SET S SEL  knob  or press the    amp  IN or   OUT button     The duration of the transfer range appears in the lower  right of the screen     When the selected range  duration  in the expand  thumbnail screen is less than two seconds  it is  expanded automatically to two seconds        Execute step 2 to 9
37.   Y cd Ins Del  Spanish  Spain   a          I   amp                 Re Blog           elt ila ella   lia ls lle  lz  i ie li ee a inset rico  P  g    Num  T     Q IW IE  R IT IY ju iT Wo IP J  JF Enter sul en A   7   8 V9   gt        H e upr jj FN    Pag    inicio    4   ReP  g  M  Bloq A S D F G H J K L N j    4 5 6  May  s       x S  Shift      Z   X lc Iv IB IN IM I     J  If Shift 4 1   2 Js     I lt        a Fin   JN P  g  Wiss  Control Alt Alt Gr Control 0      1 4 m   Ins Supr                                                                         xipueddy    When the area of use is set to    UC    and  the font setting is  Korean     The keyboard is fixed as the Korean keyboard  and you can  enter Hangul characters     The keyboard language cannot be changed     1 86 List of Supported USB Keyboards                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      de  l  J  I      amp  I gt                 Page   Num            1  l2 4  s5 lle Jj Ila Il   jlo l  l  Jj Insert Home uo    Lock  Tab    Q m p E cR nit ally   U    oslPalt     Delete   ena Page   7   8   9   gt   Hl all cl al all ul 3 E H ALL Wt Down   Home  _ 4   PgUp    Capslock A   S D F  G  H J K L H T E
38.   button  OUT button   You can use these buttons for thumbnail selection  menu  setting operations  setting In Out points  and so on            MARK1 button and  amp  MARK2 button    IN indicator and OUT indicator    MARK1    g Oe  Q 6    IN button and    OUT button   7  MARK2                 MARKI button and 4 MARK2 button   When the THUMBNAIL indicator  see page 21 is lit  you  can use these for thumbnail selection    During recording or playback  a shot mark 1 or shot mark  2 is recorded as an essence mark when you press the PUSH  SET  S SEL  knob with the   MARK1 or    MARK2  button held down  If you connect a Windows USB  keyboard to the MAINTENANCE connector  you can  record shot marks from Shot MarkO up to Shot Mark9 by  pressing the 0 to 9 keys on the numeric keypad    Use the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software on the supplied  XDCAM Application Software CD ROM to delete and  modify essence marks    Essence marks can also be deleted and modified from the  Thumbnail Menu of the chapter thumbnail screen  see  page 71        IN indicator and OUT indicator   IN indicator  When an In point is set  this lights  If an  attempt is made to set the In point after a recorded Out  point  this flashes    OUT indicator  When an Out point is set  this lights  If an  attempt is made to set the Out point before a recorded  In point  this flashes          IN button and    OUT button   When the THUMBNAIL indicator  see page 21 is lit  you  can use these for thumbnail selection    An In or Ou
39.   clip continuous rec   see page 133      See page 56 for more information about the disc  exchange cache function     See page 57 for more information about the Clip  Continuous Rec function      D  Low battery warning  Appears and flashes during  operation with a battery pack when the battery power  is almost exhausted     B Converter display  Displays the current down  or up   converter mode  depending on the state of the unit   The current down converter  DC  mode appears  when HD video is being input and when an HD disc  is being played  The current up converter  UC  mode  appears when SD video is being input and when an  SD disc is being played P  The current modes are those selected with setup menu  items 9330 DOWN CONVERTER MODE  DC  and  950 UP CONVERTER MODE P     1 When the PDBK S1500 option is installed     DC EC  Down converter edge crop mode  DC LB  Down converter letter box mode  DC SQ  Down converter squeeze mode  UC EC  Up converter edge crop mode  UC LB  Up converter letter box mode  UC SQ  Up converter squeeze mode    Front Panel       seq Jo suonounJ pue seweN z Jeideu     27          Sued Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jeideuo    28    Rear Panel          NACIN    POWER E    EASE     WXWEWESI          Power supply section  see  page 29                                li          LY a  Ej     S9      DC IN 12V connector  2    L      REMOTE connector    Q SD HDSDI INPUT connector                 output section  see     amp   page 30  3              2  Analog audio 
40.   delete  or rename a clip      Make a network or FAM connection     Eject the disc     Changethe recording format  change the setting of setup  menu item 031 RECORDING FORMAT      Power the unit off    To turn the function off  Set setup menu item 150 REC MODE to  normal         Using the Live Logging function    Live Logging allows you to transfer planning metadata and  proxy AV data between this unit and a computer as you are  recording    Live Logging has the following two operation modes        Main functions as seen from this  unit    Operation mode    Live   Receive planning metadata     Send clip metadata recorded on the  basis of planning metadata     Write edited clip metadata back to  disc       Live View   Same functions as above    Send proxy AV data                To record with the Live Logging function  enabled    Connect this unit and a computer to a network  see  page 153   and then set setup menu item 258 LIVE  LOGGING MODE to one of the following    live mode  Live mode   live view mode  Live View mode    In Live View mode  the run mode is always Free Run   regardless of the setting of RUN MODE on page P5 TC  of the function menu  It is not possible to preset the  timecode to be recorded    The Disc Exchange Cache function and Clip Continuous  Rec function cannot be enabled in Live View mode   FAM or FTP connections cannot be established during a  Live View mode connection  Live view mode  connections cannot be established during a FAM or FTP  connection  
41.   or    E E01    part  may be   limited to 14 characters   The limit for ASCII characters  is 56 characters     All file name extensions are converted automatically to   uppercase    Titles are used as user defined clip names on this unit    Therefore  the available characters are limited to those   supported by the title function    Files generated along with clips and clip lists use the   same names  the    C     or  E   part of the following file   names       Clips  Metadata files  C MO1 XML   user metadata  files  C MO02 KLV   proxy AV data files   C S01 MXF      Clip lists  Metadata files  E MO1 XML    The following names cannot be assigned      Clips  CO000 MXF     Clip lists  EO000E01 SMI  E0100E01 SMI to  E9999E01 SMI  E0000 SMI  E0100 SMI to  E9999 SMI   The following names should be avoided      Clips  C5000 MXF to C9999 MXF     Clip lists  E0001 SMI to E0099 SMI    To assign clip names on this unit    The title assigned to clip becomes its clip name  file  name      When the first letter of the title setting with setup menu  item 035 CLIP TITLE NAMING SELECT is a space or  period      the clip name is the title string minus the first  letter    An FTP client that supports UTF 8 is required to use  Unicode characters other than ASCII characters   Command prompt FTP commands do not support  UTF 8     Overview       suoneiedo aji4 9 1e1deuj    111          suonejedo aji4 9 1e1deu     112                    Uu     U  TITLE00001       VON  UT    When the  AUTO NAMING  
42.   or    UB     see page 48         TC ExT  D    TC EXTERNAL IS SELECTED   SET TC INTERNAL MODE IN FUNCTION  MENU     This appears when TCG on page P5 TC of the  function menu is set to  EXT   and you try to preset  timecode or user bits by setting PRST RGN to     PRESET       Set TCG to  INT   see page 51         REGEN mode  9    TCG REGEN MODE IS SELECTED   SET TC PRESET MODE IN FUNCTION  MENU     This appears when PRST RGN on page P5 TC of the  function menu is set to  TC  or  VITC   and you try to  preset timecode or user bits    Set PRST RGN to    PRESET     see page 51                                 REC RUN  9 TCG RUN MODE IS SET TO REC RUN    This appears when RUN MODE on page P5 TC of  SET TC FREE RUN MODE IN FUNCTION   the function menu is set to    REC RUN   and you try to  MENU  preset timecode or user bits   Set RUN MODE to  FREE RUN   see page 51    REC mode  P THUMBNAIL S  CANNOT BE Stop recording and try again   DISPLAYED DURING RECORDING   CANNOT EXECUTE IN REC MODE   DRIVE MAINTENANCE MENU CANNOT  BE EXECUTED WHILE IN REC MODE   INPUT SELECTION CANNOT BE  CHANGED DURING RECORDING   AUDIO REC MODE CANNOT BE  CHANGED DURING RECORDING   REC PAUSE  TC UB CANNOT BE PRESET IN REC  Stop recording and try again   PAUSE MODE   Disc Exchg  EXIT DISC EXCHANGE CACHE MODE  This appears when you perform one of the following  operations     Attempt to preset timecode or user bits     Attempt to make a FAM connection     Press the button such as PLAY button while the  disc i
43.   pressed    Press the PLAY button to resume playback at the stop  position     After recording   The unit stops at the position where recording ended    To play back a clip  press the PREV button to move to the  start frame of any clip or press the PREV button with the  PLAY button held down to move to any position     After disc insertion   The unit stops at the position of the disc when it was most  recently ejected    Press the PLAY button to resume playback at the most  recent position    The playback position is saved to the disc when the disc is  ejected  which allows playback to start at that position  whenever it is loaded into any XDCAM player     This function is not available when the Write Inhibit tab of  the disc is set to the recording disabled position  and when  REC INH on HOME page of the function menu is set to   ON     The REC INHI indicator may light when neither of the  above is true if the format of recorded sections on the disc  is not the same as the recording settings of this unit  In this  case  the playback position can be saved to the disc     1080 720 cross convert function    You can output 720 while playing discs recorded as 1080   and output 1080 while playing discs recorded as 720   When the system frequency of the loaded disc  59 94i   59 94P 29 97P  501 50P 25P  or 23 98P  matches the  system frequency of the unit  but the system line settings   1080 or 720  do not match  then an    FC    mark appears  and disc playback is cross converted a
44.   prompting you to enable it  Select    OK    and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob  The UPnP function will    be enabled when you power the unit off and then on  again     The Select Host Discovered via UPnP screen appears    Some time may be required before the search for  remote hosts finishes     Select the name of a remote host from the list  and  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob  A network settings  screen appears  see step 7   If you establish a  connection with the selected remote host  the network  settings are saved in Remote Host 4  From the next  time that you select    Remote Host 4 UPnP    the  remote host that you select here will be connected     To check the network settings of this unit   Select    Network Config   and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob  The following network settings  appear           Item Setting  Host Name Host name  IP Address IP address 9       Subnet Mask    DHCP Setting that specifies whether to   acquire the IP address   automatically from a DHCP server   Enabled  Acquire automatically   Disabled  Do not acquire  automatically    Method used to set IP address   Manual Set  Manually   DHCP  DHCP function   AutolP  Auto IP addressing  function   Undefined  Nothing specified    Subnet mask          Address Status                Default Gateway Default gateway       a  An IP address determined by a DHCP server appears instantly in this  field     Select OK and press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to  return to the previous screen     Select
45.   properties 94  reconstructing 58  remaining capacity alarm 22  salvage functions 58  slot 18  usable discs 52  volume labels 157  write protecting 53  DISPLAY  button 21  Display 20 23  basic operation display 23  video monitor display 26  window 23  Display menu control section 20    E  Editing  control unit 37  controller 39  EJECT button 18  Ejecting a disc manually 172  Error messages 172  Essence mark  search 78  setting 55 65  thumbnail screen 72  Expand  function 13 77  thumbnail screen 71  EXPAND button 21  Extended menu 123  display 146  items 131  operations 146  External synchronization 42    F    Features 11  File access mode  FAM  connections  36    File operations 106  Clip directory 108  Component directory 108  directory structure 106  Edit directory 108  General directory 109  root directory 107  Sub directory 109  File Operations in File Access Mode   for Macintosh  115  exiting file operations 116  making FAM connections 115  operating on files 115  reconnecting 116  File Operations in File Access Mode   for Windows  113  exiting file operations 114  making connections 113  operating on files 114  preparations 113  reconnecting 114  recording continuous timecode  122  Filter Clips function 79  Formatting discs 96  Frame frequency groups 54  Front panel 17  35  changing the angle 35  pulling out 35  returning to original position 35  FTP file operations 116  command list 117  loggingin 117  logging out 117  making connections 116  preparations 116  recordi
46.   salvage the disc                 Code  XXXX    Model   0002 PDW 1500 530 510 R1  PDW F70 F350 F330   0200 PDW F70 F350 F330  Version 1 9 or  higher   PDW F75 F355 F335   0300 2  PDW HD1500 HR1 700   0301 9 PDW HD1500 700  Version 1 5 or higher   PDW F1600 F800                a Does not appear on this unit     Even when these functions are used  it is not possible to   recover data from immediately before the interruption of   recording  The amount of data lost is as follows    Quick salvage  From 2 to 4 seconds of data before the  interruption of recording    Full salvage  From 4 to 6 seconds of data before the  interruption of recording     More data may be lost when the unit is subject to   vibrations  and when you switch frequently between   recording and paused     You are prompted to execute a full salvage every time   you insert a disc that has not been salvaged  or power the   unit on with such as disc loaded    No recording is possible on discs containing clips that   have not been salvaged  although it is possible to play   back the normally recorded sections  Recording   becomes possible if you perform a quick format  but this   erases all of the original recorded content     To restore clips with a full salvage    1    Insert the disc on which recording did not end  normally     The message  Salvage    appears on the display     To cancel the clip salvage  Press the RESET RETURN button       The message    EJECT     appears when    REC INHI     is displayed  If t
47.   section called the    Source Pack   contains information such as the time  and location of recording  A UMID  with the Basic section only is called a  Basic UMID  A UMID with the    Source Pack is called an Extended  UMID     User bits   A total of 32 bits are provided in the  timecode which the user can use to  record such information as date  reel  number  or scene number on video  tape or disc  Also called user s bits     VBID  Video Blanking ID    This is a video ID signal  defined in  the EIAJ CPR 1204 standard  which  is inserted into VBS video output to  enable the aspect ratio to be detected   The ID signal is inserted into line 20   VBI 283     Glossary          xipueddy    193       xepu    194       Index    A    AC IN connector 29  ACCESS indicator 17  Accessories  not supplied 174  supplied 174  Add Sub Clip screen 88  89  Alarms 161  Analog  audio signal input output section  30  ANALOG AUDIO  INPUT 1 2 connectors 30  OUTPUT 1 2 connectors 30  Ancillary data 178  Appendix 158  Area of use setting 33  Arrow buttons 18  Audio  input display 23  Audio level  adjustment section 18  meters 23  AUDIO MONITOR R  L connectors  30    Basic menu 123  changing settings 129  items 124  operations 128  returning to factory default  settings 129  Battery  attaching a battery pack 32  checking the remaining power 33  removing 33    C    CH 1 ALL CH  CH 2 to CH 4  adjustment knobs 18  Chapter  function 77  thumbnailscreen 71  CHAPTER button 21  Clip 87  changing index picture
48.   you can  register the names in the file as clip names    There are two ways to load files      Automatically load a file that has been written to the  following directory on a Professional Disc via an FTP or  FAM connection      Use a GUI screen to load a file that has been written to  the following directories on a Professional Disc or a  USB flash drive  see page 94      File creation rules       File location File name         Format that can be used  in the General directory   see page 109      Extension  XML      ASCII characters  up to  63 characters including  the extension      Extension  XML    Professional Disc   General Sony Planning    directory 9       USB memory  General   Sony Planning  directory                a  General Sony Planning directory is created automatically when a disc is  formatted  Automatically when a disc is formatted     Do not save more than 100 planning metadata files in the  above save locations  The unit may fail to load the files  correctly if more than 100 are saved     Clip name string format    In a text editor  modify the two fields in the   Title   tag that  contain the clip name strings  the shaded fields in the  example below     Enter a name in the first field in ASCII format  up to 13  characters   and enter another name in the second field in  UTF 8 format  up to 52 characters      Overview       epen Buiuue d  g 1e deuo    155    C3          eepo Buiuuejd  9 saj deyo    156    Clip name string example       xml  versionz  1 0
49.  117 for the FTP protocol commands  supported by this unit     Standard commands    In the command syntax   lt SP gt  means a space  entered by  pressing the space bar  and  lt CRLF gt  means a new line   entered by pressing the Enter key     USER  Send this command to begin the login process     Command syntax  USER  lt SP gt   lt user name gt   lt CRLF gt     Input example  USER admin    PASS    After sending the USER command  send this command to  complete the login process     Command syntax  PASS  lt SP gt   lt password gt   lt CRLF gt   Input example  PASS pdw hd1500    QUIT    Terminates the FTP connection  If a file is being  transferred  terminates after completion of the transfer     Command syntax  QUIT  lt CRLF gt     FTP File Operations       suolyesado e  9 seydeyp    117          suonejedo aji4 9 1e1deu     118    PORT  Specifies the IP address and port to which this unit should  connect for the next file transfer  for data transfer from this  unit    Command syntax  PORT   SP     h1 h2 h3 h4 p1 p2     lt CRLF gt     h1  most significant byte  to h4  least significant byte   IP  address    p1  most significant byte   p2  least significant byte   Port  address  Input example  PORT 10 0 0 1 242 48   IP address  10 0 0 1  Port number  62000     PASV  This command requests this unit to    listen    on a data port   which is not its default data port    It puts this unit into  passive mode  waiting for the remote computer to make a  data connection     Command synta
50.  2 to  2 times normal speed  In shuttle mode  you  can perform high speed searches at either  20 times  normal speed or maximum speed  as selected by an  extended menu setting   High speed F FWD and F REV  searching is possible at either  35 times normal speed or  maximum speed  1     1  Maximum speed is about  50 times normal speed  However  the  maximum speed may vary depending on the state of the clip and the  playback position on the disc     Convenient disc based playback and searching  Like previous products in the XDCAM series  this unit  supports a number of convenient search functions   including scene selection  thumbnail searches  essence  marks searches  and expand searches    Scene selection  This function allows you to select clips  from the disc and insert them into playlists  Clips can  be inserted and played back in any order    Thumbnail searches  The unit creates thumbnails from  the first frame of each generated clip  and displays  them in thumbnail lists on the color LCD or an  external monitor  You can cue up clips very easily by  simply by selecting them from thumbnail lists    Essence mark searches  Essence marks can be recorded  at any scene during or after recording  Lists of these  marks can be displayed on the color LCD or an  external monitor  allowing you to quickly find scenes  that were marked for later reference    Expand searches  This function allows you to look inside  the clip selected in a thumbnail screen  or inside the  segment from a s
51.  81  continuous playback mode 63  deleting 85  duration  70  finding 77    Index    information  24  locking 85  playback screen 68  properties 82  selecting by type 79  single clip playback mode 63  thumbnail screen 68  70  transferring 99  unlocking 85  user defined name 111  Clip Continuous Rec function 57  Clip List   Move  screen 90   Trim  screen 90  user defined name 111  Cliplist 87  changing start timecode 91  clearing 93  creating and editing 88  current clip list 87  deleting 93  loading 92  managing 92  playback screen 68  previewing 87  saving 92  sorting 93  thumbnail screen 68  71  Clip Properties screen 82  Closed caption data 179  Command list 117  Communications speed 154  COMPOSITE OUTPUT 1 2  SUPER   connectors 29  Connections 36  cut editing system 37  editing control unit settings 39  FAM connection 36  for pool coverage 41  for using PDZ 1 36  FTP connection 36  using the editing function of  recorder 41  Current clip list 87    D    Date time setting 34   DC IN 12V connector 28   Delete Clip 86   Delete Clip  amp  Clip List 86   DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU   IN 1 2  3 4 connectors 30  OUT 1 2  3 4 connectors 30   Digital audio signal input output   section  30   Digital hours meter 159   display modes 159    displaying 160  exiting 160  Direct FTP function  99  DISC MENU  button 21  68  indicator 21  68  Disc Menu 73  Discs 94  ejecting with the unit powered off  172  formatting 53  96  handling 52  information 25  loaded indication 25  loading unloading 53
52.  Assemble editing is possible only on the last clip     Live Logg  CANNOT EDIT AV MATERIAL IN LIVE This appears when an edit preset command is zi  LOGGING MODE  received while the Live Logging function is enabled   a  Displayed only when setup menu item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to     on    or  limit    During playback  Alarm message in time data Alarm message in monitor video Description action  display section section  ILL  PLAY  9 ILLEGAL PLAYBACK  Check the disc being played by this unit   Troubleshooting 1 67          xipueddy    168       Alarm message in time data  display section    MEM  Empty  9    Alarm message in monitor video  section    MEMORY EMPTY       Description action    Check the disc being played by this unit        Disc Error        DISC ERROR DETECTED  Use another disc              a  Displayed only when setup menu item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to       on    or  limit      During thumbnail search  scene selection  and clip list operations       Alarm message in GUI  screen    Description action       Cannot Expand Clip any  Further     The clip cannot be expanded into more blocks   This appears when the EXPAND button is pressed when the number of block is maximum  or  when the duration of an expanded thumbnail is 1 frame        Selected Essence Mark does  not Exist     The selected essence mark does not exist   This appears in the essence mark selection screen when the specified essence mark does not  exist on the disc        Sub Clip is Invalid   Set 
53.  CHAR SEL with the  setting for setup menu item 028     See  Basic Operations of the Function Menu   page 48   for more information about the CHAR SEL settings        See page 126 for more information about the setup menu  item 026 HD CHARACTER     To treat the input and output signals of these connectors as  non audio signals  set the maintenance menu item M37   AUDIO CONFIG  gt M372  NON AUDIO INPUT   recording   see page 148  and setup menu item 823 NON   AUDIO FLAG PB  playback      Q COMPOSITE OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER   analog  composite video output 1  2  superimpose    connectors  BNC type    Output analog composite video signals  You can   superimpose timecodes  menu settings  or error messages   on the output of the 2  SUPER  connector when CHAR   SEL on the HOME page of the function menu is set to ON     See  Basic Operations of the Function Menu  on page 48  for more information about the CHAR SEL setting     Q REF VIDEO INPUT  reference video signal input   connectors  BNC type    The two connectors form a loop through connection  when  a reference video signal is input to the left connector  the  same signal is input from the right connector   AW   to a  connected device  When no connection is made to the right  connector  the left connector is automatically terminated  with an impedance of 75 ohms     O    network  connector  RJ 45 type   This is a IOBASE T 100BASE TX 1000B ASE T  connector for network connection     For safety  do not connect the connector for periph
54.  Clips are reconstructed on the basis of  markers recorded on the disc  Nonvolatile memory  cannot be used  so processing takes longer than for a  quick salvage  about 30 seconds  although it depends  on the state of the disc     You are prompted to execute a full salvage whenever  you insert a disc that was removed manually from a  powered off device after interruption of recording by  power off     Note that no recorded clip contents are lost when the on   standby button on the front panel is set to standby during  recording  because the unit does not enter standby mode  until after the end of recording processing     Even after recording finishes  do not set the POWER  switch on the rear panel to off until the ACCESS  indicator has gone out    These functions salvage as much recorded material as  possible after an unforeseen accident  but 100   restoration cannot be guaranteed    When recording on the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500  does not end successfully  you can use another XDCAM    system to perform a full salvage of the disc  As the other  system  use the PDW F800 or PDW 700    The following alarm message  see page 162  may  appear when you insert a disc       DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED  FORMAT DISC  OR CONTACT SERVICE TO RUN CLIP SALVAGE  PROGRAM   XXXX     This message means that recording on that disc did not  end normally  The  XXXX  in the message is a code for  XDCAM devices that can salvage the disc  Refer to the  following table and use one of the indicated devices to
55.  FEB 2008 09 14  08 00   21 FEB 2008 09 14  08 00  Guillermo Arduino    File Name  Assign ID  Created  Modified  Modified by  Title1 Clip 00006  Title2  none   Material Gp 008       File Name  Planning metadata file name   Assign ID  Assign ID   Created  Date and time of creation   Modified  Date and time of most recent modification   Modified by  Name of person who modified the file   Title1  Title 1 P   Title2  Title 2   Material Gp  Number of clips recorded with this  planning metadata    1 This can be set as the clip name  see page 155      To scroll hidden parts of the string into view    When a  lt  or  gt  mark is displayed for an item  you can  press the   IN or    OUT button to scroll the display  by one character for each press    The   MARK1 and V MARK2 buttons scroll the  beginning and end of the string into view     To return to the previous screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To clear planning metadata    See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Clear Planning Metadata  and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A message appears asking if you are sure that you want  to clear the plannning metadata     3 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     The planning metadata is cleared from this unit   s  memory     To switch the title display in the display  window  When planning metadata is loaded into this unit  you can    select the format of the title to display in the display  win
56.  General and User Data  directories  and so on   operate after establishing a FAM or  FTP connection  see page 106                                                      Local host  this unit     sEIEGdgsoo    a  The following software requirements must be satisfied     An FTP server function must be available     Service  Version 7 0 or higher      nthe case of Macintosh  Mac OS X Version 10 5 6 or higher        Upload clip  put     Download clip  get            nthe case of Windows  Microsoft Window IIS  Internet Information                                                                 Material server    Remote host             Preparations for clip transfers    Check the following points      This unit must be connected over a network to the  transfer target device  XDCAM device or computer       The transfer target device  XDCAM device or  computer  must be supplied with stable power  and the  power must not be turned off during the transfer  For  battery powered devices  the batteries must have  sufficient remaining capacity       The settings under maintenance menu item M5   NETWORK must be set to values that allow network  connections      The remote control switch must be set to NET      For XDCAM devices that support UPnP  universal plug  and play   the UPnP function must be enabled  the  setting may vary      Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function        SueeJoS  MH ui suonejedo 9G Jeydeuj    99          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedQ  s JaydeyD    100    To enable the U
57.  H  andlirig  DISCS    niano RR IE ERR eB bown QUE UO CE LC DE RR ainaani 52    Discs used for recording and playback                                sess 52  INotes on Handling sacs ed ede p odi n ls vo RSEN o oon 52  Wiite protecting CASCS x osuere tore a t P VIR aes 53  Loading and unloading a disc                             esee 53  Formatting ANSE sd oen edi aa tdt v a adieu adh 53       Chapter 4 Recording and Playback    PREC ONCIING M 54  Mixed recording of clips in different formats on the same disc            54  Preparations for recording Jeden or oo raf fert p Pe exe EN Ree eR beh 54  COryme oubTecOrtd Hb  ecco desde meg ep dose END water  55  Continuing recording while exchanging discs  disc exchange cache   FUNCTION jenean a a A Uds 56  Recording with the HDSDI remote control function                            57  Recording with the Clip Continuous Rec function                              57  Using the Live Logging function                   eeeeeeeeeeeeereennn 58  Handling of discs when recording does not end normally  salvage   Tti cons  Se eee Ie NEN Hen 58   Linear ECU G RETTULIT LIT II 60   OVeEVIBW  Lis e o eae aa heed oat ered Joe eoe ota issicd ic eos 60  CONMECCUONS coca tod esi eia ess 61  Preparations for editing    esset recs t ve aeta k iR ae reg O eA 61  Editing operations te snc tUe UMass dtu t D Debido Et bns 62   Play ir  e m                        63  Playback operation    eiii teni ite ne ede tee re dE e Re Re to NES RE VERE Dave SERE dS 64 
58.  HD1500  this unit     PDW 700                                                                               To SDI OUT 1 connector To SD HDSDI INPUT    connector                   75Q coaxial cable  not supplied        PDW 700  camcorder   setting    HDSDI REMOTE I F on  page CAM CONFIG 1 of    Settings on this unit    Remote control switch   REMOTE  see page 18        the MAINTENANCE menu     other than OFF Setup menu item 214    REMOTE INTERFACE  SDI                Connections and Settings       suoneiedejgd e Jaydeyup    41          suonejedejg e jejdeuj    42       Synchronization Reference Signals    The synchronization reference signal generator of this unit  synchronizes to a reference signal input to the REF   VIDEO INPUT connector or to a video input signal   External synchronization is as follows  depending on the    setting of OUT REF on page P6 REF of the function menu   and on the type of the selected input signal  Video output  signals are always synchronized to the internal  synchronization signal                                Input to SD HDSDI Input to REF  VIDEO Setting of OUT REF on page P6 REF P   INPUT connector 9  INPUT connector REF INPUT   Yes Yes Synchronize to the signal input to   Synchronize to the signal input to  the REF  VIDEO INPUT connector   the SD HDSDI INPUT connector   Yes No Synchronize to the signal input to the SD HDSDI INPUT connector   No Yes Synchronize to the signal input to the REF  VIDEO INPUT connector   No No No external synchr
59.  HDSDI signals   down convert playback  you can also play and output EIA   page 178  or  To record EIA 608 B standard closed    608 standard closed caption data     caption data in HDSDI signals   page 178      However  settings are required for output of ELA 608  standard closed caption data by down convert playback         HDSDI  VANC  output  EIA 608             EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output    Down convert playback       Internal processing by this unit    Cross convert playback of HD discs containing EIA 608 data only  When 1080 or 720 clips are played after cross conversion    EIA 608 standard closed caption data recorded in the clips   is played and output without conversion  By performing   down convert playback  you can also play and output EIA     608 standard closed caption data     However  settings are required for output of ELA 608    standard closed caption data     For details  see  To record and playback EIA 708 B  standard closed caption data in HDSDI signals    page 178  or  To record EIA 608 B standard closed  caption data in HDSDI signals   page 178      Ancillary Data       1080 clip        Down convert  playback       720 clip    Cross convert  and playback    Down convert  playback    Internal processing by this unit                     HDSDI  VANC  output  1080 playback    EIA 608    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output    Composite  line 21  output    HDSDI  VANC  output  720 playback    EIA 608    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  ou
60.  HV RATIO Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the horizontal vertical ratio  for edge enhancement   0to3to7   a   HD1500  When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed  To enable display of the extended menu    Proceed as follows to use the maintenance menu        Extended menu operations    The extended menu can be used with the same procedures    as in the basic menu     However  since with the factory default settings the    1 Holding down the PAGE HOME button and the  SHIFT button  press the MENU button     The maintenance menu appears on the video monitor  display     extended menu is not displayed  it is first necessary to  enable display of the extended menu     Setup Menu          MAINTENANCE MENU  MO  CHECK  gt   M1  ADJUST    SERUICE SUPPORT  M3 QTHERS   MA SETUP MAINENANCE  MS NETWORK   M6  DRIVE       N             2 Tumthe PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select  M4  SETUP MAINTENANCE   then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob or the SELECT function button   F2      The sub items of M4  SETUP MAINTENANCE  appears        MAINTENANCE MENU  MA SETUP MAINTENANCE   lt M40 EXTEND MENU  dis  gt   MAO CUSTOMIZE   dis  M46 MENU DATA CONTROL  M47  SETUP BANK4  M48 AUTO RECALL  off  M49 RESET ALL SETUP          3 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    M40  EXTENDED MENU     then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob or the SELECT function button        F2    The setting screen for M40  EXTENDED MENU  appears    MAINTENANCE MENU  M4 SETUP MAINTENANCE   MAO EXTEND MENU  dis 
61.  However  if you change the setting from    clip  continuous rec   the setting change is enabled after the  end of Clip Continuous Rec mode recording     3 Exchange the disc     Recording    When recording on the current disc ends  the disc is  ejected  Until the next disc is inserted  the unit records  to its internal cache memory  Then  after the new disc  is inserted  it copies the data from the cache to the disc  and resumes normal recording     Disc exchange cache indications and their  meanings       Indication Meaning    Right side of icon  flashes once per  second    Recording to the cache       Left side of icon  flashes twice per  second    Remaining memory capacity  Low       Whole icon flashes  four times per  second    Remaining memory capacity   None  disc full                  C  indications in superimposed text information  and their meanings       Indication Meaning       C    flashes once  per second    Recording to the cache        C  flashes twice  per second    Remaining memory capacity  Low       An alarm message  appears instead of  IOn    Remaining memory capacity   None  disc full                 To stop disc exchange cache recording   Do any of the following during cache recording      Press the STOP button      Set setup menu item 150 REC MODE to    normal           fthe disc becomes full while setup menu item 150 REC  MODE is set to    disc exchange cache   the disc is  ejected and the unit continues to record to its internal  memory  for about 30 
62.  INHI  recording inhibit  indicator   This lights in the following cases      When a disc with recording inhibited is loaded      When REC INH on the HOME page of the function  menu is set to    ON          The format of the recorded part of the disc does not  match the system frequency settings of the unit        Display window    Basic operation display       Q Audio input display   Audio level meters                   DATA                  Function menu       Clip information       Recording format             Time data display area    a  The mixing display appears only on the PDW F1600   see the following figure         12 34 47          Q Disc information      System information    Format conversion                    ULICIL INI PRESET    R               Reference signal      Video input display          Q Audio input display Audio level meters  Displays information about audio  There are two display  modes for the audio level meter  FULL mode and FINE    mode  which can be switched over using AU METER on  page P4 AUDIO of the function menu        Meter display mode  FULL       Input signal display           B  Data indication    nara nara  CS PS Se Be       l     e        1 1 l  0 AU N  GG        COUT     E   wy  w          Level bar   EF  Reference level   E  Audio channel     Monitor channel  F1600             Mixing          Meter display mode  FINE      Meter display mode                   DATA DATA  CS BSE Se Tw                   Front Panel       seq Jo suonoun J 
63.  JOG buttons alternately     To repeat playback in variable mode   Set setup menu item 142 REPEAT MODE to    play  amp   VAR fwd    or    force       This allows you to perform repeat playback  limited to  variable playback in the forward direction in the range 0 to   2 times normal speed     To perform manual frame sync playback    During playback  you can adjust the playback output phase  in units of one frame  To do so  hold down the PLAY  button and turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob in either  direction    To speed up the phase  Turn clockwise    To delay the phase  Turn counterclockwise        Playback operations using  thumbnails    Playback operations that you can perform with thumbnails  include searching for clips  displaying clip information   playing clip lists created with the scene selection function   and locking and deleting clip  This allows you to check the  actual video as you work     See  Thumbnail Operations   page 76  for more  information about thumbnail operations  and  Scene  Selection  Clip List Editing    page 87  for more  information about the scene selection function     Playback       xXoeg e g pue Buipiooeu v 1e deu    67    Operations in GUI  Screens    Chapter       Overview    You can perform scene searches  play the searched scenes   and select scenes  edit clip list  in Graphical User Interface   GUI  screens  The GUI screens are your gateways to discs  and the data saved on discs      The GUI screens can display European languages   Japanese 
64.  Korean  Simplified Chinese  and Traditional  Chinese for clip names and titles               SU9919S  MD ui suoneiedo  s 1e1deu    68    Switching between GUI screens    The most important GUI screens are    Clip thumbnail screen  displays thumbnails of clips on  the disc     Clip    is displayed as the title at the upper  left of the screen  see page 69     Clip list thumbnail screen  displays thumbnails of sub  clips in a clip list   Clip List  is displayed as the title  at the upper left of the screen  see page 69      There are also two playback screens    Clip playback screen  playback screen for normal video   Clip list playback screen  playback screen for clip list  video    You will use the THUMBNAIL button   and the SUB  CLIP DISC MENU button   to switch between these  four screens  Each press of these buttons switches between  the screens as shown in the following figure  The  THUMBNAIL and SUB CLIP DISC MENU indicators  light as follows  according to the type of screen that is  currently displayed     To switch between these four screens  a disc with recorded  clips must be loaded in the unit     Overview       Clip playback screen 9                 0e  e0       Clip list playback screen 9  D    TCR 00 00 18 01  SHUTTLE STILL  F0008   003 005    THUMBNAIL  oS Je unit  SUB CLIP I  6   L  Hoe ut  DISC MENU             a  Playback screens appear when you switch to video monitor display  Use the DISPLAY button to switch from the basic monitor    display to video monit
65.  OUTPUT in setup menu item 731 is set to  auto  and  the VITC insertion line is set to line 20        In 50i 50P 25P  mode    Select the line into which to insert VITC signals  SD output   9H     19H     22H  Any line from line 9 through line 22     You can insert VITC signals in two places  To insert in two places  set  both item 601 and item 602        602    VITC POSITION  SEL 2 9    In 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P mode    Select the line into which to insert VITC signals  SD output   12H     18H     20H  Any line from line 12 through line 20       You can insert VITC signals in two places  To insert in two places  set  both item 601 and item 602       n 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode  J   output of wide picture information is  given priority if OUTPUT in setup menu item 731 is setto  auto  and the  VITC insertion line is set to line 16      In 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode  UC   output of wide picture information  is given priority if OUTPUT in setup menu item 731 is set to  auto  and  the VITC insertion line is set to line 20           In 50i 50P 25P  mode    Select the line into which to insert VITC signals  SD output   9H     21H     22H  Any line from line 9 through line 22     You can insert VITC signals in two places  To insert in two places  set  both item 601 and item 602        605    TCG REGEN MODE    Select the signal to be regenerated when the timecode generator is in the  regeneration mode    TC amp UB  Both the timecode and user bits are regenerated    TC  Only the timecod
66.  Playback operations using thumbnails                              eee 66       Chapter 5 Operations in GUI Screens    jl T                       68  Switching between GUI screens  toe orte S IRSE ERRRT NN IERDREUMAR 68  Information and controls in thumbnail screens                          sssess 69  Displayine qe ls   stes osea opel Ae up apad vei e  72  GUI screen GperatlOBs unosi oot ere ore percitus S aita d 75   Thumbnail Operations                                     eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee eren 76  Selecting t  humbinalls od eor aee Rug as redis SR as sede Baten 76  Searching with thumbnalls     a itoeet o re eR RR E RIHR OS IA eEMQR UTE 77  Playing the scene you have found                       sese 79  Selecting clips by type  Filter Clips function     79    Table of Contents    7    Selecting the information displayed on thumbnails                              8l    Changing Clip index pices    oce ues dco tope tes eene eee ee pant nets 8l  CHECKING Clips  PROPS IES oc od d pO ee Gee ec eo e cU A s 82  sette cip flags  dedu pre out a a ENS e Pu Voi OR uve eU Uds uds 84  Locking  write protecting  clips                      essere 85  Deletmngelpsscosodeode esas wera ast istis tuu tenta antes b aet mtd 85  Scene Selection  Clip List Editing                                                 87  What is scene selection  cu ceo eode nea ona ieri aca eda ns 87  Creating and editing clip lists                          esee 88  Managing Clip  sts   oed eese ene Ee dy I ERE a
67.  S RUE Uses 92  DISC en rcu              aiaia 94  Checking disc properties    eee niece mite ette etur Re e RE dire 94  Using planning metadata    oie e resur etate ete dst ae Pee Rog Ve 94  Checking user defined essence marks                            eese 96  Formatting disces 5 eti eret EIUS ae ERE GENRE CHASE R EAR dede 96  Displaying disc and clip properties in a web browser                          96  Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function                                       99  Preparations for clip transfers    99  Uploading Clips  oeste tesis iati due e PONES D RE a eed AaS 100  Downloading eps su ue tea eiat eno e e tee eee ee acs Rast ene 103  Copying clips directly between XDCAM devices                              104  Shortcut LIST  iion crisp Eco REEF eiaa IN MR EUR Eo Pa De RUNS RRR GB RE E   105       Chapter 6 File Operations    rT nup M 106  Directory  SUP CUTS o esos on con itsabistensed T eicit nola 106  File operation YeSteloHODS eiren ote a se eti a 107  Assigning user defined clip titles                         eeeeeeeeeees 110  Assigning user defined clip and clip list names                                  111   File Operations in File Access Mode  for Windows                   113  Making FAM connections                 eeeeeeseeeeseeeeee eene enne nennen 113  Operating on leS Lus seno e oC ORI le tea sedo qe uo Lucano Notas 114  Exiting file operations    2 e ore eterne Mu Sae e spore ke en de t rea Ure ge gun 114   File Operations in File Ac
68.  SD REF  SD format reference signal    The HD REF or SD REF display flashes when the video  input signal is not synchronized to the reference signal  and  when the signals are synchronized but their phases do not  match      D Video input display   This displays the currently selected video input signal   HDSDI  HDSDI video input   SDSDI  SDSDI video input   i LINK  i LINK TS  HDV  input P   SG  Test video signal from the internal signal generator    1  When the PDBK 201 option board is installed    The display blinks when there is no video input signal  and  when the video input signal does not match the system  frequency of this unit     The video signal input is selected with V INPUT on page  P1 VIDEO of the function menu  see page 49      Video monitor display         amp  Audio level meters          TCR 00 45 39 18Xx       JOG STILL        B Superimposed information       Recording mode indication        B  Low battery warning     Converter display             When you press the DISPLAY button  the display window   changes to the video monitor display        Audio level meters  LEVEL MT on page P2 AUDIO  of the function menu decides whether the meter is to  be displayed and on which side  left or right  it is  displayed in the display window    Superimposed information  Appears when CHAR  SEL on the HOME page of the function menu is set to   ON  or  LCD        Recording mode indication  This appears when setup  menu item 150 REC MODE is set to    disc exchange  cache  or
69.  SD converter output to 13 9        932    H CROP POSITION  DC     Adjust the H crop  the horizontal position when cropping in the edge crop  mode  of the down converter output when menu item 930 is set to  crop       120 to 0 to 120       934    CROSS COLOR  DO     Adjust the down converter cross color   0 to 8 to 15       935    DETAIL GAIN  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  the sharpness of edge  enhancement   0 to 7FH       936    LIMITER  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  the maximum detail level  added to emphasize the original signal   0 to 20H to 3FH       937    CRISP  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  the threshold amplitude at  which low amplitude signals are not emphasized   0 to FH       938    LEVEL DEPEND THRESHOLD  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  Set the luminance range for  edge enhancement   0 to 8 to FH       939    H DETAIL FREQUENCY  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  Set the central frequency for  edge enhancement   2 6MHz  3 4MHz  3 9MHz  4 6MHz                snus  4 Ja deup    144    940    H V RATIO  DC     Adjust the down converter image enhancer  Set the horizontal vertical  ratio for edge enhancement   0to3to7       942    V FILTER SELECT  DC     Setthe vertical interpolation filter coefficient for down converter output  in  1080 mode only    1to3       943    CROSS COLOR CRISP  DC     Set the cross color crisp level for down converter output   0 to 4 to FH       944    LE
70.  Sicherheitsvorschriften  die im betreffenden Land gelten    2  Verwenden Sie ein Netzkabel  3 adriges Stromkabel  einen  Ger  teanschluss einen Stecker mit den geeigneten  Anschlusswerten  Volt  Ampere      Wenn Sie Fragen zur Verwendung von Netzkabel   Ger  teanschluss Stecker haben  wenden Sie sich bitte an  qualifiziertes Kundendienstpersonal     F  r Kunden in Europa   Der Hersteller dieses Produkts ist Sony Corporation  1 7 1  Konan  Minato ku  Tokyo  Japan    Der autorisierte Repr  sentant f  r EMV und Produktsicherheit  ist Sony Deutschland GmbH  Hedelfinger Strasse 61  70327  Stuttgart  Deutschland  Bei jeglichen Angelegenheiten in  Bezug auf Kundendienst oder Garantie wenden Sie sich bitte  an die in den separaten Kundendienst  oder  Garantiedokumenten aufgef  hrten Anschriften     5    6       Table of Contents       Chapter 1 Overview    Marks for Model Specific Functions                                              11  uunc                                            11  beatures Of tis Ult e ir ra eS aen a E REGAT E OUS ER 11  System Configurations               1 0  6a ris xor tu aa cun iaa no cada ao pana uan 15  Using the CD ROM Manual                              cceeeeeeee eere 16  Preparations PI           P 16  Reading the CD ROM 13anudal    deep veas ERROR eise a DO edd 16       Chapter 2 Names and Functions of Parts    Eront Pa  riel      EE E E AAE eic oce ve eazast cH d e cEes Y eds eo Cada OR eEN IE eU CEOs eve 17  Display  Windows eda pera san oa gee
71.  Sub items of maintenance menu item M3B0  VANC RX  PACKET    LINE  line for the VANC to be received   9LINE   example     DID  data identification word   61h    SDID  secondary data identification word   02h    To record EIA 608 B standard closed caption  data in SDSDI line 21 signals after conversion to  the EIA 708 B standard  Set the following items     Sub items of maintenance menu item M3B0  VANC RX  PACKET    LINE  line for the VANC to be received   9LINE   example     Ancillary Data      DID  data identification word   61h    SDID  secondary data identification word   01h     V INPUT on function menu page P1 VIDEO  SDSDI     Setup menu item 031 RECORDING FORMAT  HD422   420HQ  or 420SP    VANC packets    The Japanese ARIB TR B23 standard limits the number  of packets that can be multiplexed into HDSDI to 4  packets per line    The number of VANC packets that can be recorded that  is set using maintenance menu item M3B is limited to 9  packets per frame for 50P or 59 94P mode and 18  packets per frame for other modes    When VANC packets are not continuous from word 0   and there is unused area on the line  then information  about the packet position is not recorded  Packets are  output flush left    During input  if a parity error is detected in a VANC  packet  the packet is discarded and recorded flush left        Ancillary data in MXF files    VANC ancillary data recorded from a HDSDI signal can  be inserted to an MXF file as an ANC Frame Element   conforming to the 
72.  TC 00 00 00 00 TC 00 00 04 14 TC 00 00 12 04     WIL IFAs    TC 00 00 28 08 TC 00 00 35 15 TC 00 00 46 08 TC 00 00 53 22     E i     POs iai   TC 00 00 59 16 TC 00 01 06 18 TC 00 01 13 11 TC 00 01 17 27   DATE amp TIME 28 JUL 2006 19 55 00 01 31 16    Disc Menu    Load Clip List  gt   Save Clip List    Save Clip List as      Delete Clip List   Clear Clip List   Load Planning Metadata Select Drive  Planning Metadata Properties   Clear Planning Metadata   o or Delete All Clips    002 013              TC 00 00 20 13          GUI screen operations                                                                         Q PUSH SET S SEL  knob       IN     OUT button        MARK1     MARK2 button     Jog and shuttle dials   Q RESET RETURN button   Q SHIFT button             To select items    Do one of the following to select thumbnails  menu items    timecode digits  and other items      Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob      Turn the jog or shuttle dial      Press the   MARKI     MARK2    IN or   OUT  button      Press the PREV or NEXT button      With the SHIFT button held down  press the PREV or  NEXT button  to move to the first or last item       With the SHIFT button held down  press the   MARK1  or V MARK2 button  to move to the previous or next    page      To select multiple thumbnails    Do one of the following     Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob with the SHIFT  button held down      With the SHIFT button held down  press the   IN or     OUT button     To return to the previou
73.  Text Information       suonejedejgd e je deu    47       Basic Operations of the  Function Menu    The function menu provides access to frequently used  settings  such as input video signal selection and timecode  settings    Menu settings are stored in nonvolatile memory and are  preserved even after the unit is powered off              suonejedejg e Jaydeyo    48    Function menu operations    The function menu appears on the color LCD of this unit   The following figure shows the buttons  numbered 1 to 6  beginning at the top  used in function menu operations        Function buttons  1 to 6        Function menu    PUSH SET S SEL                             w01 500 001 001  000 00 li 5   TL 0t  T    L 4  12 34 47  12       TCS SET                   ud  i PUSH SET S SEL  knob  DISPLAY button    PAGE HOME button             To display the function menu   The function menu is made up of the HOME page and  pages P1 to P7   P8  P   HOME2  P    If the function menu is not already visible  press the  PAGE HOME button to display it   The most recently    accessed function menu page appears    1  If a menu item is assigned using maintenance menu item M38  F KEY  CONFIG    To display a different page   Each press of the PAGE HOME button displays the next  function menu page in the order  HOME     gt P1     P2      P3     P4     P5     P6     P7      P8       HOME2  P      HOME       1  If a menu item is assigned using maintenance menu item M38  F KEY  CONFIG    Turning the PUSH SET 
74.  This appears when an attempt is made to preset          LOGGING        timecode or establish a FAM or FTP connection while  the Live Logging function is set to Live View mode        a  Displayed only when setup menu item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to     on      b  Displayed only when setup menu item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to       on    or    limit        Troubleshooting       During recording and editing operations       Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen    Description action                            FOR MORE RECORDING  DELETE  SOME CLIPS     Input Sig     9 VIDEO INPUT SIGNAL DOES NOT This appears when the signal that does not  MATCH SYSTEM SETUP  correspond to the system frequency or the number of  lines set in this unit is being input  or when HDSDI or  i LINK TS is selected as a video input signal while  setting the SD signal recording   Input a signal that matches the system frequency  or  change this unit s system frequency setting  see  page 43    ILL  REC  9 ENCODING DOES NOT SYNCHRONIZE   Check the signals being input to this unit   WITH REF VIDEO   ILL  REF  9 INPUT VIDEO SIGNAL DOES NOT Input a reference signal synchronized with this unit s  SYNCHRONIZE WITH REF VIDEO system frequency   SIGNAL   USE COMMON REFERENCE SIGNAL  OR CONNECT RECORDER REF OUT TO  PLAYER REF IN    MEM  Full  9 MEMORY FULL    Check the disc being recorded by this unit    Verify ERR  DISC ERROR DETECTED  This appears when an error is found 
75.  To check the automatically acquired address of DNS server 1  close the maintenance  menu and then open it again        M58  DNS2    Set the address of DNS server 2   000 000 000 000      The address of DNS server 2 cannot be set when DHCP is set to    ENABLE        To check the automatically acquired address of DNS server 2  close the maintenance  menu and then open it again        M59  UPnP    Select whether to enable the UPnP  universal plug and play  function   DISABLE  Disable the UPnP function   ENABLE  Enable the UPnP function        M5F  RESET NET CONFIG          Reset network settings to the factory defaults   SAVE function button  F5   Reset   MENU button  Return to the next highest menu level without executing the reset        a  A jumbo frame is a frame larger than the maximum 1514 bytes  not The maintenance menu appears on the video monitor    including FCS  of the standard Ethernet frame  Jumbo frames make it  possible to deliver larger payloads per packet  Since fewer packets need to    display and the currently set menu item is displayed in    be routed  packet processing overhead is lower and network throughput is reverse video   potentially improved   Note that this item is enabled only when LINK  SPEED is set to  1000Mbps   For it to work  all other devices that handle                packets on the network must also support jumbo frames   Meanings of indications on the menu  screen  Maintenance menu operations On screen indication Meaning  i     s     Right
76.  a compact  lightweight body for easy portability  outdoors  and can be powered from any of three power  sources  AC  DC  or battery 4 power     1  Professional Disc is a trademark of Sony Corporation   2  FAM  File access mode   3  This unit does not support DV stream output    4  BKP L551 Battery Adaptor is required        Features of this unit    The principal features of this unit are as follows     MPEG HD422    codec    High quality video and audio recording and  playback   The MPEG HD422 codec provides video compression  compliant with the MPEG 2 422P Q HL standard  It  enables HD 4 2 2  50 Mbps  digital component file  recording in the 10801  1 080 effective scanning lines   interlaced  or 720P  720 effective scanning lines   progressive  format currently in use by many broadcast  facilities     11    Marks for Model Specific Functions   Features       MOeIAJOAQ   Je deUD       M8IAJOAQ   1e1deuo    12    Uncompressed PCM recording of 24 bit 48 kHz audio  enables 8 channel audio recording at high sound quality     1  MPEG HD422 is a trademark of Sony Corporation     Long recording times   PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 supports dual layer  Professional Discs  50 GB   When dual layer Professional  Discs are used  this unit can record about 95 minutes     Recording and playback functions    Support for multiple SD and HD codecs   In addition to the MPEG HD422 codec  this unit supports  the MPEG HD codec  It can record HD 4 2 0 digital  component files at both 10801  35 25 18 M
77.  abandon the resetting operation   Instead of pressing the SAVE function button  F5    press the RESET RETURN button  The display  returns to the top level of the setup menu  leaving the  settings unchanged     To customize the display of setup menu  items    You can select the menu items displayed in the setup  menu     1 Set maintenance menu item M41  CUSTOMIZE to     ENABLE        See page 152 for information about how to use the  maintenance menu     2 Hold down the MENU button for about three seconds     The SETUP CUSTOMIZE screen appears     SETUP CUSTOMIZE   HO1 OPE HOURS    HO2 LASERO     LASER1   OPE HOURS r    SEEK HOURSOr      SPDL HOURS r    LOAD COUNT r    SEEK HOURS1 r    P ROLL TIME    CHARA H POS     CHARA U POS         Setup Menu       3 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob so that the         mark  appears next to the item you want to hide or display in  the setup menu     SETUP CUSTOMIZE   H01 0PE HOURS      LASERO     LASER1     OPE HOURS r    SEEK HOURSOr      SPDL HOURS r    LOAD COUNT r    SEEK HOURS1r    P ROLL TIME     CHBRA H POS    CHARA U POS         You can press the UP function button  F3  or the  DOWN function button  F4  to move the         mark by  100 menu items     4 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A setting screen for the currently selected item  appears     RETURN  CUSTOM ITEM H13    SEEK RUNNING HOURS 0   resettable     on       5 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    on    or   off      on  Display the item in the setup menu   off  Do n
78.  asingle line with a CRLF only after the last character in the  statement line  and do not enter spaces except where  specified  except within essence mark name strings        sp indicates a space and   indicates       Setting volume labels by using  planning metadata    If you read planning metadata that contains a volume label  into the unit s memory  the volume label is set in  UserDiscID in DISCMETA XML when recording of the  first clip finishes  1     1  If recording of the first clip does not end normally  the volume label is set  in UserDiscID if you restore the clip by using the salvage function     See page 155 for more information about how to load files     Volume labels cannot be set in UserDiscID in the   following cases      When a clip has been written by a FAM or FTP  connection     When another volume label is already set in UserDiscID  in DISCMETA XML   In this case  we recommend that you use one of the  following to change the existing volume label to the  name that you want     The software keyboard screen  see page 94     PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software    You can also use the above tools to erase the existing  volume label before reading the planning metadata  This  makes it possible to set a new volume label by reading  the planning metadata  However  the setting is reflected  to DISCMETA XML only when recording of the first  clip finishes     How to specify volume labels    Using a text editor  enter an ASCII or UTF 8 format string   up to 127 bytes in l
79.  be used by XDCAM devices without this mark     Professional Disc       Notes on handling    Handling   The Professional Disc is housed in a cartridge  and is   designed to allow handling free of risk from dust or   fingerprints  However  if the cartridge is subjected to a   severe shock  for example by dropping it  this can result in   damage or scratching of the disc  If the disc is scratched  it   may be impossible to record video audio  or to play back   the content recorded on the disc  The discs should be   handled and stored carefully      Do not touch the surface of the disc itself within the  cartridge      Deliberately opening the shutter may cause damage      Do not disassemble the cartridge      The supplied adhesive labels are recommended for  indexing discs  Apply the label in the correct position     Storage     Do not store discs where they may be subjected to direct  sunlight  or in other places where the temperature or  humidity is high      Do not leave cartridges where dust may get inside      Store cartridges in their cases     Care of the discs    Remove dust and dirt on the outside of a cartridge using  a soft dry cloth        f condensation forms  allow ample time to dry before  use     MODE KEY ENABLE DURING RECORDING to   stop         Write protecting discs    To protect the content recorded on the disc from accidental  erasure  move the Write Inhibit tab on the lower surface of  the disc in the direction of the arrow  as shown in the  following figu
80.  been recorded on the basis of  a specified planning metadata entry  and transfer those  clips to an external device using the Direct FTP function   see page 99      To filter clips    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Display the clip thumbnail screen     2 If you want to select clips by video format  select the  thumbnails of clips in that format     3 Display the Thumbnail menu     4 Select  Filter Clips   and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Filter Clips screen appears     Filter Clips    Select Filter Condition  Clip Flag  OK  Clip GE  Clip Flag     P KEEP    Clip Flag  none   Current Planning Metadata   PM_001_sample   AV Format of Selected Clip    meesIr  1080SP 4ch    D select the clip filtering condition                 Item name Filtering condition   Clip Flag  OK Clip flag set in the clip  OK NG   Clip Flag  NG KP KEEP  none    Clip Flag    KP KEEP    Clip Flag  none          Current Planning  Metadata    Clips that have been recorded  according to the instructions in the  currently loaded planning  metadata       AN Format of Video format of the selected clips             Selected Clip       6 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A filter thumbnail screen appears  showing only clips  that meet the specified condition    The filtering condition appears at the lower left of the  screen     Thumbnail Operations    005 005    5    AE    NG zu    TC 00 24 45 11 TC 00 25 06 14    Filter C0010    A 7      y Li  a a   NG N
81.  can start shuttle playback by  simply rotating the shuttle dial  even when the SHTL   JOG button is not lit     To alternate between normal speed playback and  shuttle mode playback   Set the shuttle dial to the position corresponding to the  desired shuttle playback speed  then switch between  normal speed playback and shuttle playback by pressing  the PLAY and SHTL JOG buttons alternately     Playback in variable speed mode    In variable speed mode  you can control the speed of  playback in the range of    2 to  2 times normal speed   You  can use setup menu item 119 VARIABLE SPEED LIMIT  IN KEY to specify the speed range of variable playback    To carry out playback in variable speed mode  proceed as  follows     Playback                                                     aues    R  il  E                                                 oO  ToP    FREV7 UF FWD END osi   upsv onec IH           3 2 3 1  1 Press the VAR JOG button  turning it on     2 Tum the shuttle dial to the desired angle  corresponding to the desired playback speed     Playback in variable speed mode starts     3 To stop playback in variable speed mode  return the  shuttle dial to the center position  or press the STOP  button     To alternate between normal speed playback and  variable speed mode playback   Set the shuttle dial to the position corresponding to the  desired variable playback speed  then switch between  normal speed playback and variable speed mode playback  by pressing the PLAY and VAR
82.  clips  Sub clips are generated for each of the clips in the  range     To check the newly added sub clips  You can check the newly added sub clips by  displaying the clip list thumbnail screen     4 Repeat steps 1 to 3 as required to add more sub clips     D Save the clip list  see page 92      To reorder sub clips    When this unit is in single clip playback mode  see  page 78   only the selected sub clip can be played     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip list thumbnail screen  select the thumbnails  of the sub clips that you want to move  multiple  selections possible      2 Display the Thumbnail Menu        Select Move Sub Clips  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Clip List  Move  screen appears     006 m 001 034  X    a  TC 00 04 13 14    Clip List  Move     TC 00 00 21 27    TC 00 04 06 00    iret Ft    TC 00 04 35 12 TC 00 04 57 10 TC 00 05 41 05    TC 00 06 03 03 TC 00 06 25 00 TC 00 06 46 27 TC 00 07 08 25  DATE amp TIME 08 AUG 2007 11 50 00 13 48 24    4 Move the I cursor to the point where you want to move  the selected thumbnails     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing        5 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The sub clips are moved to the I cursor position   6 Repeat steps 1 to 5 as required     T Savethe clip list  see page 92      To adjust the In and Out points of sub clips   trim    Proceed as follows to define the range of a scene by  changing the positions of the In and Out points     See 
83.  connected to the DC IN  12V connector on the rear panel  this switches the unit  between the operating state  the indicator is lit green  and  the standby state  the indicator is lit red     When the indicator is lit red  pressing the button switches  this unit to the operating state  and the indicator lights  continuously green    When the indicator is lit green  pressing the button  switches the unit to the standby state  and the indicator    lights continuously red  If a disc is loaded in the unit  the  indicator flashes before changing to continuously lit red   When using this unit  normally leave the rear panel  POWER switch in the I  on  position  and use this button  to switch the unit between the operating state and standby  state        ACCESS indicator   This lights when the disc is accessed and when a file is  opened by a FAM or FTP connection  see page 106   If the  on standby button is pressed while this indicator is lit     Front Panel    17       Sud Jo suonounJ pue seweN z Jedeuo          Sed Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jeldeup    18    access to the disc is completed before the unit switches to  the standby state     While the ACCESS indicator is lit  do not turn off the  POWER switch on the rear panel or disconnect the power  cord  This could lead to a loss of data from the disc     Q Remote control switch   Different positions of the switch allow different operations   as follows    NET  Enables access to the network  The indicator lights  when an external net
84.  connector        759 coaxial cable  not supplied        p       I               9 pin remote control cable  not supplied          HDSDI OUTPUT 2          PDW                                  PDW F1600 SD HDSDI   recorder  INPUT                                                 gt         HD1500  player     Reference video signal        REMOTE 9P   RECORDER DEVICE2                                                                              HDSDI  To HDSDI input     gUTPUT2      connector  SUPER                                HD video monitor                REFVIDEO RM 280  INPUT  editing  controller   REF VIDEO REMOTE 9P  REF IN OUT  RECORDER DEVICE1              PDW F1600  recorder  settings  Remote control switch  REMOTE    RM 280  editing controller  settings    EDITOR REMOTE CONTROL selector  switch  EDITOR    PDW HD1500  player  settings    Remote control switch  REMOTE  see  page 18        Setup menu item 214 REMOTE  INTERFACE  9PIN    Setup menu 01 PREROLL  5s    Setup menu item 214 REMOTE  INTERFACE  9PIN       Function menu page P1 VIDEO  gt V  INPUT  HD SDI    Setup menu 05 SYNC SEL  ON       Function menu pages P2 and P3 AUDIO   gt A1 to A8 INPUT  SDI    Setup menu 06 SYNC VTR   RECORDER       Function menu page P5 TC  gt TCG  INT    Setup menu 09 EDIT DLY   7       Function menu page P5 TC  gt PRST   RGN  PRESET    Setup menu 10 R ST DLY AUTO          Function menu page P5 TC  gt RUN  MODE  FREE RUN       Setup menu 11 P ST DLY AUTO          Connections and Setting
85.  control panel functions  video and audio control  and  digital data processing     Configuration of the basic menu  The basic menu comprises the following groups of items              Item group   Function Refer to  Items Display of the total number of   page 159  H01 to H17 hours the unit has been  powered on  and other  information collected by the  digital hours meter  Items Settings relating to the preroll   page 124  001 to 099 time  superimposed text  information  switching between  59 94i 59 94P 29 97P and 50i   50P 25P 23 98P modes  etc   Items Settings relating to the menu   page 127  B01 to B20 banks for saving menu settings                   Configuration of the extended menu  The extended menu comprises the following groups of  items     Menu System Configuration   Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    123                                                          Item group Function Refer to Item group Function Refer to   7 7 It tti lating to th 1  Items Settings relating to control page 131 SOT 650 NDA a j page 136  100 to 199 panels       It tti lating to th 137  Items Settings relating to the remote   page 133 eee 699 e ATUM S page 13  200 to 299 control interface       E It tti lating to vi 1  Items Settings relating to editing page 134 Sah   799 dn relatingto video page 139  300 to 399 operations       It tti lating t i 141  Items Settings relating to preroll page 135 BOOTS 899 den relatingto audio page  400 to 499         Items Settings relating to digital p
86.  deletion target clip is referenced in the current clip  list  only those referencing sub clips are deleted at the  same time as the deletion target clip     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of  the clip that you want to delete     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 select Delete Clip     A window appears asking you to confirm the deletion    The window displays thumbnails of four frames from   the target clip  the first frame  two intermediate   frames  and the last frame   along with the name  title1    date of creation  and duration of the clip    One of the following messages also appears    depending on whether the clip is referenced in a clip   list      When the clip is not referenced in a clip list      Delete Clip        When the clip is referenced in a clip list     Delete  Clip  amp  Clip List   All clip lists that reference the  target clip are deleted along with the clip      Delete Clip  amp  Clip List 022 036    INDEX MIDDLE1 MIDDLE2   gt   gt   gt     TC 00 25 30 22 TC 00 25 31 13     m  TC 00 25 30 00    TC 00 25 29 09    Name C0023  Title SCENE 00126  Date 2005 DEC 01 14 55 OK    Dur 0 00 02 05  l  On Clip List    4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     The selected clip is deleted  and you return to the clip  thumbnail screen     In step 1  you can also perform a shortcut operation by  pressing the RESET RETURN button with the SHIFT  button held dow
87.  disc in this  unit     You can operate in the same way that you operate on  local drives and files on network computers       If you power this unit off during a FAM connection  the  data transferred thus far is discarded      All file operations are not possible for some types of  files     For details  see  File operation restrictions   page 107      To eject discs from a remote computer    Click the eject button to the right of the icon for this unit in  the Finder  or drag the icon for this unit from the Finder to  the Trash        suoneledo ei 9 sajdeyp    File Operations in File Access Mode  for Macintosh  1 1 5          suonejedo aji4 9 1e1deu     116       Exiting file operations    Proceed as follows     Do not disconnect the cable before performing steps 1 and    2     1 Eject the disc by clicking the eject button to the right  of the icon for this unit in the Finder  or by dragging  the icon for this unit from the Finder to the Trash     2 Disconnect the i LINK cable as required     To make a reconnection    To reconnect after exiting file operations  do one of the   following  depending on whether an i LINK cable is   connected    i LINK cable is not connected  Connect this unit and a  remote computer with an i LINK cable    i LINK cable is connected  The unit is mounted  automatically  so you do not need to do anything    The unit is powered off and an i LINK cable is  connected  Power the unit on     You can enable and disable FAM connection from the  function 
88.  display this item on the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 with the PDBZ   UPGO 2 Software Upgrade Key installed  set maintenance menu item  M393  AUDIO DSP to    AGC limiter     When maintenance menu item  M393  AUDIO DSP is set to    linear edit   this item is not displayed        840    AUDIO AGC SELECT    Set the AGC saturation level    off  AGC does not operate       6dB     9dB     12dB     15dB     17dB  AGC operates when the  VARIABLE switch is set to PRESET       To display this item on the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 with the  PDBZ UPGO2 Software Upgrade Key installed  set maintenance menu  item M393  AUDIO DSP to  AGC limiter   When maintenance menu  item M393  AUDIO DSP is set to  linear edit   this item is not displayed      This setting is valid only for channels where  mic  is selected with  setup menu item 834 AUDIO INPUT LEVEL  Regardless of this  setting  AGC is    off    for channels where  line  is selected        841          AUDIO LIMITER SELECT       Select the limiter saturation level  for limiting large input signals  for use   in manual adjustment of audio input levels    off  The limiter does not operate       6dB     9dB   12dB   15dB   17dB  The limiter operates when the  VARIABLE switch is set to PRESET       To display this item on the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 with the  PDBZ UPGO2 Software Upgrade Key installed  set maintenance menu  item M393  AUDIO DSP to  AGC limiter   When maintenance menu  item M393  AUDIO DSP is set to  linear edit   this item is not di
89.  down the     MARK  or V MARK2 button and press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob  If you connect a Windows USB  keyboard to the MAINTENANCE connector  you can  record shot marks from Shot MarkO up to Shot Mark9 by  pressing the 0 to 9 keys on the numeric keypad    Use the PDZ 1Proxy Browsing Software on the supplied  XDCAM Application Software CD ROM to delete and  modify essence marks     See page 175 for an overview of the PDZ 1 software and  information about how to install it     You can also delete and modify essence marks from the  Thumbnail Menu of the chapter thumbnail screen  see  page 77        When setup menu item 669 ESSENCE MARK  RECORD MODE is set to    rec     shot marks cannot be  set during playback      Shot marks cannot be set to a locked clip     To set a clip flag   You can set one of the three types of flag  OK  NG or  KEEP  for the clip while it is being played back by  viewing its video image and using the function menu  see  page 51      Playback in jog mode    In jog mode  you can control the speed of playback by the  speed of turning the jog dial  The playback speed range is       to 41 times normal speed    To carry out playback in jog mode  proceed as follows                                               ll                       m                                                       1    1 Press the SHTL JOG button or VAR JOG button   turning it on     2 Turn the jog dial in the desired direction  at the speed  corresponding to the desired playback spee
90.  initial setup settings before  using the unit   You cannot use the unit without setting it  up     Once the unit has been set up  the settings are retained even  when the unit is powered off     Use the following procedures                                                                                         1 Power the unit on     The INITIAL SETUP screen appears on the display     INITIAL SETUP    UC J MODEL  SELECT    NONE    INC DEC    CANCEL amp PREV    SET amp NEXT      CTRL   KNOB  F1  RET   FS SET        2 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the area of    use     Display UC  for regions outside Japan  or J  for  Japan   and then press the SET function button  F5    The system frequency screen appears     3 Tur the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the system    frequency     Initial Setup       suoneiedejgd e je deu     33    I          suonejedejg e Jajdeyo    34       RETURN  es INITIAL SETUP    SYSTEM FREQUENCY  SELECT    1080 50i    INC DEC   CTRL KNOB  CANCEL amp PREV   F1  RET   SET amp NEXT   FS SET     Display the system frequency that you want to use  and  then press the SET function button  F5    The DATE TIME PRESET screen appears     In the DATE TIME PRESET screen  set the current  date and time by setting the following items     RETURN  Ed DATE TIME PRESET    YEAR 2008    IET MONTH 11  m NE  BEN E 16 49 00  SET    TIM  TIME ZONE UTCt00 00    INC DEC   CTRL KNOB  SHIFT               KEY    CANCEL amp PREV   F1  RET   SET amp NEXT   F5CSET   YEAR  Year
91.  input channels  also turn    PB    on     4 Repeat steps 2 and 3 until you have set up mixing for  all of the required channels     5 Press the SAVE function button  F5      The settings are saved  and the unit exits the audio  setup mode     6 Set MIX SWAP on page P4 AUDIO of the function  menu to    ON        The setting of setup menu item 819 AUDIO INPUT  ARRANGE is enabled        To return to the setup menu  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob without turning it     2 Tur the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the         to  the recording channel that you want to set up  and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The screen changes to the input channel selection  screen     To return to the recording channel selection screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob without turning it     3 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move     gt     to the  input channel that you want to turn on  and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     In this state  you can turn the selected input channel on  or off     To toggle the input channel on  highlighted  or off  Do one of the following      Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob      Press the     or   function button  F3 or F4      Linear Editing    Editing operations      When the In and Out points are not set in the same clip   insert editing is performed only for the clip containing  the In point        IN point OUT point    Edit execution segment               If the OUT point is set within the final clip  in assemble  editing the length of the clip does
92.  is set to    muting     no timecode is output     Rear Panel    31       seq Jo suonounJ pue seweN z 13 deyo          suonejedejg e jejdeuj    32    Preparations       Preparing Power Sources    This unit can be powered by AC power  DC power  or a  battery pack    For safety  use only the Sony battery packs listed below   Lithium ion battery pack  BP L80S  BP GL95    If you load or remove a battery pack incorrectly  it may fall  and cause bodily injury  Follow the procedures described  below to load or remove them        Supplying power    AC power supply    Connect the AC IN connector to an AC power source using  the specified AC power cord  To supply AC power to the  unit  setthe on standby button on the front panel to ON and  the POWER switch on the rear panel to I  ON      DC power supply    Connect the DC IN 12V connector to a DC power source   To supply DC power to the unit  set the on standby button  on the front panel to ON and the POWER switch on the  rear panel to OFF  If the POWER switch on the rear panel  is set to l  ON   AC power is supplied     Battery power supply    Battery packs that can be used with this unit are as follows   To use battery pack  a BKP L551 Battery Adaptor and a  BC L100 Battery Charger are also required    e BP L80S     BP GL95    Preparing Power Sources       Chapter    Continuous recording time at room temperature  BP GL95 lithium ion battery pack  80 minutes  95  minutes when used in power save mode     For details on charging battery 
93.  left click on a key to enter the   character for that key    To change the speed of the mouse pointer  Select the  desired speed using Settings   Select Mouse Pointer  Speed in the Disc Menu  Select the speed that works  best with the connected mouse     To exit the software keyboard from a USB  keyboard    1 with the cursor in an edit box  press the Enter key to  move the focus to OK     2 Doone of the following     To confirm the edit and then exit the software  keyboard  While OK is selected  press the Enter  key    To discard the edit and then exit the software  keyboard  On the USB keyboard  press the   key  or the Tab key to move to Cancel  and then press  the Enter key    To continue editing  Press any key except the Enter  key  the Esc key  and the Tab key        Setting clip flags    You can set three types of clip flags  OK NG KP  KEEP    during recording or playback  Setting these flags in each  clip that you record makes it easy for editors and other  colleagues to find and select the clips that they need     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of  the clip where you want to set a flag     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Set Clip Flag     The clip flag setting screen appears     Thumbnail Menu    ii Set Clip Flag  Return to Upper Menu    NG  KP  KEEP   none       4 Select the clip flag that you want to set  OK NG KP   KEEP       A clip flag icon  see page 70  appear
94.  locking all  clips     3 Select OK to lock all clips or Cancel to cancel it  and  then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To unlock a specific clip    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of  the clip that you want to unlock     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Lock Unlock Clip     A message appears asking you to confirm the  unlocking     Unlock Clip    C0004  Unlock this Clip        SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo g Ja deyD    4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     In step 1  you can also perform a shortcut operation by  pressing the STOP button with the SHIFT button held  down     To unlock all clips  1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Lock or Delete All Clips  and then select  Unlock All Clips     A message appears asking you to confirm that you  want to unlock all clips     3 Select OK to execute the unlock  or Cancel to cancel  it  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob        Deleting clips    You can delete clips while checking their contents     Thumbnail Operations 85             SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedo  s je1deu     86      Clips cannot be deleted when the write inhibit tab of the  disc is set to the recording disabled position  or when  REC INH in HOME page of the function menu is set to  ON      Locked clips cannot be deleted      If a deletion target clips is referenced by clip lists on the  disc  all of those clip lists are deleted as well       f a
95.  not change     Carrying out clip editing  To carry out clip editing  use an RM 280 or similar editing  controller     Requirements for use of editing controllers             Model name Requirement   RM 280 Software version  2 04 or higher  On this unit  set setup menu item 501  STILL TIMER to 1 min  1 minute  or  longer    RM 450 Set to player synchronization                For details of how to set edit points and carry out editing   refer to the operation manual for the editing controller     If an assemble edit command is received while  maintenance menu item M393  AUDIO DSP is set to   AGC limiter   the unit creates a new clip and performs  normal recording    Compared to linear editing on VTRs  a longer time is  required for processing at the end of an edit  from 4 to 5  seconds are required for completion of the edit after  passing the Out point      When an insert edit finishes   Do one of the following    Wait until the unit enters standby off mode  the time  until the unit enters standby off mode depends on the  setting of setup menu item 501 STILL TIMER    Eject the disc     File system information is written to the disc     If you turn the unit s primary power off before doing one  of the above  file system information is not recorded to the  disc  As a result  no additional edits can be made on the  edited clip  and the audio is set to non audio     Essence marks recorded by clip editing    CUT  is recorded as an essence mark at the IN and OUT  points of video in
96.  number  703    Item name  BLANK LINE SELECT       Sub Item    Settings    Switch blanking of the video output signal on or off for individual lines in  the vertical blanking interval     The Y C signal and odd even fields are blanked simultaneously        ALL LINE           Specify the blanking for each line separately    bink  blank   Regardless of the setting of other sub items  blank all lines  which can be specified in this menu item    thru  throu   Regardless of the setting of other sub items  switch off  blanking for all lines which can be specified in this menu item        In 59 94i   59 94P 29 97P  mode  UC     LINE 12      LINE 19    Specify blanking for lines 12 to 19     bink  blank   Carry out blanking   thru  throu   Switch off blanking        LINE 20    Specify blanking for line 20    bink  blank   Carry out blanking   half  Carry out half blanking   thru  throu   Switch off blanking        LINE 12      LINE 20    In 59 94i   59 94P 29 97P  mode  J     Specify blanking for lines 12 to 20     bink  blank   Carry out blanking   thru  throu   Switch off blanking        LINE 21    Specify blanking for line 21    bink  blank   Carry out blanking   half  Carry out half blanking   thru  throu   Switch off blanking        In 50i 50P 25P  mode    LINE 9      LINE 22    Specify blanking for lines 9 to 22     bink  blank   Carry out blanking   thru  throu   Switch off blanking        LINE 23       Specify blanking for line 23   half  Carry out half blanking   thru  throu
97.  of the previous section    To upload  entire clips            Downloading clips    Proceed as follows to download clips from a remote host   such as other XDCAM device devices or a material  server      See page 75 for information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Download Clip via Direct FTP  and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The Select Remote Host screen of the Download Clip  via Direct FTP command appears     Download Clip via Direct FTP    Select Remote Host     Remote Host 1     Remote Host 2     Remote Host 3  Remote Host 4 UPnP     Hosts Discovered via UPnP  Network Config        UMID Unchange    Cancel  lt  lt        Execute steps 6 to 9 of    To upload entire clips        page 100      If the connection succeeds  the Select Clip to  Download screen appears     Download Clip via Direct FTP  Select Clip to Download    C5001 MXF 36 4MB  C5002 MXF 2 147 4MB  2 147 4MB  36 7MB  224 9MB  298 8MB  75 3MB    C5003 MXF  C5004 MXF  C5008 MXF  C5009 MXF  C5012 MXF          If the remote host is a computer  only the MXF files  in the specified directory appear      When more 301 or more clips are stored on a remote  host  the denominator indicating the clip total at the  upper right is shown as            and the names of the  301st and following clips are not displayed      File names containing other than ASCII characters   kanji and so on  are not displayed     4 selecta clip to download  and then press the PUSH    SET S S
98.  of the unit  The  information can be displayed in the time data display area  and also  by text superimposition  on the monitor  connected to the unit  Use the information as a guide in  scheduling periodic maintenance    For periodic maintenance  consult a Sony service  representative     Display modes of the digital hours meter  H01  OPERATION HOURS mode    Displays the total number of hours the unit has been  powered on in units of 1 hour     H02  LASER PARAMETER 0 mode  not  resettable    Of the two optical heads  this shows a counter of the  cumulative light output time by one optical head in units of  hours    This can be used as a guide in determining when to replace  the optical head     1  The counter advances at different rates during recording and playback  It  is also affected by the ambient temperature     H03  LASER PARAMETER 1 mode  not  resettable    Same as H02    Of the two optical heads  this shows a counter of the  cumulative light output time by the other optical head in  units of hours  P    1  The counter advances at different rates during recording and playback  It  is also affected by the ambient temperature     H11  OPERATION HOURS mode  resettable   Same as HO1 except that the count is resettable    This can be used as a guide in determining when to replace  parts     H13  SEEK RUNNING HOURS 0 mode  resettable   Of the two optical heads  this shows the cumulative seek  operation time for one optical head in units of hours  The  count is resettable 
99.  on  this unit to the current directory on the remote computer     Command syntax  RETR   SP    lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt   Input example  RETR Clip C0001 MXF    STOR  Begins transfer of a copy of a file in the specified path on  the remote computer to the current directory on this unit   Depending on the type of file transferred  the following  files are created     C  MXF file     C MO01 XML file  metadata    C MO2 KLV file  user metadata    C S01 MXEF file  proxy AV data   E E01 SMI file     E MO1 XML file  metadata     1     0001 to 9999  2     0001 to 0099      For C  MXF files  the UMID of the copy source file is  not saved  However  it is saved if an immediately  preceding SITE UMMD extended command has been  issued      For C  MXF files  some data  such as file header  metadata  may be missing      Depending on the transfer destination directory and the  file type  transfer may not be possible     For details  see  File operation restrictions   page 107      Command syntax  STOR   SP    lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt   Input example  STOR Edit E0001E01 SMI    RNFR   RNTO   Rename a file    Specify the file to be renamed with the RNFR command   and specify the new name with the RNTO command    Always follow a RNFR command with a RNTO  command      For details  see  File operation restrictions   page 107      Command syntax  RNFR   SP     path name  before  change     lt CRLF gt   RNTO   SP     path name  after change     lt CRLF gt     Input example  RNFR General info
100.  other settings  press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob or the SELECT function button  F2  to return to  the previous screen  then repeat steps 1 to 3     D When you have completed the settings  press the  SAVE function button  F5      The message    NOW SAVING       appears on the video  monitor display  and    Saving       appears in the time  data display area  while the new settings are saved in  memory  When the saving operation is completed  the  video monitor display and the time data display area  return to their normal indications     If you power off the unit before a save operation is  completed  settings may be lost  Wait until the save is  completed before powering off the unit    If  instead of pressing the SAVE function button  F5    you press the MENU button  the new settings are not  saved  The message    ABORT      appears on the video  monitor display and    Abort    in the time data display  area for about 0 5 seconds  and the system exits the  menus  To change more than one setting  be sure to press    the SAVE function button  F5  after making the settings     To return menu settings to their factory  default settings    After changing menu settings  use the following procedure  to return the settings to their factory default settings   setting initialization      To return a particular setting to its factory default  setting   In the screen that selects the setting of that item  press the  RESET RETURN button    For example  proceed as follows to return the 00
101.  point setting returns to the previous  value     6 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     7 Repeat steps 1 to 6 as required     8 save the clip list  see page 92      To delete sub clips    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Select the clips to delete in the clip list thumbnail  screen  multiple selections possible      2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Delete Sub Clips  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A message appears asking you to confirm the deletion     4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     5 Repeat steps 1 to 4 as required     6 save the clip list  see page 92    To play the clip list    When this unit is in single clip playback mode  see  page 63   only the selected sub clip can be played     See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     To play using GUI screens    1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail  of the sub clip where you want to start play     To start play from the start of the clip list  Select the thumbnail of the first sub clip     2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To play using the clip list playback screen  1 Display the clip list playback screen     2 Press the PREV button or the NEXT button to display  the sub clip that you want to play     To start play from the first sub clip  Press the SHIFT   PREV buttons to move to the start  of the clip list     3 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To change the starting time
102.  pointing arrow Pressing the PUSH SET S SEL   This section describes the indications in the maintenance   gt   at the right of a knob or the    OUT button switches  menu and how to change the settings  menu item to the next lower menu level or to a  setting selection screen   To display the maintenance menu Left pointing arrow         Pressing the PUSH SET S SEL     at the left of a menu knob or the   IN button switches to  Holding down the PAGE HOME button and the SHIFT item the previous  higher  menu level     button  press the MENU button     Maintenance Menu                   On screen indication   Meaning    Character string at the  right of a menu item    Current setting of the menu item   When shown with a colon      the  current setting is the same as  the factory default setting    When shown with a raised dot       the current setting is  different from the factory  default setting        An    asterisk  in a  complete list of settings    Factory default setting                To change a menu item setting  Carry out the following operations to change the setting     For information about how to change network settings see  next section  To change network settings         Function buttons Arrow buttons    PUSH SET S SEL  knob                                                                                                                          SHIFT button    PAGE HOME button MENU button             1 Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the   MARK1  and   MARK2 buttons
103.  recorded clips   Press the THUMBNAIL button to display the thumbnail  screen  and select the clip whose title you want to check   The title of the selected clip appears at the upper left of the  screen     See    Thumbnail Operations     page 76  for more  information about the thumbnail screen     The value of the serial number is incremented by 1 every  time a title is generated  When the value reaches 99999   the next number restarts from 00001    Duplicate clip titles can be generated if you reset the  serial number after recording several clips or the same is  true depending on the value setting  Care should be taken  when setting the serial number    The    PREFIX    setting is saved in memory banks  but the     NUMERIC    setting is not saved  see page 128         Assigning user defined clip and clip  list names  The following standard format names are assigned    automatically to clips and clip lists that are created or  recorded by XDCAM devices     Clips  C0001 MXF to C9999  MXF   Clip lists  E0001E01 SMI to E0099E01 SMI   This unit can handle clips and clip lists with user defined  names as well as names in the standard format     Limitations   Letters  numbers and symbols from the Unicode 2 0   character set can be used    However  the following control characters and symbols   cannot be used      Control characters  U 0000 to U 001F  U 007F     Symbols               lt    gt            Depending on the character type  the length of user    defined names  the  C 
104.  sacs etna dene t p E SM DNE 23  Hear Panel    E A stdeavcuscsucceubetutccnusencdeevevicuviteasseaveunesetesen 28       Chapter 3 Preparations    Preparing Power Sources                                 eese 32  SUDDLVIRS DUE coca E edits Mason wiser b me usd uud 32  Attaching a battery pac Eus ose detect eH Dra cote et e Re es 32   Initial Setup  a uei masc hrec t ms D  S D Ee tilia lat cas 33   Front Panel Tilt Mechanism                                eeeeeeeeeeeennrnnnnnne 35   Connections and Settings                                    eese 36  Connections for using PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software                     36  Connections for cut editing 2d aseo queris ien dicte Een op Gan PRI Mi eaves 37  Using the editing functions of the recorder  controlling through   REMOTE 9P  connector     22  1 mudi neta 41  Connections for pool coverage            eessssssesssesessseesseesserssereseresssesseessee 41   Synchronization Reference Signals                                              42   Setting System Frequency                                  eene 43   Setting Timecode inei rapi rie c Ik cow dci Eros bw Ces inicie 43   Superimposed Text Information                                             euuus  45   Basic Operations of the Function Menu                                         48  Function menu operations   e onec eet oerte eee pero ko ei Sepe iae o eres t   P e pns 48  Function menu Sel HngS s caede oe Be PRINE DU e TUI HIR IPIE Ite eI PD dErS 48    Table of Contents   
105.  superimposed display on the monitor  The   hexadecimal value 00 is for the far left of the screen  Increasing the value   moves the position of the characters to the right    00     OC     28  When the number of system lines is 1080 and the  system frequency is 59 94i  29 97P  50i  25P  or 23 98P     00     OB     28  When the number of system lines is 720 and the system  frequency is 59 94P or 50P      Set this item by adjusting to the required position while viewing the monitor        003          CHARACTER V POSITION    Adjust the vertical screen position  as a hexadecimal value  of the text   information output from the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector    the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2    SUPER  connector for superimposed display on the monitor  The   hexadecimal value 00 is for the top of the screen  Increasing the value   lowers the position of the characters    00     2A     32  When the number of system lines is 1080 and the  system frequency is 59 94i  29 97P  50i  25P  or 23 98P     00     29     32  When the number of system lines is 720 and the system  frequency is 59 94P or 50P      Set this item by adjusting to the required position while viewing the monitor           124    Setup Menu          Item number  005    Determine the kind of text information to be output from the COMPOSITE    Item name    DISPLAY INFORMATION  SELECT    Settings    OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector    or the HDSDI OUTPUT 
106.  take the  action described in the next  section  This corresponds to the     red    channel condition indicator  of aVTR   C Disc This appears during cache  exchange recording   cache  For details  see page 56                 a  Read errors will occur if the playback condition continues to deteriorate   If a read error occurs  a    Disc Error     alarm appears in the time data  display  the picture freezes  and audio is muted     To display playback condition marks  set setup menu item  012 CONDITION DISPLAY ON VIDEO MONITOR to   ena   and set setup menu item 005 DISPLAY  INFORMATION SELECT to  T amp sta      For details about operation  see  Basic menu operations    page 126      Playback condition displays    You can be alerted in advance to deteriorating playback   conditions and to error correction rates which are   approaching their limits    Deteriorating playback may be due to the following   causes      Scratches and dust on the disc surface  This includes fingerprints  dust from the air  tar from  cigarette smoke  and so on   Scratches and soiling which occur before recording are  not a problem because they are registered in advance as  defects  and recording avoids them  However  scratches  and soiling which occur after recording can lead to  deteriorating playback conditions      Aging of disc recording layers  Over several decades  the recording layers of optical  discs can age and cause deteriorating playback  conditions   You can use this function to check arch
107.  the current system lines setting of this  ON DISC  unit does not match the resolution of the inserted  1080 29 97P disc   1080 25P Insert a disc with a resolution that matches the        c current system lines setting of this unit  or change the     1080 23 98P system lines setting of this unit  or enable mixed  z 720 59 94P format recording mode   E  720 50P  x HD422 1080 DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED  This appears when mixed format recording mode is  HD422 720 VIDEO REC MODE SELECTION disabled  and the video recording format of this unit  DIFFERENT FROM VIDEO ON DISC  does not match the video recording format of the  HD420 1080 inserted disc   Insert a disc with a video recording format that  aae matches the video recording format of this unit  or  IMX50 Clip change the video recording format of this unit   IMX40 Clip  IMX30 Clip  1 70 Troubleshooting             Alarm message in time  data display area    8CHx16 Clip       4CHXx24 Clip       2CHx16 Clip    Alarm message in video monitor screen    DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED   AUDIO REC MODE SELECTION  DIFFERENT FROM AUDIO ON DISC     Action    This appears when mixed format recording mode is  disabled  and the audio recording format of this unit  does not match the audio recording format of the  inserted disc    Insert a disc with a audio recording format that  matches the audio recording format of this unit  or  change the audio recording format of this unit           System FREQ       RECORDING AND PLAYBACK IS NOT  POSSIBLE    SY
108.  the threshold amplitude at  which low amplitude signals are not emphasized   0 to 8 to FH  957 LEVEL DEPEND THRESHOLD  UC    Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the luminance range for  a  edge enhancement   0 to 8 to FH  958 H DETAIL FREQUENCY  UC  9 Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the center frequency and  frequency properties for edge enhancement   3 2MHz  3 2 MHz  1 1 MHz  4 5MHz  4 5 MHz   1 4 MHz  5 0MHz  5 0 MHz   0 7 MHz  4 0MHz  4 0 MHz  2 0 MHz  959 Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the horizontal vertical ratio       H V RATIO  UC  9       for edge enhancement   0 to 3to 7          Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    145          snue WN 4 Jejdeuj    146    Menu items in the 900s  relating to digital process                                                                      Item number   Item name Settings  965 IMAGE ENHANCER  INPUT UP Set up the operation of the up converter image enhancer for SD input    CONVERTER  separately from the settings for playback  menu items 950 to 959     Sub Item   1   ENH SETTING   pb  While SD signals are input  make the behavior of the image   enhancer of the up converter follow the settings for playback  menu  items 950 to 959   Settings for sub items 2 to 11 under menu item  965 become invalid     input  While SD signals are input  make the behavior of the image  enhancer of the up converter follow the settings for sub items 2 to 11  under menu item 965  separate settings during input of SD sign
109.  to select the required item   then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the  SELECT function button  F2      The sub items of the selected item appears     2 Select a sub item with the same operation as step 1   and use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the   MARK1  and    MARK2 buttons to change the setting     9 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the SELECT  function button  F2  to confirm the setting change     4 Press the SAVE function button  F5      The message  NOW SAVING     appears on the video  monitor display  and    Saving       appears in the time  data display area  while the new settings are saved in  memory  When the saving operation is completed  the  video monitor display and the time data display area  return to their normal indications     To cancel changing a setting   Before pressing the SAVE function button  F5   press the  MENU button    The menu disappears from the video monitor display   without saving the new setting     To change network settings   To change network settings  carry out the procedure  described in the previous section     To display the  maintenance menu   to display the NETWORK menu  item  then carry out the following operations     For details of the settings  consult your network  administrator     When the IP address is assigned automatically    Check that the network cable is connected to this unit  before carrying out the operation     Follow the procedure as shown in previous section    To  change a menu item setting  to set maintenan
110.  txt  RNTO General clip info txt    DELE  Deletes the specified file on this unit     Depending on the directory and file type  deletion may not  be possible     For details  see  File operation restrictions   page 107      Command syntax  DELE   SP     path name    lt CRLF gt   Input example  DELE Clip C0099 MXF    STAT  Sends information about properties of the specified file  or  about data transfer status  from this unit to the remote  computer   The following property information is sent  depending on  the file type      MXF file     File name      File type    CODEC type    Frame rate    Number of audio channels    Duration    UMID    non MXF file    File name    Command syntax  STAT   SP    lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt     The following data is transferred  depending on whether a  file is specified with  lt path name gt      File specified  The properties of the specified file    No specification  The size of the data transferred thus far   unit  bytes   Input example  STAT Clip C0001 MXF    ABOR    Requests this unit to abort a file transfer currently in  progress     Command syntax  ABOR  lt CRLF gt     SYST  Displays the system name of this unit   Command syntax  SYST  lt CRLF gt     FTP File Operations       suoneiedo aji4 9 1e1deuj    119          suoneJedo aji4 9 1e1deu     120    HELP    Displays a list of the commands supported by this unit  or  an explanation of the specified command     Command syntax  HELP   SP    lt command name gt    lt CRLF gt     The fol
111.  up converter    u amp d  Control both the up  and down converter     It is also possible to adjust setup menu item 718 SETUP LEVEL BLACK  LEVEL from the HKDV 900  Hold down the D2 button on the HKDV 900  and rotate the SETUP dial        214    REMOTE INTERFACE    When the remote control switch is set to REMOTE  select the device from  which to remote control this unit    9PIN  Device connected to the REMOTE 9P  connector    SDI  Device connected to the SD HDSDI INPUT connector     i LINK  Device connected to the      i LINK  S400 connector  b        215    i LINK MODE D    Select the connection method for the     i LINK  S400 connector   FAM  FAM  PC REMOTE    FAM connection  TS  TS connection          257          NETWORK ENABLE       Select the remote control switch positions which enable network   connections    net  network   Only when the switch is set to  NET     n amp 9P  network  amp  remote 9PIN    When the switch is set to  NET   and  when the switch is set to    REMOTE    and setup menu item 214 is set    to  9PIN               Setup Menu       snue N Z Je deu    133          snue wN 4 Ja deup    134    Menu items in the 200s  relating to the remote control interface       Item number  258          Item name  LIVE LOGGING MODE       Settings    Specify the Live Logging operation mode    off  Disable the Live Logging function    live mode  Select Live mode  Supported operations are metadata  editing only    live view mode  Select Live View mode  Supported operation
112.  video monitor display     For details  see    Display window    on page 23        PUSH SET S SEL  knob   Use for menu and GUI screen operations  Turn the knob to  select items  and press it to confirm the selection  This  button is also used to set numerical and timecode values   You can also change the playback speed by pressing the  PLAY button and turning this knob during playback  see  page 66      See    GUI screen operations     page 75  for more  information about how to use the thumbnail screens        MENU button   Displays the setup menu or the GUI screen menu  The  setup menu appears when no GUI screen is visible  The  same information is also superimposed on the display on a    monitor connected to the unit  Press once more to return to  the original display     See  GUI screen operations   page 75  for more  information about how to use the thumbnail screens     Q RESET RETURN button   Functions as the RESET button or the RETURN button    RESET button  Reset counters or the setting values of the  timecode generator  This button is also used to abort  or cancel setup menu  scene selection  and thumbnail  search operations    RETURN button  In setup menu and GUI screens   returns to the previous procedure     Q SUB CLIP DISC MENU button and indicator  When pressed alone  functions as the SUB CLIP button   When pressed together with the SHIFT button  functions  as the DISC MENU button    SUB CLIP button  Press the button  lighting the  indicator  to carry out playb
113.  video monitor screenr   Typhoon  001  Typhoon 002        The actually recorded clip names    Typhoon Strikes Tokyo 001    Typhoon Strikes Tokyo 002      D          1  When display of the ASCII format clip name has been selected  see  page 95      Overview      The serial numbers return to 001 on the next  recording operation if you reach number 999      Serial numbers are not reset when you power the  unit off or exchange discs  newly generated numbers  are continuous on the old ones        f the ASCII format clip name string is longer than  14 characters  it is displayed in the viewfinder as the  first 8 characters   Bl  abbreviated    the last 4  characters  for a total of 13 characters        Setting essence mark names by  using planning metadata    You can use planning metadata to specify user defined  names for the Shot Mark0 to Shot Mark9 essence marks  that correspond to the 0 to 9 keys on a USB keyboard   When planning metadata that contains user defined  essence mark name strings is loaded into this unit s  memory  the unit displays those names for the essence  marks that correspond to the keys and that are recorded  when the keys are pressed     See page 55 for more information about recording essence  marks  and see page 155 for more information about how  to load files     Essence mark name string format    Use a text editor to enter essence mark names in the  sections indicated by shading in    Essence mark name  string example   Names can be either in ASCII for
114.  with the distribution    Neither the name of Sparta  Inc nor the names of its  contributors may be used to endorse or promote products  derived from this software without specific prior written  permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS  IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT   INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY     Trademarks and Licenses    OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE          Part 6  Cisco BUPTNIC copyright notice  BSD           Copyright  c  2004  Cisco  Inc and Information Network  Center of Beijing University of Posts and  Telecommunications    All rights reserved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or  without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer  
115.  you set an essence mark    When Shot MarkO0 to Shot Mark9 is set  you can search for  the shot marks by displaying thumbnails of the frames at  those positions  see page 78     You can also use shot mark positions as edit points during  scene selection operations  see page 87      You can also set shot marks during playback  See page 65  for the procedure     To set a clip flag    You can set one of the three types of flag  OK  NG or  KEEP  for the clip while it is being recorded by viewing its  video image and using the function menu  see page 51      You can also set a clip flag during playback  See page 65  for details     You can also seta clip flag on the GUI screen  See page 84  for details        Continuing recording while  exchanging discs  disc exchange  cache function     About 30 seconds  this duration may differ depending on  the state of a disc  of video and audio data can be recorded  to the unit s internal memory cache during a disc   exchange  and then written back to the newly loaded disc     1 check that setup menu item 150 REC MODE is set to     disc exchange cache        If the disc exchange cache indication is lit in the time  data display area  see page 24  of the basic operation  display  setup menu item 150 REC MODE is set to     disc exchange cache        2 If none of the indications of step 1 appear  set setup  menu item 150 REC MODE to    disc exchange cache      see page 133      The setting of 150 REC MODE can be changed even  during recording   
116. 00 24 56 24    Scene Selection 00 13 48 24    a   aos       3 select the sub clips that you want to add from the  upper part of the screen  the part where 8 thumbnails  are displayed  multiple selections possible      To select from expanded thumbnails  Press the EXPAND button to display the expand  thumbnail screen     To select from chapter thumbnails  Press the CHAPTER button to display the chapter  thumbnail screen     4 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The thumbnail selection is confirmed  and an I cursor  appears at the bottom of the Clip List  Add  screen  in  the Scene Selection window   The I cursor indicates       the location where the currently selected sub clips will  be inserted     To display the total duration after addition of the  selected clips  Press the SHIFT button     5 In the Scene Selection window  move the I cursor to  the location where you want to insert the clip   The  existing thumbnails arrange themselves to the left and  right of the I cursor      6 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The sub clips are added at the I cursor position  and  you return to the clip list thumbnail screen     You can check the results of the addition in that screen     7 Repeat steps 1 to 6 as required to add more clips     8 Save the clip list  see page 92      In step 1  you can also perform a shortcut operation by  pressing the PUSH SET S SEL  knob with the SHIFT  button held down     To add clips from the clip playback screen  quick  insertion    This method all
117. 2  SUPER  connector    T amp sta  time data  amp  status   Time data and the units status    T amp UB  time data  amp  UB   Time data and user bits data   When UB  user bits  data  is selected with CNTR SEL on the HOME page of the function  menu  the user bits data and time data arranged in that order are  displayed     T amp CNT  time data  amp  CNT   Time data and counter count   When  COUNTER is selected with CNTR SEL on the HOME page of the  function menu  the counter count and time data arranged in that order  are displayed     T amp T  time data  amp  timecode   Time data and timecode  TC or VITC    T amp clp  time data  amp  clip no   Time data and clip number   time  time data only   Time data only          006    LOCAL FUNCTION ENABLE    Determine which recording and playback control buttons on the front panel  are enabled when this unit is controlled from external equipment   dis  all disable   All buttons and switches are disabled     st amp ej  stop  amp  eject   Only the STOP button and EJECT button are enabled        ena  all enable   All buttons and switches are enabled        007    DISC TIMER DISPLAY    Determine whether to display the counter in 12 hour mode or 24 hour mode          12H     12H   12 hour mode  24H  24 hour mode       009    CHARACTER TYPE    Determine the type of characters such as timecode output from the  COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector for  superimposed d
118. 3  and FTP connections   page 116            Able to use clips with user defined names  over FAM and FTP connections    Sakura SMI       Able to use clip lists with user defined names  over FAM and FTP connections             To check clip names   Press the THUMBNAIL button to display the thumbnail  screen  and select the clip whose name you want to check   The name of the selected clip appears at the upper left of  the screen     See  Thumbnail Operations   page 76  for more  information about the thumbnail screen     The item at the upper left of the screen is displayed   according to the following order of priority    Title  gt User defined clip name  gt Standard format clip name   Therefore  the display of this item changes as following    depending on whether there is a title      When a title has been set as a clip name on this unit  for  clips recorded on this unit  the title is displayed      The user defined name or standard format name is  displayed for clips without a title        File Operations in File  Access Mode  for  Windows     File access mode operating environment    Operating system requirements for file operations by file  access mode  called FAM below  are as follows   Computer operating system  Microsoft Windows XP  Professional SP3 or higher  Microsoft Windows Vista  Business Ultimate  32 bit 64 bit  SP2 or higher  or  Microsoft Windows 7 Professional Ultimate  32 bit 64  bit     Preparations    Install the FAM driver on the remote computer  see the  
119. 5  DISPLAY INFORMATION SELECT item to its default  setting  This assumes that the setting has been changed  from the factory default  time data  amp  status  in step 3 of  the procedure in  To change the settings of menu items    page 129      1 Press the RESET RETURN button      time data  amp  status   factory default setting  is  selected     2 Press the SAVE function button  F5      The setting returned to its factory default is saved in  memory as the current setting     Setup Menu       snus  z Jeideuj    129          snue wN 4 Jejdeuj    130    To return all settings to their factory default  settings     T Press the MENU button to display the setup menu     2 Press the RESET RETURN button     A message appears  to confirm whether you wish to  return all settings to their factory default settings        Message on the video  monitor display    Initialize all items to factory  preset values        Message in the time data   Init setup     display area                3 Press the SAVE function button  F5      The message    NOW SAVING       appears on the video  monitor display  and    Saving       appears in the time  data display area  while the settings of all items are  returned to their factory default settings  These factory  default settings are saved in memory  If you power off  the unit while settings are being saved  settings may  not be correctly returned to their factory default  settings  Wait until the saving is completed before  powering off the unit     To
120. 50DLA 50 0 GB                   A PFD23 Professional Disc with a 2 times normal data  transfer rate cannot be used for linear editing        Connections    Make connections in the same way as for a cut editing  system  see page 37      When making the connections  also refer to the operation  manuals provided with the equipment to be connected        Preparations for editing    Recording format settings    Before performing clip editing  you need to set the  recording format of the PDW F1600 units to match the  recording format of the editing target clip  The following  table shows the required settings        Item Setting    Recording format   Check the recording format of the clip  with the display window  see page 24   and select the same format with setup    menu item 031 RECORDING FORMAT        Audio Non audio   data     To perform insert editing of non audio   data   set maintenance menu item  M37  AUDIO CONFIG  gt M372  NON   AUDIO INPUT to    data          When you insert non audio into a clip   the channels containing the non   audio are treated as non audio  across their entire length      Use channel pairs  CH1 2  CH3 4   CH5 6  CH7 8  for non audio insert  editing  Non audio editing is not  executed unless a channel pair is  specified                 See page 128 for more information about setup menu  operations     See page 152 for more information about maintenance  menu operations     Settings required for editing    The following table shows the settings requi
121. 68  indicator 21  68  Sub clip 87  adding 88  deleting 91  reordering 90  trimming 90  Superimposed text information 45  Supplying power 32    Index    AC power supply 32   Battery power supply 32   DC power supply 32  Synchronization reference signals 42  System frequency setting 34  System information 25    Video input display 26    Web Thumbnail function 96  Write protecting discs 53    T    Text information 45  THUMBNAIL  button 68  indicator 21  68  Thumbnail  display items 70  operations 76  selecting 76  selecting information displayed  81  selecting multiple thumbnails 77  Thumbnail Menu 72  Thumbnail search 77  using chapter function 77  using essence marks 78  using expand function 77  using thumbnails 77  Tilt mechanism 35  TIME CODE  IN connector 30  OUT connector 30  Time data display area 24  Timecode 43  after setting initial value 43  input output section 30  recording external timecode  directly 45  recording sequentially upon the  last recorded timecode  44  recording with the internal  timecode generator  synchronized 44  setting to current time 44  Title 110  Troubleshooting 161    U    UMID Data 176  USB connector 29  User bits   setting 44    V    VAR JOG button 19  VARIABLE switch 18  Variable speed mode 66   VIDEO CONTROL connector 28    The material contained in this manual consists of information  that is the property of Sony Corporation and is intended solely  for use by the purchasers of the equipment described in this  manual    Sony Corporation e
122. AL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR  CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT  NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE          Part 4  Sun Microsystems  Inc  copyright notice  BSD     Copyright O 2003 Sun Microsystems  Inc   4150 Network  Circle  Santa Clara  California 95054  U S A  AII rights  reserved     Use is subject to license terms below     This distribution may include materials developed by third  parties     Sun  Sun Microsystems  the Sun logo and Solaris are  trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems   Inc  in the U S  and other countries     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or  without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution     Trademarks and Licenses       xipueddy    189          xipueddy    190    Neither the name of the Sun Microsystems  Inc  nor the  n
123. ANK4    Select the bank to be stored in menu bank 4  or reset menu bank 4   CURRENT TO BANK4  Store the current menu settings in menu bank 4   BANK1 TO BANK4  Store the menu bank 1 settings in menu bank 4   BANK2 TO BANK4  Store the menu bank 2 settings in menu bank 4   BANKS TO BANK4  Store the menu bank 3 settings in menu bank 4   RESET BANK4  Reset menu bank 4        M48  AUTO RECALL    Select whether to recall settings automatically from a menu bank when the system is  powered on  and if so which menu bank to recall from    off  Do not recall settings from a menu bank    from BANK1  Recall settings from menu bank 1    from BANK2  Recall settings from menu bank 2    from BANK3  Recall settings from menu bank 3    from BANK4  Recall settings from menu bank 4        M49  RESET ALL SETUP       Reset the current menu settings to the factory settings   SAVE function button  F5   Reset   MENU button  Return to the next highest menu level without resetting       The system frequency setting is also cleared  If you execute this item  reset the system  frequency  see page 33       Date and time settings are not cleared  but the time zone setting is cleared  After executing  this item  reset the time zone  see page 33         M5  NETWORK  Items relating to network settings       Item  M50  DHCP    Setting    Set whether to assign an IP address automatically with the DHCP server   DISABLE  Do not assign automatically   ENABLE  Assign automatically           M51  IP ADDRESS PRESET    
124. ARS AGAIN AFTER  ABOVE PROCEDURE    Exchg batt  BATTERY NEEDS REPLACING  PLEASE The NVRAM battery is exhausted  Contact a  CONTACT SERVICE  Sony service representative    Update Err  RUN SOFTWARE UPDATE PROGRAM  The software version is not properly updated   Update the software version again  If the same  message appears after you update the software  version  contact a Sony service representative                    Troubleshooting       xipueddy    161          xipueddy    162    When a disc is inserted       Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen    Description action                                           Unknown FS  UNKNOWN FILE SYSTEM  Format the disc  or eject it  see page 96    PLEASE FORMAT DISC OR EJECT   No FS  NO FILE SYSTEM PLEASE EJECT DISC    Eject the disc   ILL  Disc  IRREGULAR DISC IS USED  Use a Professional Disc   USE PROFESSIONAL DISC   IRREGULAR DISC IS USED   PLEASE EJECT DISC   Salvage NG  CLIP SALVAGE WAS NOT COMPLETED    See  Handling of discs when recording does not end  Salvage XXXX DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED  normally  salvage functions    page 58    FORMAT DISC OR CONTACT SERVICE  TO RUN CLIP SALVAGE PROGRAM    XXXX   Over DUR  EXCESSIVE DURATION IS IN DISC  Data in excess of the rated capacity is recorded on  RECORDING AND PLAYBACK IS NOT the disc   POSSIBLE   No Support  FORMAT NOT SUPPORTED  A disc in an unsupported recording format is loaded   RECORDING AND PLAYBACK IS NOT Use a disc in a format suppo
125. AUDIO AES EBU  IN 1 2 connectors       F4  A6 INPUT    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 6    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG2  Analog 2 audio signal   AES EBU2  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 1 2 connectors          F5  A7 INPUT       Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 7    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG 1  Analog 1 audio signal   AES EBUS  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 3 4 connectors          Basic Operations of the Function Menu    a  To enable this setting  the following settings are also required  in the same  way as for volume operations for channels 1 to 4     Set the VARIABLE switch of the front panel to    REC    or    PB        Set setup menu item 131 AUDIO VOLUME to    EACH       b   HD1500   When the PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key is installed                                            P5 TC page P6 REF page  Item Setting Item Setting  F1  TCG Selects the timecode signal to which the F1  OUT REF Selects the reference signal for the  internal timecode generator output signals of this unit   synchronizes  REF  Use the signal input to the  INT  Follow the initial value set from the REF VIDEO INPUT connector as the  control panel or remotely from the output reference signal   device connected to the INPUT  Use the input video signal as the  REMOTE 9P  connector  or output reference signal   synchronize to timecode played f i 7  back trom tha 
126. AVE SETUP BANK 1 Set to  on  to save current menu settings to menu bank 1    B12 SAVE SETUP BANK 2 Set to  on  to save current menu settings to menu bank 2    B13 SAVE SETUP BANK 3 Set to  on  to save current menu settings to menu bank 3    B20 RESET SETUP MENU Set to  on  to return the settings of the current menu to the factory default    off              settings  Set to    bank 4    to set the current menu to the settings saved in  menu bank 4     on  Return the current menu to the factory default settings   bank 4  Set the current menu to the settings saved in menu bank 4           a   HD1500  When the PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key is installed   b  IHDI1500  When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed                       Basic menu operations    The setup menus are displayed in the time data display area  of the basic operation display or on the video monitor  display  If you have connected an external monitor  they  are also superimposed over the picture shown on that  monitor     To display the setup menu                                                                                                                                  DISPLAY button    MENU button  Time data display area             Press the MENU button   A setup menu appears on the video monitor display  and a  cursor     indicates the currently selected menu item        Cursor indicating the currently selected item    Group name for the currently selected item       d METER  HO1 0PE HOUR
127. Appropriate IN OUT  Points     The temporal relationship between the specified In and Out points in sub clip trimming is not  correct    Reset so that the value of the Out point timecode is larger than the value of the In point  timecode        Duration of One Clip List  must be Less than 24 Hours     The total duration of the current clip list is greater than 24 hours   This appears when the total duration of the current clip list exceeds the upper limit of 24 hours as  the result of adding or trimming sub clips        No More Sub Clips can be  Added to the Clip List     The upper limit of sub clips in the current clip list has been reached   This appears when the upper limit of 300 clips in a clip list has been reached as the result of  adding or trimming sub clips        Sub Clip does not Exist     There are no sub clips in the current clip list   This appears when an attempt is made to move  trim or delete sub clips or preset timecode        Clip List does not Exist     There are no clip lists on the disc   This appears when an attempt is made to execute a Delete Clip List operation when there are no  clip lists on the disc        Move is Invalid     The sub clip cannot be moved   This appear when an attempt is made to execute a Move Sub Clips operation when there are no  sub clip in the current clip list  or when there is only one sub clip        Chapter does not Exist     The specified chapter has not been recorded   This appears when an attempt is made to display a cha
128. CE MENU FROM  DATA  TO  editing of non audio signals  always operate on     AUDIO     channel pairs   If you want to perform insert editing of the audio of  individual channels from channel pairs  set  maintenance menu item M37  AUDIO CONFIG   gt M372  NON AUDIO INPUT to  audio    List Exists DISC CANNOT BE EDITED  This appears when an edit preset command is  DELETE ALL CLIP LIST BEFORE received but the inserted disc contains a clip list   BEGINNING DESTRUCTIVE EDITING  Exchange the disc for one that does not contain a clip  list  or delete all clip lists from the disc   N A Clip      CANNOT EDIT AV MATERIAL  This appears when an edit preset command is  CHECK REC FORMAT IN CLIP  received for an HD420 clip or another clip that cannot  be edited   Check the recording format of the edit target clip  see  page 60    Mode Err  D CANNOT EDIT AV MATERIAL  This appears when an edit preset command is  CHANGE    SNGL CLIP PB    TO    OFF    AND   received but the unit is in Single Clip Playback mode      REC MODE    TO    NORMAL IN SETUP Disc Exchange Cache mode  or Clip Continuous Rec  MENU  mode   Set setup menu item 154 SINGLE CLIP PLAY MODE  to  off   or set setup menu item 150 REC MODE to     normal      N A Disc  P  DISC CANNOT BE EDITED  This appears when an edit preset command is  USE PFD23A OR PFD50DLA  received  but linear editing is not possible for the  inserted disc   Insert a disc that can be edited by linear editing  see  page 60    Live Logg  EXIT LIVE VIEW MODE OF LIVE
129. CLIPS   MAX   Files DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED TO  Delete clips or GENERAL files   FOR MORE RECORDING SPACE   DELETE CLIPS OR NON AV DATA  mE   GENERAL FILES  Lc  Disc Full  DISC FULL  Delete unneeded clips  or insert a disc with enough  gt   FOR MORE RECORDING  DELETE free space  g  SOME CLIPS     MAX SB CLP D NO MORE SUB CLIPS CAN BE ADDED   This appears when an attempt is made to add sub     TO CLIP LIST  clips when 300 sub clips have already been  registered   Limit the creation of sub clips to 300 or fewer   CL OVER DUR P DURATION OF ONE CLIP LIST MUST BE  This appears when you try to add a sub clip when the  LESS THAN 24 HOURS  total duration of sub clips in a clip list has already  reached 24 hours   Create clip lists so that the total duration is within 24  hours   Troubleshooting 1 63          xipueddy    164       Alarm message in time  data display area    Run Salvage    Alarm message in video monitor screen    EXECUTE SALVAGE PROGRAM     Description action    This appears when recording  E E display  essence  mark recording  or sub clip addition for quick scene  selection is attempted on a disc that needs to be  salvaged    Try again after salvaging the clips on the disc  see  page 58         CNT mode  9     COUNTER MODE IS SELECTED   SET COUNTER SELECT MENU TO TC  OR UB     This appears when CNTR SEL on the HOME page of  the function menu is set to    COUNTER     and you try   to preset timecode or user bits    To use timecode or user bits  set CNTR SEL to    TC    
130. DI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG 1  Analog 1 audio signal   AES EBU 1  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 1 2 connectors   SG  Test signal from internal signal  generator  Normally this item is not  displayed  It appears when you hold  the button down for 3 seconds  The  test signal is assigned to audio  channels 1 to 8 simultaneously    Press one of the function buttons  corresponding to A1 INPUT to A8  INPUT again to stop output of the  test signal    i LINK  i LINK signal  when the PDBK   201 option board is installed           F4  CHROMA          Sets the output level for HD SD chroma   signals  range     lt    to  3 dB     PRESET  Set the chroma signal output  level to a preset value  regardless of  manual setting    Manual setting  While the setting value  is flashing  turn the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to adjust the  chroma SETUP signal output level     F2  A2 INPUT    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 2    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG2  Analog 2 audio signal   AES EBU2  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 1 2 connectors          F3  MONITRL    Selects the channel to monitor as the left   monitor channel    CH1  CH2  CH3  CH4  CH5  CH6  CH7   CH8   CH1 2  CH3 4  CH5 6  CH7 8  MIX              F4  MONITR R       Selects the channel to monitor as the   right monitor channel    CH1  CH2  CH3  CH4  CH5  CH6  CH7   CH8   CH1 2  CH3 4  CH5 6  CH7 8  MIX           Basic Operations of the F
131. ECORDING FORMAT    Set the recording format   HD422  HD422   420HQ  HD420HQ  420SP  HD420SP    IMX50 IMX50Mbps   MPEG IMX 50 Mbps P  IMX40 IMX40Mbps   MPEG IMX 40 Mbps P  IMX30 IMX30Mbps   MPEG IMX 30 Mbps P  DVCAM  DVCAM D       033    BATTERY END VOLTAGE    Sets the voltage to shut down the unit in the battery operation  The battery  near end indicator flashes at  0 7 V of the set voltage   10 5V to 13 5V  10 5 V to 13 5 V in 0 5 V unit        034    MENU STATUS DISPLAY ON  VIDEO MONITOR 9    Specify whether to display the setup menu status at the left edge of the   status display line when setup menu item 005    DISPLAY INFORMATION   SELECT  is set to  T amp sta     dis  disable   Do not display    ena  enable   Display   The display is visible only when no disc is loaded   and during insertion and ejection of a disc         035    CLIP TITLE NAMING SELECT       Sub item    Specify whether to allow user definition of the titles assigned to clips   off  Do not allow assignment   on  Allow assignment     See  Assigning user defined clip titles   page 110  for more information  about assigning titles        1 TITLE    Specify whether to assign titles to recorded clips   disable  Do not assign titles to clips   enable  Assign titles to clips        2 PREFIX    Set the prefix of the title  up to 10 characters   The allowable characters are  alphanumeric characters  symbols  1   96  amp           8            and  the space character    TITLE       3 NUMERIC       Set the initia
132. EDIT MODE  select    cut edit  or    cross  fade      Audio mix See the next section    To set up mixing    of audio input signals          Time code   With TCG on page P5 TC of the Q  function menu  select    INT     g    With PRST RGN on page P5 TC of Ed  the function menu  select T     PRESET     ze    With RUN MODE on page P5 TC of i  the function menu  select    FREE    RUN     3  Repeat playback With setup menu item 142 REPEAT S  mode MODE  select    off     2  e  o             xoeg e g pue BuipiooeH y 1e1deuo    62    To set up mixing of audio input signals    By making setup menu settings  you can perform the   following kinds of audio mixing      Mixing of audio input signals      Changing the channels of audio input signals and  recording to disc      Mixing of audio input signals and audio that has been  recorded to disc  sound on sound      1 Display setup menu item 819 AUDIO INPUT  ARRANGE     See page 128 for more information about setup menu  operations        ITEM 819  AUDIO INPUT ARRANGE                   Input channels  Recording channels          To confirm the setting and return to the input  channel selection screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To exchange input channels   For example  turn input channel 2 on for recording  channel 1  and turn input channel   on for recording  channel 2     To mix multiple audio input signals  For each of the recording channels  turn any two input  channels on     To make sound on sound settings  In addition to the
133. EF of the function menu  is not being  input     This unit can automatically enter standby off mode  whenever a specified time elapses in disc stop mode  For  details  see the description of setup menu item 501 STILL  TIMER  page 135         REC  record  button   To start recording  hold down this button  and press the  PLAY button  The recording takes place on an unrecorded  part of the disc    To stop recording  press the STOP button     To monitor in E E mode   You can press this button from stop mode to monitor input  signals in E E mode  The button lights when pressed  Press  the STOP button to return to the original video    You can also press this button during playback and  searches  E E mode playback continues for as long as the  button is held down     To use the REC button as a remaining disc capacity   alarm   Make the following settings      Function menu page P7 OTHER  gt REC REMAIN  ALARM  enable     Setup menu item 150 REC MODE  disc exchange cache    When the remaining disc capacity drops below two  minutes  the button begins to flash  to prompt you to  exchange the disc     Q STANDBY indicator   Lights when the unit is in standby mode  STOP button and   STANDBY indicator lit     After a certain time passes in a disc stop mode  the unit  automatically enters standby off mode and the indicator  goes off     You can specify the time until the unit enters standby off  mode  For details  see the description of setup menu item  501 STILL TIMER  page 135      Q REC
134. EL  knob     The download starts    When the download finishes  the Downloading Result  Report screen appears    Select  OK   and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob  This returns you to the clip thumbnail screen              SU88J9S  MD ul suonejedo  s Ja deyD    Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function  1 03          SU99198  MD ui suoneiado 6 1e1deu    104       Copying clips directly between  XDCAM devices    In the field or another environment where the devices are  not connected to a network  you can copy  upload  clips  between XDCAM devices by connecting them directly   The example in the following procedure shows how to  copy a clip from this unit to a PDW HD1500  Insert discs  into both units and proceed as follows     1 Connect this unit and the PDW HD1500 by a network  cable     The cable can be either a cross cable or a straight cable                          00 o600600       Ha ooa     Network cable   not supplied                          Haone        PDW HD1500    2 se up the two units as follows        Item Setting    Item M50 in the maintenance menu  DHCP   ENABLE       Item M59 in the maintenance menu  UPnP   ENABLE                3 Power both units off and on again  and wait for about  three minutes     4 Check that the IP addresses of the two units have been  set as follows by the Auto IP function        Item Setting          menu  IP ADDRESS PRESET  X  any number     Item M51 in the maintenance 169 254  XXX XXX          D Inthe clip list thumbnail screen 
135. File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create   Delete  Any file Yes Yes Yes 9  Yes Yes                               a  UTF 8 file names can be up to 63 bytes in length   Depending on the  character type  file names  including extension  may be limited to 21  characters      General directory    The following directory operations are possible in the   UserData directory      Directory creation  up to 62 levels  including the  UserData directory      Deletion and renaming of directories          File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write Rename   Create   Delete  Any file Yes Yes Yes 9  Yes Yes                               a  UTF 8 file names can be up to 63 bytes in length   Depending on the  character type  file names  including extension  may be limited to 21  characters      The following directory operations are possible in the   General directory      Directory creation  up to 63 levels  including the  General directory     Overview       suoneledo e  9 1e1deu     109      Deletion and renaming of directories    The maximum number of files that can be created on a  disc is 5 000 for single layer discs and 6 000 for dual   layer discs  both including directories     File names and directory names can use letters  numbers   and symbols from the Unicode 2 0  UTF 8  character  set    However  the following control characters and  symbols D cannot be used      Control characters  U 0000 to U 001F  U 007F  
136. G    TC 00 23 00 25    TC 00 23 40 07    Clip Flag  NG 30 NOV 2005 13 40 pur 0 00 04 14       7 f you want to filter the clips again with a different  filtering condition  to narrow down the filtering  results   repeat steps 2 to 6   The command name  selected in step 4 changes to Filter Clips Narrowing       To play selected clips continuously  Register all of the filtered clips in an automatically  generated clip list  and play the clip list     1 Display the Thumbnail Menu in the filter thumbnail  screen     2 Select    Copy to Clip List     and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A clip list thumbnail screen appears  showing filtered  clips that have been registered in the clip list     Clip List  no name   TC 00 00 04 14  TC 00 00 12 04    0    TC 00 00 46 08    TC 00 00 20 13    TC 00 00 28 08 TC 00 00 35 15    New File      TOTAL DUR MORO OHSAS        3 Press the PLAY button     The screen changes to the clip playback screen  and  playback starts     Operations on filtering results    You can use the Thumbnail Menu in the filter thumbnail  screen to perform the following operations        Item name Function    Select the information to be  displayed at the bottom of the  thumbnails     Clip Information       Lock or Delete All Filtered  Clips  gt Lock All Filtered  Clips    Lock all of the filtered clips                    Item name    Lock or Delete All Filtered  Clips  gt Unlock All Filtered  Clips    Function  Unlock all of the filtered clips        Lock or Del
137. G  04 AUG 10 39  04 AUG 10 39    PM 003 sample  PM 004 sample    Name  amp Date  Sorted by Name       Depending on the type of USB flash drive  data may  not appear if you attempt to read planning metadata  immediately after connecting the USB flash drive  In  this case  connect the USB flash drive again  or exit the  menu and try again  The data will then appear  correctly     4 Select the desired planning metadata file  and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The selected planning metadata file is loaded into the  unit s memory  and the Planning Metadata Properties  screen appears     D Check the information that appears  and press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To sort planning metadata    You can sort planning metadata by operating in the same  way as in    To sort clip lists     page 93   However  in step  3  select Sort Planning Metadata by       The planning metadata will be displayed in the specified  order the next time you load planning metadata     To check planning metadata properties    You can check the properties of the planning metadata that  is loaded into this unit   s memory  including the date and  time of creation and the clip titles     See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Planning Metadata Properties  and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The Planning Metadata Properties screen appears     Planning Metadata Properties  LatestNews0034   Projections of world economi       gt   21
138. GALIZE  DC     For down converter output  selects whether to suppress signals with  levels that are lower than the pedestal level    off  Do not suppress signals lower than the pedestal level    on  Suppress signals lower than the pedestal level        950    UP CONVERTER MODE 9    Select the up converter mode    EDGE CROP  Select the edge crop mode   LETTER BOX  Select the letter box mode   SQUEEZE  Select the squeeze mode        951    H CROP POSITION  UC  9    Adjust the H crop  the horizontal position when cropping in the edge crop  mode  of the up converter output when menu item 950 is set to  crop       120 to 0 to 120          952       LETTER BOX POSITION  UC  9       When menu item 950 is set to  I box   adjust the vertical location of the  position where the picture is cut out for up converter output in letter box  mode       120 to 0 to 120       Setup Menu       Menu items in the 900s  relating to digital process                            Item number   Item name Settings  953 UP CONVERTER PROCESS  UC       Select the source picture to use in converting SD to HD   FIELD  Use field pictures   ADAPTIVE  Frame or field is selected automatically   954 DETAIL GAIN  UC  9 Adjust the up converter image enhancer  the sharpness of edge  enhancement   0 to 40H to 7FH  955 LIMITER  UC  9 Adjust the up converter image enhancer  the maximum detail level added  to emphasize the original signal   0 to 20H to 3FH  956 CRISP THRESHOLD  UC  9 Adjust the up converter image enhancer 
139. HD video monitor    Audio monitor       Laptop computer             System Configurations       M  MAQ   Je deuo    15       M  Q   491deuS    16       Using the CD ROM  Manual    The supplied CD ROM includes versions of the Operation  Manual for the PDW HD1500 in English  Japanese   French  German  Italian  Spanish and Chinese in PDF  format        Preparations    The following program must be installed on your computer  in order to read the operation manuals contained on the  CD ROM      Adobe Reader Version 6 0 or higher       Memo             If Adobe Reader is not installed  you can download it from  the following URL   http   www adobe com     Adobe and Adobe Reader are trademarks of Adobe  Systems Incorporated in the United States and or other  countries        Reading the CD ROM manual    To read the operation manual contained on the CD ROM   do the following     1 Insert the CD ROM in your CD ROM drive     A cover page appears automatically in your browser   If it does not appear automatically in the browser   double click on the index htm file on the CD ROM     2 Select and click on the operation manual that you want  to read     This opens the PDF file of the operation manual        Memo             The files may not be displayed properly  depending on the  version of Adobe Reader  In such a case  install the latest  version you can download from the URL mentioned in     Preparations    above     If you have lost or damaged the CD ROM  you can  purchase a new one t
140. ION  set to  stop   Perform the operation after stopping  playback    No EM space ESSENCE MARK NOT RECORDED  Use the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software to delete   NO SPACE AVAILABLE TO RECORD unneeded essence marks   ESSENCE MARK  Or  delete unneeded shot marks in the chapter   EM Full NO MORE ESSENCE MARKS CAN BE __    umbnail screen     RECORDED        Disc Damage    DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED TO   USE ANOTHER DISC FOR RECORDING     Use another disc                                         NON AV Full DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED TO  Delete unneeded GENERAL files   FOR MORE RECORDING SPACE   DELETE NON AV DATA   GENERAL  FILES    Index File  UNSUPPORT INDEX FILE  Use another disc   DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED TO    File System CURRENT VERSION OF THE This appears when you insert a disc that can be  SOFTWARE SETS THE DISC WRITE played back but not recorded   PROTECTED  Exchange the disc for one with a file system  FILE SYSTEM ON THE DISC INHIBITS putas by this unit  Or format the disc  see  WRITING  page 30     Loading  a  LOADING  This appears if you press a button while a disc is  loading  Wait until the disc has finished loading and  try again    Unloading  9 UNLOADING  This appears if you press a button while a disc is  unloading    Wait until the disc has finished unloading and try  again    Clip lock  CLIP IS LOCKED  This appears when an operation is attempted on a   UNLOCK CLIP IN THUMBNAIL MENU  locked clip  or when an edit preset command is  received for such a clip  Use the Thumbnai
141. Item  F1  CHAR SEL    Setting    Turns the display of character   information on the color LCD and on an   external monitor on and off    ON  Character information on   OFF  Character information off   LCD  Character information on for the  color LCD only       F2  PB EE Selects the type of video and audio  signals to output during fast forward  fast  reverse  stop  and standby    PB  Playback signal    EE  E E signal       F3  REC INH Specifies whether to inhibit recording to  the disc   OFF  Do not inhibit recording     ON  Inhibit recording to the disc                    Item  F4  CNTR SEL    Setting    Selects the type of time data to display in   the time data display area    TC  Timecode   COUNTER  Elapsed recording or  playback time   UB  User bits       F5  TCG SET      When CNTR SEL is set to    TC       displays a screen where you can set  the initial value of the timecode  generated by the internal timecode  generator 9  see page 43       When CNTR SEL is set to  UB     displays a screen where you can set    timecode user bits 9  see page 44      Item    F5  HUE CHRM  PHS    Setting    Sets the hue  chroma phase     PRESET  Set the hue  chroma phase  to  a preset value  regardless of manual  setting    Manual setting  While the setting value  is flashing  turn the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to adjust the hue   chroma phase  over the range   30             F6            Unassigned function button           a  This is displayed only when TCG on page P5 TC of the function 
142. M   Acquires the date and time of the most recent modification  of the file in the format  Y Y Y YMMDDhhmmss   YYYY   year  MM  month  DD  day  hh  hour  mm  minute  ss   second      The date and time cannot be acquired in the following   cases    e When the path name includes a wildcard           replaced  by any string of characters  or          replaced by any single  character       When the size of the path name is greater than 1023  bytes     Command syntax  MDTM   SP    lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt   Input example  MDTM PROAV DISCMETA XML    Extended commands    In the Command syntax    SP   means a space  entered by  pressing the space bar  and  lt CRLF gt  means a new line   entered by pressing the Enter key     SITE REPF   Sends an MXF file from the specified path on this unit to  the remote computer  This command allows you to specify  a segment in the body of the MXF file  composed of video  and audio data   for transfer of the required segment only       A segment greater than the file size cannot be specified     This command cannot be used when the path names  contains a space  Use the SITE REPFL command  instead   Command syntax  SITE REPF   SP    lt path name gt   lt SP gt     start frame     SP    lt transfer size gt   lt CRLF gt      lt start frame gt  specifies an offset from the start of the file   Data is transferred from the video frame at the offset  the  first frame is O       transfer size   specifies the number of video frames to  transfer  specify 
143. M connection   Clips for which disc defects have been detected     Clips for which errors have been detected  such as  when the unit s primary power was turned off during  linear editing     Clips recovered by the salvage function   Normally  linear editing on this unit can target only clips   that have been created on XDCAM devices  It may not   be possible to edit clips that been created by other   software applications and uploaded to this unit as files    In rare cases  errors may occur on the recorder side if you   execute a first edit on an unrecorded disc  If this occurs    execute the first edit again     Editable clip recording formats    This unit supports editing of the following recording  formats    e MPEG HD422 1080 59 941 29 97P 501 25P 23 98P    MPEG HD422 720 59 94P 50P   e MPEG IMX 59 941 50i   e DVCAM 59 94i 50i    Editing of the MPEG HD420 format is not supported     Editable video and audio signals    This unit supports editing of the following signals on video  and audio tracks     Video    HD SDI  for HD recording     SD SDI  for SD recording     Audio    SDI    Analog    AES EBU    e Video and audio signals input to the  amp   i LINK  S400  connector cannot be edited      Editing cannot be done with a File Access Mode  FAM   connection      Recording of upconverted SD is not supported     Discs that can be used    Use the following Professional Discs           Model number   Capacity Data transfer rate   writing    PFD23A 23 3 GB 2 4 times normal   PFD
144. NT OR PROSPECTIVE PROFITS  DUE TO FAILURE OF THIS UNIT  EITHER  DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD OR AFTER  EXPIRATION OF THE WARRANTY  OR FOR  ANY OTHER REASON WHATSOEVER                 Using PDZ 1 Proxy  Browsing Software    When a computer with the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing  Software installed is connected to this unit  you can  transfer the proxy AV data and metadata files recorded on  a disc to the computer  On the computer side  PDZ 1  enables you to browse the proxy AV data  add or modify  metadata  titles  comments  essence marks  etc    or create  a clip list    The modified metadata and the created clip list can then be  written back to the disc loaded in this unit     For more information about PDZ 1 functions and  operations  refer to the PDZ 1 help     System requirements    The following are required to use PDZ 1    Computer  PC with Intel Pentium M processor  at least 1  GHz  installed memory  at least 512 MB    Operating system  Microsoft Windows XP Professional  SP3 or higher  Microsoft Windows Vista Business   Ultimate  32 bit 64 bit  SP2 or higher  or Microsoft  Windows 7 Professional Ultimate  32 bit 64 bit    Web browser  Internet Explorer 6 0 SP1 or higher  DirectX  DirectX 8 1b or higher    To install PDZ 1    Insert the supplied XDCAM Application Software CD   ROM into the CD ROM drive of your computer  and then  run the installer in the PDZ 1 directory of the CD ROM     For details  refer to the ReadMe file contained on the CD   ROM disc     Make sure that the h
145. O to transfer to the end of the file      Input example  SITE REPF Clip C0001 MXF 5 150   Transfer C0001 MXF  Body data is transferred only  from frame 6 to frame 150      SITE REPFL   Sends an MXF file from the specified path on this unit to  the remote computer  This command allows you to specify  a segment in the body of the MXF file  composed of video  and audio data   for transfer of the required segment only     A segment greater than the file size cannot be specified   Command syntax  SITE REPFL   SP       lt path name gt        SP    lt start frame gt    SP    lt transfer size gt   lt CRLF gt      lt path name gt  specifies the path name of the file to transfer    Enclose the path name in double quotation marks     lt start frame gt  specifies an offset from the start of the file    Data is transferred from the video frame at the offset  the   first frame is 0      lt transfer size gt  specifies the number of video frames to   transfer  specify O to transfer to the end of the file     Input example  SITE REPFL    Clip sakura 0001 MXF    5 150    Transfer sakura 0001 MXF  Body data is transferred  only from frame 6 to frame 150      SITE FSTS  Acquires the system status of this unit   One of the following status codes is sent     0  Initial state  or no disc is loaded     1  File system mount is OK     3  File system mount is not OK   Command syntax  SITE FSTS  lt CRLF gt     SITE MEID  Acquires the media ID of the disc loaded in this unit   Command syntax  SITE MEID  
146. PEG LA TO PROVIDE  MPEG 4 VIDEO     NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED  FOR ANY OTHER USE  ADDITIONAL  INFORMATION INCLUDING THAT RELATING TO  PROMOTIONAL  INTERNAL AND COMMERCIAL  USES AND LICENSING MAY BE OBTAINED FROM  MPEG LA  LLC  SEE HTTP   WWW MPEGLA COM    MPEG LA is offering licenses for  i  manufacturing sales of any storage  media storing MPEG 4 Visual video information  ii  distribution   broadcasting of MPEG 4 Visual video information in any manner  such as  online video distribution service  internet broadcasting  TV broadcasting    Other usage of this product may be required to obtain license from  MPEGLA  Please contact MPEG LA for any further information  MPEG LA   L L C   250 STEELE STREET  SUITE 300  DENVER  COLORADO  80206  http   www mpegla com       MPEG 2 video patent portfolio  license    ANY USE OF THIS PRODUCT OTHER THAN  CONSUMER PERSONAL USE IN ANY MANNER  THAT COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG 2 STANDARD  FOR ENCODING VIDEO INFORMATION FOR  PACKAGED MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY PROHIBITED  WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER APPLICABLE  PATENTS IN THE MPEG 2 PATENT PORTFOLIO   WHICH LICENSE IS AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA   L L C   250 STEELE STREET  SUITE 300  DENVER   COLORADO 80206        PACKAGED MEDIA    means any storage media storing MPEG 2 video  information such as DVD movie which are sold distributed to general  consumers  Disc replicators or sellers of the PACKAGED MEDIA need to  obtain licenses for their own business from MPEG LA  Please contact MPEG  LA for any furt
147. PnP function   The UPnP  universal plug and play  function allows  devices to be easily connected to networks  The following  XDCAM devices support UPnP      PDW F1600     PDW HD1500     PDW HRI     PDW F800     PDW 700    To enable the UPnP function on this unit  set maintenance  menu item M59  UPnP to ENABLE  and then power the  unit off and on again     For the settings on other XDCAM devices  refer to the  operation manuals supplied with the devices        Uploading clips    To upload entire clips    Proceed as follows to upload selected clips or all clips and  clip lists on the disc     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip thumbnail screen  select the clip to upload   multiple selections possible      To upload all clips and clip lists on the disc  start from  step 2     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Upload Clips via Direct FTP  and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The Select Transfer Type screen of the Upload Clips  via Direct FTP command appears     Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Select Transfer Type    Selected Clips 2 Clips    9 All Clips  amp  ClipList 42 Clips 19 ClipLists        UMID Unchange    Cancel    gt      4 Select the type of clip transfer     Selected Clips  Clips selected in step 1   All Clips  amp  ClipList  All clips and clip lists on the  disc     Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function        To transfer while preserving the UMID of the  transfer source clips  Check the    UMID Uncha
148. S   102  H11 0PE HOURS r  102                      Setup Menu    To display menus on the external monitor  Connect the monitor to the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector  SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER   connector  or HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector on  this unit  and press the MENU button     To display menus in the time data display area  Press the MENU button to display a setup menu on the  video monitor display  and press the DISPLAY button   The video monitor display is switched the basic operation  display  and the number and setting of the currently  selected menu item appear in the time data display area                    1H01  000108    Item number  flashing  Setting             To display the full item name  Hold down the NEXT button     Buttons used to change settings    Use the following buttons to change setup menu settings        Menu control Functions    buttons    MENU button   Displays and hides the setup and user  interface menus     Returns to the menu from a setting    Screen        PUSH  SET S SEL  knob      When turned clockwise or  counterclockwise  moves the         mark  up or down in the list of menu items to  select the item to change      When turned clockwise or  counterclockwise  changes a menu  item setting      When pressed  answers  Yes  to a  question                    Menu control Functions    buttons    Function buttons   RETURN  Goes up one level     F1 to F6 SELECT  Selects an item    The function to UP  Skips back 100 or 50 items in the  be 
149. S SEL  knob while holding  down the PAGE HOME button changes the page  forward or backward    Pressing F1 to F6 buttons while holding down the  PAGE HOME button switches the page directly to pages  P1 to P6  Pressing the F1 button again while the page P1  is displayed switches the page to P7  Pressing the F2    Basic Operations of the Function Menu    button again while the page P2 is displayed switches the  page to P8     To clear the function menu from the screen  Press the DISPLAY button to switch to the video monitor  display     To change the setting of a function menu  item  Use the function buttons     To select the value of the setting item   Press the button to the left of each setting item to change  the value of the item  Keep pressing the button until the  value you want appears     To set the value of the setting item     Press the button to the left of each setting item so that the  setting value flashes to enable adjustment of the value  and then turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to increase or  decrease the value    Turning the PUSH SET S SEL  knob while holding  down the SHIFT button increases the increment of  adjustment    Pressing the button to the left of each setting item while  the setting value is flashing causes the value to stop  flashing and completes the adjustment        Function menu settings  The following tables list the setting items on each page and    describe their setting values  Underlined values are the  factory defaults     HOME page       
150. SEL  knob     A message appears asking you to confirm the format     Format Disc    All Clips  Clip Lists and  Non AV Data  General Files   will be Deleted     Format OK     Cancel       3 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     Disc Operations    To cancel the format  Select Cancel  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     To continue by formatting another disc  Exchange the disc  select OK  and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To exit the formatting screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob with Exit selected     To disable the Format Disc command   To prevent inadvertent disc formatting  resulting in the  loss of recorded data  you can disable the Format Disc  command    See page 75 for more information about GUI information     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Settings  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     3 Select Setting Format Disc  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     4 Select Disable  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob        Displaying disc and clip properties  in a web browser    By connecting this unit and a computer over a network   you can display disc properties and clip properties in a web  browser installed on the computer  Web Thumbnail  function     The Clip Properties page also allows you to download  high resolution clip data  proxy AV data  and metadata  from this unit and to save that data on your computer     Recommended browsers    The following browsers are recommended      nternet Explorer 7 1     I
151. SEL  knob     Name A Z   Sort in ascending order by clip list name     Date Newest First   Sort by date and time of clip list  creation  newest first     Clip lists will be displayed in the specified order the  next time that you carry out an operation such as  loading a clip list     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing           SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo  s Ja deyo    93          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedo  s je1deu 2    94       Disc Operations       Checking disc properties    See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Disc Properties  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Disc Properties screen appears     Disc Properties    User Disc ID 12345   Title1 One of the memories of sum        Title2  none    Total DUR 01 23 45 00   Remain 031min   Rewrite 1234times    Horizontal Scroll  gt     User Disc ID  User disc ID P 2     Title1  Title1 P   Title2  Title2        Total DUR  Total recording time  Remain  Remaining recording time  Rewrite  Number of times rewritten    1 This can be specified with the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software on  the supplied XDCAM Application Software CD ROM    2 When the unit   s area of use  UC J MODEL SELECT   see page 33   is set to    UC     titles can be displayed in European languages    3 You can use planning metadata to set it  see page 157      To scroll hidden parts of the string into view  When a  lt  or  gt  mark is displayed for an item  you can  press the   IN or   OUT butt
152. SET S SEL  knob              P3 AUDIO page    F3  A7 VOL    Sets the volume of audio channel 7  9  The volume can be adjusted within the  range from    200 to  200     e to  12 dB   by turning the PUSH SET S SEL  knob           Item  F1  A3 INPUT    Setting    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 3    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG 1  Analog 1 audio signal   AES EBUS  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 3 4 connectors    F4  A8 VOL    Sets the volume of audio channel 8  2   The volume can be adjusted within the  range from    200 to  200     e to  12 dB   by turning the PUSH SET S SEL  knob           F2  A4 INPUT    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 4    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG2  Analog 2 audio signal   AES EBU4  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 3 4 connectors    F5  MIX SWAP P    Specifies whether to perform audio  mixing according to the settings of setup  menu item 819 AUDIO INPUT  ARRANGE    OFF  Do not perform audio mixing    ON  Perform audio mixing        F6  AU METER          Selects the display mode of the audio   level meters    FULL  Display the range from    60 dB to  0 dB    FINE  Display a magnified section with  0 25 dB step marks           F3  A5 INPUT    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 5    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG 1  Analog 1 audio signal   AES EBU 1  Signal input to the DIGITAL  
153. SMPTE436M 2006  and can be output   This data can also be input and recorded on the disc     To insert ancillary data into MXF files to  output    In setup menu item 666 METADATA ITEM OUT  select   on   see page 136      HANC VANC packets    Detection of HANC VANC packets   HANCY V ANC packets are recorded on the disc only when  the DATA ITEM of the head frame is identified as ANC  Frame Elements conforming to the SMPTE436M 2006  when an MXF file is input        General MXF metadata    This unit examines the data contained in the header  metadata area    when an MXF file is input  If the data is  identified as the data created by the device other than  XDCAM at this time  one file  KLVE file  is created     1  The header metadata area contains the metadata information about the  entire file  See SMPTE377M for details     For details  see    Directory structure     page 106  and     Clip directory     page 108         Closed caption data    This section explains the closed caption data that can be  recorded  played back  and output during EE output        Legend    mmc    Signal I O by standard function   gt    Signal I O by optional function             Standard functions    Normal EIA 708 608 recording and playback   In response to closed caption input data that complies with  the EIA 708 608 standards  record  play  and output that  data with no changes    However  settings are required for recording of closed  caption data in HDSDI signals     For details  see  To record a
154. SON Y   PROFESSIONAL DISC RECORDER    PDW F1600  PDW HD1500       The supplied CD ROM includes operation manuals for the PDW F1600 HD1500  Professional Disc Recorder  English  Japanese  French  German  Italian  Spanish and  Chinese versions  in PDF format    For more details  see  Using the CD ROM Manual    on page 16              Professional Disc Syste    2  gt    CINEAITA    DL    OPERATION MANUAL  Ist Edition  Revised 4  TN    2    Important Safety Instructions    Read these instructions    Keep these instructions    Heed all warnings    Follow all instructions    Do not use this apparatus near water    Clean only with dry cloth    Do not block any ventilation openings    Install in accordance with the manufacturer s instructions     Donotinstall near any heat sources such as radiators  heat  registers  stoves  or other apparatus  including amplifiers    that produce heat      Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or  grounding type plug  A polarized plug has two blades with  one wider than the other  A grounding type plug has two  blades and a third grounding prong  The wide blade or the  third prong are provided for your safety  If the provided plug  dose not fit into your outlet  consult an electrician for  replacement of the obsolete outlet      Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched  particularly at plugs  convenience receptacles  and the point  where they exit from the apparatus      Only use attachments accessories specified by the  manu
155. STEM FREQUENCY SELECTION  DIFFER FROM IT ON DISC        This appears when mixed format recording mode is  disabled  and the system frequency setting of this unit  does not match the system frequency of voice over  clips on the inserted disc    Insert a disc with a system frequency that matches  the system frequency of this unit  or change the  system frequency setting of this unit           Troubleshooting       xipueddy    171          xipueddy    172       Error messages    Error codes appear in the time data display when an error   usually a hardware problem  occurs  In addition  both  error messages and error codes appear in the monitor video  section and on the video monitor connected to the unit   When an error message appears  follow the instructions in  the error message to resolve the problem     Error code    Error50 010    Error code in time data display area                ERROR    AN ERROR HAS BEEN  DETECTED  INFORM SERUICE    OF FOLLOUING CODE   50 010       PRESS EJECT KEY  TO EJECT DISC              Error code    Example error in video monitor screen       To eject discs with the unit powered  off    As an emergency measure  disc cartridges can be removed  with the unit powered off  This operation should always be  done by a trained service technician     Specifications       Specifications    General    External dimensions  w h d  excluding projections   210x132x396 mm  8 3 gx5   4x15 Vg  inches        noon nnmgt hn                      396  15 5 5           
156. Set the IP address of this unit   192 168 001 010       P address cannot be set when DHCP is set to  ENABLE      To check the automatically acquired IP address of this unit  close the maintenance menu  and then open it again        M52  SUBNET MASK PRESET       Set the subnet mask   255 255 255 000      Subnet mask cannot be set when DHCP is set to  ENABLE      To check the automatically acquired subnet mask  close the maintenance menu and then  open it again           Maintenance Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    151          snue wN 4 Jejdeuj    152    M5  NETWORK  Items relating to network settings       Item    M53  DEFAULT GATEWAY  PRESET    Setting    Set the address of the default gateway   000 000 000 000      The address of the default gateway cannot be set when DHCP is set to  ENABLE      To check the automatically acquired address of the default gateway  close the maintenance  menu and then open it again        M54  LINK SPEED    Set the communications speed   AUTO  10Mbps  100Mbps  1000Mbps       M55  DUPLEX    Set the communications method   AUTO  Full Duplex  Half Duplex    For how to set the communication method  see  To change network settings   page 153         M56  JUMBO FRAME 9    Set the size of jumbo frames   9014  4088  OFF 1514     This value does not include the 4 bytes of the FCS  Frame Check Sequence         M57  DNS1    Set the address of DNS server 1   000 000 000 000      The address of DNS server 1 cannot be set when DHCP is set to    ENABLE       
157. Set the communications speed  LINK SPEED  and  communications method  DUPLEX  to match the network  environment     To set the communications speed and communications  protocol  proceed as explained in the previous section    To  display the maintenance menu    to display the NETWORK  menu and then proceed as follows     Contact your network administrator if you have any  questions about the proper settings for these items     To set the communications speed    1 Select maintenance menu item M5  NETWORK   gt M54  LINK SPEED     2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The communications speeds  AUTO  10Mbps   100Mbps  and 1000Mbps  appear  and the arrow  flashes     3 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or use the      MARKI or   MARK2 button to select a  communications speed     To return to the factory default setting  Press the RESET RETURN button     4 Press the SAVE function button  F5    This returns to the NETWORK menu     To set the communications protocol    1 Select maintenance menu item M5  NETWORK   gt M55  DUPLEX     Maintenance Menu    2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The communications protocols  AUTO  Full Duplex   Half Duplex  appear  and the arrow flashes     3 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or use the     MARK 1 or    MARK2 button to select a  communications protocol     To return to the factory default setting  Press the RESET RETURN button     4 Press the SAVE function button  F5    This returns to the NETWORK menu     Planning Metadata       Overview    Plann
158. T NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE          Part 3  Cambridge Broadband Ltd  copyright notice   BSD           Portions of this code are copyright  c  2001 2003   Cambridge Broadband Ltd   All rights reserved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or   without modification  are permitted provided that the   following conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer     Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution    The name of Cambridge Broadband Ltd  may not be  used to endorse or promote products derived from this  software without specific prior written permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDER  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS  OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT  LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE  LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT   INCIDENT
159. T or SHIFT      IN       Exit  exit the current thumbnail screen           THUMBNAIL          a  If Settings  gt SET Key on Thumbnail in the Disc Menu is set to    Cue up  amp     Play     then playback starts as soon as cueup is ready     b  If Settings  gt SET Key on Thumbnail in the Disc Menu is set to    Cue up  amp     Play     then pressing the PUSH SET S SEL  knob has the same effect     Shortcut List       SU9BINS  ND ui suonejedo g JaydeyD    105          suonejedo e 4 9 1e1deu     106    File Operations       Overview    A remote computer can be connected to this unit and used  to operate on recorded data which has been saved in data  files  such as video and audio data files   There are two ways to connect a remote computer     FAM connection  Connect the f   i LINK  S400 connector on this unit to  the i LINK  IEEE1394  connector on the remote  computer  using an i LINK cable  see page 36      FTP connection  Connect the network connectors on this unit and the  remote computer  using a network cable  see page 36         Directory structure    The following figure shows the directory structure of discs  visible to a remote computer     This structure is not the same as the actual structure  recorded on the disc     Overview    Chapter       root 9        INDEX XML       ALIAS XML 9             DISCMETA XML          MEDIAPRO XML       uj m pu ug pug          SYSPRO XML             Li    Clip    p         C0001 MXF       J          C0001M01 XML          C0001M02 KLV  
160. This unit cannot be controlled from devices connected to  the REMOTE 9P  connector  D sub 9 pin  and     i LINK  S400 connector    Signal input to this unit and signal output from this unit  are stopped     File Operations in File Access Mode  for Windows        suonejedo e  9 1e1deuj    113          suoneJedo aji4 9 1e1deu     114       Operating on files    1 Start Explorer     Check that a drive letter has been assigned to this unit    The drive letter will differ depending on the number  of other peripherals connected to the remote  computer      2 Use Explorer to perform file operations on the disc  loaded in this unit     You can operate in the same way that you operate on  local drives and files on network computers        f you power this unit off during a FAM connection   the data transferred thus far is discarded      All file operations are not possible for some types of  files     For details  see    File operation restrictions      page 107      To eject discs from a remote computer  Right click the icon representing this unit in Explorer  and  select    Eject    from the menu which appears        Exiting file operations    For Windows XP or Windows Vista    Do not disconnect the cable before performing steps 1 to 3     1 Do one of the following on the ue  Or icon    displayed in the remote computer s taskbar       Double click     Right click  and select the    Safely Remove  Hardware      The    Safely Remove Hardware  dialog appears     2 Select  Sony XDCAM PD
161. UI screen  operations     1 Select the thumbnail that you want to cue up     Clip C0010 010 041    El   OK f  TC 00 23 00 25    TC 00 24 45 11 TC 00 25 06 14   EMB s S  m MAN u F  TC 00 27 51 09  Fw TT  FLA    TC 00 28 06 09 TC 00 28 22 02 TC 00 23 34 18 TC 00 23 54 22  DATE amp TIME 30 NOV 2005 13 40 pun 0 00 04 14    TC 00 25 49 23 TC 00 27 19 04    P a     Bi    5      2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To play clips with the PUSH SET S SEL  knob   In the Disc Menu  set Settings  gt SET Key on Thumbnail to     Cue up  amp  Play   Playback begins from the selected frame  when you press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob  in the same  way as when you press the PLAY button     To search for a thumbnail position and  play from there    See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 select the thumbnail that you want to play     2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  button     TCR 00 26 22 10  PLAY  C0010  010 041             Selecting clips by type  Filter Clips  function   You can select clips of a certain type from among all of the    clips on a disc  Filter Clips function   For example  you  can do the following     Thumbnail Operations       SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo g Ja deyD    79          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedo  s Je1deu     80      Select clips in a certain video format from a disc that  contains clips in different video formats      Select clips that have been set  NG  as a clip flag  and  delete all of those clips in one operation      Select only clips that have
162. W        IEEE 1394  SBP2 Device                F1600    or    HD1500     and  click    Stop        The    Stop a Hardware device    dialog appears   3 Select    Sony XDCAM PDW        IEEE 1394    SBP2 Device              F1600  or    HD1500     and  click    OK        File Operations in File Access Mode  for Windows     Windows XP     Sony XDCAM PDW        IEEE  1394 SBP2 Device                F1600    or     HD1500     is deleted from the    Hardware devices   list    Windows Vista  A message appears to inform you  that you can now safely remove the device from  your computer     This unit can now resume normal operations   The  limitations described in    Operation limitations during  FAM connections    no longer apply      4 Disconnect the i LINK cable as required     For Windows 7    Do not disconnect the cable before performing step 1     1 Click the icon displayed in the remote computer s  taskbar  and then click    Eject Solid state disk         The    Sony XDCAM PDW        IEEE 1394 SBP2  Device  device can now be safely removed from the  computer              F1600    or  HD1500   appears   This unit can now resume normal operations   The  limitations described in  Operation limitations during  FAM connections  no longer apply      2 Disconnect the i LINK cable as required     To reconnect    To reconnect after exiting file operations  do one of the   following  depending on whether an i LINK cable is   connected    i LINK cable is not connected  Connect this unit an
163. WD    command    force  Perform repeat playback during normal playback and 0 to  2 times  normal speed variable playback in the forward direction  To select  repeat playback in this mode from a device connected to the  REMOTE 9P  connector  send the    PLAY    command or the    VAR  FWD    command     Set to    off    to perform linear editing        143    INDEX PICTURE POSITION    Select the frame of the clip to use as the thumbnail image  index picture    when recording    Osec to 10sec  Can be set in the range from 0 seconds  first frame of the  clip  to10 seconds  in units of 1 second        145          MODE KEY ENABLE DURING  RECORDING       Select whether the STOP button is the only button that stops recording   ena  all enable   Recording stops when the EJECT button 9  PLAY  button  STOP button  SHTL JOG button  and VAR JOG button P  are    pressed   stop  Recording stops only when the STOP button is pressed        1 32 Setup Menu       Menu items in the 100s  relating to the control panels       Item number  150    Item name  REC MODE    Settings    Select the recording mode    normal  Normal recording mode   D EXC  disc exchange cache   Disc Exchange Cache mode  C REC  clip continuous rec   Clip Continuous Rec mode       151    GUI OPERATION    Select whether to disable the display of the Thumbnail Menu and Disc  Menu when this unit is in any mode other than stop mode   ena enable   Do not disable    stop via stop   Enable the display of menus in the stop mode   di
164. When the remote control switch is  set to REMOTE  displays the name of the interface  selected with setup menu item 214 REMOTE  INTERFACE       Clip playback mode  The clip playback mode appears  as follows  according to the settings of setup menu  items 142 REPEAT MODE and 154 SINGLE CLIP  PLAY MODE                    Display   Setup menu setting   Description  Item 142   Item 154  REPEAT      play  amp  off Repeat playback  VAR fwd    mode  Perform  or    force    repeat playback of  all clips on the disc   SINGLE   off on Single clip playback  mode  Play the  currently selected  clip once   SNGL    play  amp  on Single clip repeat  RPT VAR fwd    playback mode   or    force    Play the currently  selected clip  repeatedly   No off off Continuous  display playback mode   Perform continuous  playback of all clips  on the disc  playing  each clip once                        E  Jog shuttle dial mode  Appears when the unit is in  shuttle  jog  or variable mode        Format conversion  This displays the status of 1080 720 format conversion     Format conversion is not being performed                 Front Panel      Format conversion is being performed     See page 64 for more information about 1080 720 cross  convert function        Reference signal   This displays the type of reference signal to which this unit  is synchronizing    When there is no display  the unit is synchronizing to the  internal reference signal    INPUT  Input video   HD REF  HD format reference signal  
165. ack field frame mode    auto  Field playback   frame  Frame playback  Compared to field playback  frame playback  gives more detail during playback of still pictures        130    DISPLAY DIMMER CONTROL    Set the brightness of the indication on the LCD   10   25   50   75   100           131    AUDIO VOLUME    Select whether each of the CH 1 ALL CH  CH 2 to CH 4 adjustment  knobs on the control panel is effective to control the audio recording level  and playback level on each channel or the CH 1 ALL CH adjustment  knob alone functions as a master control to control the audio level on all  channels together   each  Each of the CH 1 ALL CH  CH 2 to CH 4 adjustment knobs is  effective to control each channel   all  The CH 1 ALL CH adjustment knob alone functions as a master  control   When    all    is selected  the ALL CH indicator under the CH 1 ALL CH  adjustment knob lights up        140    AREA MARKER    Select whether to display the display area of SD output on the color LCD   off  Do not display   on  Display              142    snuey  Z Jajdeup    REPEAT MODE    Put the unit into repeat playback mode  or exit from repeat playback   mode    off  Exits from repeat playback mode    play  amp  VAR fwd  Perform repeat playback during normal playback and 0  to  2 times normal speed variable playback in the forward direction   To select repeat playback in this mode from a device connected to  the REMOTE 9P  connector  send the    REPEAT PLAY    command or  the    REPEAT VAR F
166. ack in clip list order  see  page 87   Jog and shuttle operations are supported  during clip list playback  To return to playback in  recording order  press the button again  turning the  indicator off     If no clip list is registered  this button does not light  when pressed  The operation is invalid     DISC MENU button  When pressed together with the  SHIFT button  displays the Disc Menu  see page 94    Press the button again  turning the indicator off  to  hide the Disc Menu     See  GUI screen operations   page 75  for more  information about how to use the thumbnail screens       THUMBNAIL button and indicator   To carry out a thumbnail search or create a clip list in the  GUI screen  press this button turning the indicator on   Thumbnail images representing each clip or sub clip  appear  Press once more  turning the indicator off  to return  to a whole screen display    To display the thumbnails of essence mark frames  frames  with an essence mark attached   hold down the SHIFT  button  and press this button  The essence mark selection  menu appears  Select the desired type of essence mark  and  the corresponding essence mark frames appear in  thumbnails  Press once more  turning the indicator off  to  return to a whole screen display     See  GUI screen operations   page 75  for more  information about how to use the thumbnail screens     Q DISPLAY button  Each press of this button switches between the basic    operation display and video monitor display  see page 23
167. age 143  Items Settings relating to disc page 135 t    50010599   protection 900 to 999   processing             Items in the basic menu    The basic menu items  excluding the items related to the  digital hours meter  are listed in the following table        tem names are the names which appear on the video  monitor screen of this unit and an external monitor     when the input signals to the monitor are the video  signals output from the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER     connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER   connector   e An abbreviated name appears in the time data display  area when you press the NEXT button   The values in the Settings column are the values which  appear in the time data display area   The values may  appear in a different format on an external monitor  In  this case  the external monitor values are shown in  parentheses   Underlined values are the factory defaults        Item number  001    Item name  PREROLL TIME    Settings    0 s  0 sec     5 s  5 sec     30 s  30 sec   Set the preroll time to between 0  and 30 seconds in steps of 1 second   A preroll time of at least 5 seconds is recommended when using this  unit for editing        002          snus  Z Jejdeuj    CHARACTER H POSITION    Adjust the horizontal screen position  as a hexadecimal value  of the text   information output from the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector    the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2    SUPER  connector for
168. ails  indicate frames where Shot Mark1  Shot Mark2  and Rec  Start essence marks are set        Chapter number total chapters  Displays the total number of chapters and the number of  the selected chapter     The total number of chapters is the total number of  chapters in the specified clip only     Q Scrollbar    See the description in  Clip thumbnail screen   page 70      Q Clip name  Displays the name or a title of the clip whose chapter is  displayed  see page 69      Q Duration    Displays the time from the first frame of the selected  chapter to the first frame of the next chapter     Overview    Essence mark thumbnail screen    This screen displays thumbnails of the specified essence  mark  found by searching all clips on the disc     zem  TC 00 25 07 01 TC 00 25 40 24    TC 00 27 51 25 TC 00 28 06 17    TC 00 26 22 11    wd  dia    TC 00 27 19 25    TC 00 28 35 00        TC 00 28 55 02  30 NOV 2006 19 55    TC 00 29 10 05 TC 00 29 20 03   Capping literally years of spe             Essence mark name   Displays the name of the essence mark  Shot Mark1 here    If the shot mark name has been defined by the user  it is  enclosed in quotation marks       in the display  see  page 96         Selection frame  See the description in    Clip thumbnail screen     page 70         Essence mark number total essence marks  Displays the total number of essence marks and the  number of the selected essence mark     The total number of essence marks is the total number of  essence mar
169. als  from those during playback     2   CONVERT Select the up converter mode    CROP  Select the edge crop mode   L BOX  Select the letter box mode   SQUEZ  Select the squeeze mode    3  H CROP P When sub item UP CONVERTER MODE of menu item 965 is set to     crop     adjust the H crop  horizontal crop  position for up converter output  in edge crop mode       120 to 0 to 120   4  LBOXP When sub item UP CONVERTER MODE of menu item 965 is set to    l   box     adjust the vertical location of the position where the picture is cut  out for up converter output in letter box mode       120 to 0 to 120   5  CNV PROC Select the source picture to use in converting SD to HD   FIELD  Use field pictures    ADAPT  Frame or field is selected automatically    6   DETAIL Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the sharpness of edge  enhancement    0 to 40H to 7FH   7  LIMITER Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the maximum detail level  added to emphasize the original signal   0 to 20H to 3FH   8  CRISP Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the threshold amplitude at  which low amplitude signals are not emphasized   0 to 8 to FH   9  DEPEND Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the luminance range for  edge enhancement   0 to 8 to FH   10  H DETL F Adjust the up converter image enhancer  Set the center frequency and  frequency properties for edge enhancement   3 2MHz  3 2 MHz  1 1 MHz  4 5MHz  4 5 MHz  1 4 MHz  5 0MHz  5 0 MHz  0 7 MHz  4 0MHz  4 0 MHz  2 0 MHz   11  
170. ames of its contributors may be used to endorse or  promote products derived from this software without  specific prior written permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS  IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR  CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT   INDIRECT  INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY   OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING   BUT NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE          Part 5  Sparta  Inc copyright notice  BSD           Copyright  c  2003 2006  Sparta  Inc  All rights reserved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or  without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided
171. ample  SITE CHMOD 444 Clip C0001 MXF   Lock clip C0001 MXF     SITE TCPR    Presets the starting timecode of a clip copied with the  STOR command  Specify the timecode in the format   ffssmmhh   ff  frames  ss  seconds  mm  minutes  hh   hours        This command remains in effect until a STOR command  is executed  or  if no STOR command is executed  until  the FTP connection is terminated      If a SITE UMMD command is executed after this  command  the SITE UMMD command takes priority  and this command is discarded       f this command is executed several times in sequence   the last command takes priority     Command syntax  SITE TCPR   SP    lt timecode  gt    lt CRLF gt     FTP File Operations       suonejedo aji4 9 Jeydeyp    121          suoneJedo aji4 9 1e1deu     122    Input example  SITE TCPR 00050001   The starting timecode is preset to 01 00 05 00      Recording Continuous Timecode with FAM and FTP Connections       Recording Continuous  Timecode with FAM and  FTP Connections    When you are connected to the unit by FAM or FTP  you  can create new clips with timecode that is continuous with  the timecode of the last frame of the last clip on the disc   To record continuous timecode  set TCG on page P5 TC of  the function menu to    INT     and set PRST RGN to    TC      Then proceed as follows     Continuous timecode cannot be recorded if PRST RGN on  page P5 TC of the function menu is set to  VITC      See  Extended menu operations   page 146  for more  informati
172. andwidth of 64 kbps per channel   This unit records proxy AV data    automatically whenever high   resolution MPEG HD data is  recorded     Reference video signal   A video signal that contains a sync  signal or sync and burst signals  used  as a reference for synchronization of  video equipment     SDSDI signal   SD Serial Digital Interface  An  interface standardized as SMPTE   259M which enables the  transmission of an uncompressed  digital component stream     S N   Signal to Noise ratio  The relation of  the strength of the desired signal to  the accompanying electronic  interference  the noise  If S N is high   sounds are reproduced with less noise  and pictures are reproduced clearly  without snow     Sub clip   One of the sections which make up a  clip list  A sub clip may be part of a  clip or an entire clip     Thumbnail image   A reduced still picture of video for  display on a GUI screen  XDCAM  creates thumbnail images from proxy  video  and displays them as index  pictures on GUI screens     Timecode   A digitally encoded signal which is  recorded with video data to identify  each frame of the video by hour   minute  second and frame number   SMPTE timecode is applied to NTSC  system  and EBU timecode to PAL  and SECAM systems     UMID   Unique Material Identifier  A  standard  SMPTE 330M  for video  and audio metadata  The Basic  section of a UMID contains a  globally unique number and a  material number for the identification  of recorded material  An optional
173. ard disk drive on which the work  folder to store the material transferred from this unit has  adequate free space    To transfer files between the computer and this unit  requires this unit  s IP address and other network related  settings to be made     For details of the network related settings  see  To change  network settings   page 153      Using PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software       xipueddy    175          xipueddy    176       Using UMID Data    Metadata is additional information recorded on discs along  with audio visual data  It is used to bring greater efficiency  to the flow of operations from material acquisition through  editing  and to make it easier to find and reuse material   As one of application of metadata  the UMID has been  internationally standardized     What is a UMID     A UMID  Unique Material Identifier  is a unique i   dentifier for audio visual material defined by the  SMPTE 330M 2003 standard    A UMID may be either as a 32 byte Basic UMID or an  Extended UMID  which includes an additional 32 bytes of  Source Pack to make a total 64 bytes     For details  refer to SMPTE 330M     Extended UMID  64 bytes        Basic UMID  32 bytes     Source Pack  32 bytes                          A globally unique ID is automatically recorded for every  clip     4  gt   gt   Universal label   L   Instance   Material Number   Time Date   Spatial Country  Org   User  No  Coordinates  12 bytes 1   3bytes 16 bytes 8 bytes 12 bytes 4 bytes   4 bytes   4 bytes       
174. b     3 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    on     and  press the knob     The clip title naming screen appears     RETURN  SELECT    ITEM 035    CLIP TITLE NAMING  SELECT    XTITLE  PREFIX  NUMERIC      disable    TITLE    00001    SAVE  EXIT    SETUP       4 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the asterisk      on the left of the menu items to    TITLE     and press  the knob     The asterisk indicates the selected item     5 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select    enable      and press the knob     The automatic title generation function is enabled     6 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the asterisk      on the left of the menu items to the item you want  to select  and press the knob     PREFIX  A string of up to 10 characters  The  allowable characters are alphanumeric characters   symbols  1  96  amp         2           and the space character    NUMERIC  A five digit number  00001 to 99999  to  serve as the initial value of the serial number     f Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the  character position to set  and press the knob     8 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the  character to set     9 Repeat steps 7 and 8 as required     When you are setting the    NUMERIC    item  you can  press the RESET RETURN button to return the initial  value of the serial number to 00001  factory default  setting      1 Ocarry out steps 7 to 9 to set the other item     11 Press the SAVE function  F5  button   The title is saved     To check the titles of
175. back        HDSDI  VANC  output    EIA 708  EIA 608     708   Up convert playback  conversion   EIA 608    SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output    Internal processing by this unit    Cross convert playback of HD discs containing closed caption data  and down convert playback  When you cross convert and play 1080 or 720 clips  EIA    708 compliant closed caption data recorded in the clips is   played and output with no changes  By performing down   convert playback  you can also play and output EIA 608   standard closed caption data    However  settings are required for output of EIA 708   standard closed caption data     For details  see  To record and playback EIA 708 B    standard closed caption data in HDSDI signals    page 178      Ancillary Data       xipueddy    181          xipueddy    182    Playback and down convert         HDSDI  VANC  output  1080 playback    EIA 708                  1080 clip       Down convert    playback EIA 608    SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output       720 clip HDSDI  VANC  output    720 playback  EIA 708       Cross convert  and playback       Down convert EIA 608    playback SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output       Internal processing by this unit    playback of HD discs containing EIA 608 data only    EIA 608 standard closed caption data recorded in HD clips For details  see  To record and playback EIA 708 B  is played and output without conversion  By performing standard closed caption data in
176. bout thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of a  clip with chapters set     The    S    mark appears on the thumbnails of clips with  chapters set     2 Press the CHAPTER button     The chapter thumbnail screen  see page 71  appears   with thumbnails of the frames where chapters are set     The    S1        S2     and    RS    marks on the thumbnails  indicate frames where Shot Mark1  Shot Mark2  and  Rec Start essence marks are set     To delete the shot mark at a chapter position  You can delete the shot mark  Shot Marko to 9  at the  chapter position in the chapter thumbnail screen   Rec  Start cannot be deleted      1 In the chapter thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail  for the frame whose shot mark you want to delete     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Delete Essence Mark     A message appears asking if you are sure that you want  to delete the shot mark     Delete Essence Mark    Delete 002   e   4       4 Select OK to delete the mark  or Cancel to cancel the    deletion  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To adjust the position of shot marks at chapter  positions   You can use the chapter thumbnail screen to adjust the  position of shot marks  Shot MarkO to 9  at chapter  positions   The positions of Rec Start essence marks  cannot be adjusted      1 In the chapter thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail  of the shot mark whose position you want to adjust     Thumbnail Operations    2 Display the Thumb
177. bps     and 720P   35 25 Mbps   allowing HD operation across a wide range  of recording times and application objectives  The unit is  also capable of SD  IMX 30 40 50 Mbps or DVCAM  codec  recording and playback           1   HD1500   When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed   2  MPEG HD is a registered trademark of Sony Corporation   3  Playback only supported for 18 Mbps           Support for multiple frame frequencies   This unit can record and play multiple frame frequencies at  both 1080  59 941  501  29 97P  25P  and 23 98P  and 720   59 94P and 50P   for MPEG HD422   It can also perform  pulldown playback of discs recorded at 23 98P  D              1  IHD1500   When the PDBK S1500 option is installed        Support for mixed format recording mode   As long as the frame frequency group is the same  clips in  different recording formats can be recorded or written to  the same disc      The system frequencies supported by this unit are divided  into frame frequency groups  as shown in the following  table     1  The recording format is regarded as different whenever the system  frequency  video resolution  video codec bit rate  or number of audio  channels or number of bits does not match                          Frame frequency group System frequency  59 94Hz 59 94P  59 94i  29 97P  50Hz 50P  50i  25P  23 98Hz 23 98P                You can record clips with different recording formats  for  example HD422 and HD420SP clips  by putting this unit  into mixed f
178. c  press the  EJECT button     Front Panel     1  Audio level adjustment section          CH 1 ALL CH  CH 2 to CH 4 adjustment knobs    CH 1 CH 3    O CH  CH 2 O CH4    VARIABLE          VARIABLE switch               CH 1 ALL CH  CH 2 to CH 4  audio level   adjustment knobs   Depending on the setting of the VARIABLE switch  these   adjust the input audio or playback audio levels of channels     to 4     You can adjust levels of channels 5 to 8 using the function  menu  See page 50 for details     By the setting of setup menu item 131 AUDIO VOLUME   you can enable the CH 1 ALL CH adjustment knob to  simultaneously adjust all eight channels  When this  simultaneous adjustment is enabled  the ALL CH indicator  lights        VARIABLE  audio level adjustment selector   switch   This selects whether input audio levels or playback audio   levels are adjusted by the CH 1 ALL CH and CH 2 to CH    4 adjustment knobs for channels 1 to 4  or by the function   menu setting for channels 5 to 8    REC  Adjust the input audio levels  The playback audio  levels are fixed at their preset values    PRESET  The audio levels are fixed at their preset values    PB  Adjust the playback audio levels  The input audio  levels are fixed at their preset values     Arrow buttons   The four arrow buttons are also used as the MARKI  button  MARK2 button  IN button  and OUT button  The  correspondence with these buttons is as follows      button  MARKI button     button  MARK2 button   button  IN button    
179. ce menu item  M5  NETWORK  gt M50  DHCP to  ENABLE      To check the assigned IP address  Select maintenance menu item M5  NETWORK  2M51  IP ADDRESS PRESET     If the IP address cannot be assigned  this is shown as     000 000 000 000     In this case  consult the network  administrator     To set the IP address  First set DHCP to    DISABLE     see the previous section      When the IP address is assigned automatically        1 Select maintenance menu item M5  NETWORK   gt M51  IP ADDRESS PRESET     2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The IP address appears  and the digit that can be  changed flashes     3 Set the IP address     To select a different digit to be changed  Use the   IN and   OUT buttons     To change the value of a digit   Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob    Turning clockwise increases the value  and turning  counterclockwise decreases the value    The 4 MARKI and V MARK2 buttons can be used     Maintenance Menu       snus  z Jeideuj    153          snue N 4 Jejdeuj    154    To return to the factory default setting  Press the RESET RETURN button     4 Whenall digits are set  press the SAVE function  button  F5      This returns to the NETWORK menu     5 Repeat steps 1 to 4 as required  to set the subnet mask  and default gateway     6 Inthe NETWORK menu  press the SAVE function  button  F5      T When the    NOW SAVING       message vanishes   power the unit off and then on again with the on   standby button     To set the communications speed and  protocol    
180. cess Mode  for Macintosh                 115  Making FAM connections                eeeeseeeeseeeeee eene entente tentent 115  Operating on TES x  ssivcicssdssvscacsiieccaasetedeacens a E E 115  Exiting TIle ODeEF aU OMS oestro oasia ene Cope ea Fede M assai a 116   FTP File Operalions             rcr corr rre ai sad e re daaaaaaaa 116  Making FTP connections    ii doeet irae epe IR Se ota ek ERUNT e Sn exe U RSS 116  C  mmand TSE ade doe hee niteat o E SESE 117    8 Table of Contents    Recording Continuous Timecode with FAM and FTP       COMMECTIGINS ius hactpex vn Curie rni Dr cn bed d eek ic 122  Chapter 7 Menus  Menu System Configuration                                    eee 123  currime                   123  Items Th the basic Hell  ooiii sper Paetos Re Po Goode do i tes 124  Basic menu Operations  7 2  eciiiuriacee ee dtt ee edn epar ede Pape de arae etas 128  Items in the extended menu sacs s dosisted e ON INE abb dE 131  Extended menu Operations a  ins oet eene ter todo oe Eo Pee at ehe E veut 146  Maintenance Menu                            eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeennn nennen nnn nnn 148  Items in the maintenance meri  coco eee o ee o e Re aee EN itd us 148  Maintenance menu operatlOfls         eeede easet teet eene RES koe eU ee o eaae ae Rag 152       Chapter 8 Planning Metadata        9 1  Q7 er 155  Manipulating planning metadata                          eene 155  Setting clip names by using planning metadata                                  155  Setting essence mark 
181. ch complying  with AES 3id 1995    Timecode input  TIME CODE IN  BNC type  x1   SMPTE timecode  0 5 to  18 Vp p  10 kQ  unbalanced    Output connectors    Digital video outputs  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2 SUPER   BNC type  x2   complying with SMPTE   292M  SDSDI OUTPUT 1  2 SUPER   BNC type  x2   complying with SMPTE   259M    Analog video outputs  COMPOSITE OUTPUT 1  2 SUPER     Specifications       xipueddy    173          xipueddy    174    BNC type  x2   1 0 Vp p  75 Q  sync  negative  complying with SMPTE   170M    Analog audio outputs  ANALOG AUDIO OUTPUT 1 2  XLR 3 pin  male  x2    4 dBu  600 O   low impedance  balanced  AUDIO MONITOR  XLR 3 pin  male  x2    4 dBu  600 Q   low impedance  balanced  Stereo phone jack  x1      e to    13 dBu   8 Q  unbalanced    PHONES    Digital audio outputs  DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  OUTPUT 1 2  3 4  BNC type  x2   1 2 ch  3 4 ch complying  with AES 3id 1995    Timecode output  TIME CODE OUT  BNC type  x1   SMPTE timecode   1 0 Vp p  75 Q  unbalanced    Remote control connectors    REMOTE 9P  D sub 9 pin  female  x1   complying  with RS 422A   VIDEO CONTROL   D sub 9 pin  female  x1   complying  with EIA RS 423   4 pin  female  x1    DC 12 V  7 5 W   RJ 45 type  x1    1000BASE T  complying with  TEEE802 3ab   100BASE TX  complying with  TEEE802 3u   10BASE T  complying with IEEE802 3    REMOTE       Network    Other    MAINTENANCE connectors   High Speed USB  USB 2 0  Type A     Accessories supplied  Operation manuals  English version  1   Japane
182. code of clip  lists    The timecode of clip lists is continuous timecode   unrelated to the timecode of the original clips  By default  the timecode  LTC  of the start of the clip list is  00 00 00 00  but it can be set to any value     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the  Thumbnail Menu     2 Select Set Start Time Code  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Set Start Time Code screen appears     Set Start Time Code    TC Be a nh    N EC    Preset TC 00 00 00 00    Cancel    3 Press the 4 IN or  amp  OUT button to select the digit that  you want to change     4 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  konb or the jog dial to  change the value of the digit     5 Repeat steps 3 and 4 as required     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing           SU88J0S  MD ul suonejedo g Ja deyD          SueeiJoS IND ui suoneiedo  S 1e1deuo    92    To reset the timecode to 00 00 00 00  Select Reset to Zero in the Thumbnail Menu  and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To preset the frequently used timecode   Select Save Preset TC in the Thumbnail Menu  and  then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob    The timecode set in steps 4 and 5 is saved as a preset  value     To recall the preset timecode  Select Recall Preset TC in the Thumbnail Menu  and  then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     6 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob   OK is selected     7 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob again     8 save the clip list  see page 92   
183. computer     FTP download limitations   The following limitations apply to FTP download   operations  They do not apply to HTTP download   operations      The characters that can be used in the names of clip   related data files are single byte letters  numbers  and  symbols  However  the following symbols cannot be  used          lt  gt 2        If you click    Cancel    in the download dialog  or if the  download is cancelled in some other way with the  browser still connected to the unit by FTP  click    Back  to Thumbnails  to return to the thumbnails screen  or  exit the web browser     SU9919S  MD ui suoneiado 6 1e1deu    98 Disc Operations       Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function     You can transfer clips  MXF files  between this unit and  external devices over a network  This unit has an Direct  FTP function  which allows you to connect to any  XDCAM device or computer with an FTP server function  and transfer files with a few simple operations in the GUI  screen    The following table lists the types of file transfers that this  unit can execute              Transfer direction   Transfer target Function  Upload One or more clips put  Multiple clips with clip list  Part of one clip partial put                      Transfer direction   Transfer target Function          Download One clip get             File transfers with this function are limited to clips  high   resolution data  and clip list files  To transfer files of other  types  proxy AV data  files in the
184. ction   Bl  red   Lights during still image display        Jog dial   Turn this for playback in jog mode  Turn clockwise for  forward direction playback  and counterclockwise for  reverse direction playback  In jog mode  the playback  speed varies from  1 to  1 times normal speed  according  to the rotation rate of the jog dial  There are no detents   Normally  you press the SHTL JOG or VAR JOG button  before turning the jog dial  but it is also possible to make a  setting to enable jog mode directly by turning the dial  set    Front Panel       seq Jo suonouny pue seweN zsaideyo    19          Sued Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jeideuj    20    setup menu item 101 SELECTION FOR SEARCH DIAL  ENABLE to   dial       Q Shuttle dial   Turn this for playback in shuttle mode or variable speed   mode  Turn clockwise for forward direction playback  and   counterclockwise for reverse direction playback       n shuttle mode  the playback speed varies in the range   20 times normal speed or in the maximum speed range   as selected by an extended menu setting   according to  the angular position of the shuttle dial           n variable speed mode  you can finely adjust the  playback speed from    2 to  2 times normal speed   according to the angular position of the shuttle dial    The shuttle dial has a detent at the center position  for still   image playback    Normally  you press the SHTL JOG button before turning   the shuttle dial  but it is also possible to make a setting to   enable shu
185. d     Playback in jog mode starts     3 To stop playback in jog mode  stop turning the jog dial     When setup menu item 101 SELECTION FOR  SEARCH DIAL ENABLE is set to  dial   factory  default setting   you can start jog playback by simply  rotating the jog dial  even when the SHTL JOG and  VAR JOG buttons are not lit     Playback       yoeghe q pue DBuipiooeu v Jaydeyo    65          xoeg e g pue BuipiooeH y 1e1deuo    66    Playback in shuttle mode    In shuttle mode  you can control the speed of playback by  the angular position of the shuttle dial  The range of  playback speed is  20 times normal speed or maximum  speed  as selected by an extended menu setting   H    1  Maximum speed is about  50 times normal speed  However  the  maximum speed may vary depending on the state of the clip and the  playback position on the disc    To carry out playback in shuttle mode  proceed as follows                       A  all    p  CHA ca OD        z  OOs    ww C     fond    og                                                                         PREV     TOPU F                       3 12 3  1 Press the SHTL JOG button  turning it on     2 Tum the shuttle dial to the desired angle  corresponding to the desired playback speed     Playback in shuttle mode starts     3 To stop playback in shuttle mode  return the shuttle  dial to the center position  or press the STOP button     When setup menu item 101 SELECTION FOR  SEARCH DIAL ENABLE is set to  dial   factory  default setting   you
186. d  except for the EJECT button     Monitor display in HDSDI remote control mode     RM SDI    appears in the remote interface display area   see page 26  of the monitor  This display lights if  command packets are embedded into HDSDI signals  and  flashes if they are not  However  the    RM SDI    continues  to flash until the time the controlling camcorder is powered  on and the time that the REC button is pressed on the  camcorder     Recording operation    When a recordable disc is inserted  recording  or stop  is  executed according to the REC  or STOP  command  embedded into the HDSDI signals    Recording stops automatically when the end of the disc is  reached     When HDSDI signals are interrupted during  recording   Recording stops if HDSDI signals are interrupted during  recording  for example because the HDSDI cable is  disconnected or the controlling camcorder is powered off   When HDSDI signal input is restored  the unit resumes    operation according to the embedded REC or STOP  command     Exchanging discs   Even during recording  it is possible to eject discs by  pressing the EJECT button on the front panel  After a disc  is exchanged  the unit resumes operation according to the  embedded REC or STOP command     This unit begins recording operation about one second  after the camcorder        Recording with the Clip Continuous  Rec function    Normally  a clip is generated as an independent file every  time recording starts and stops  The Clip Continuous Rec  f
187. d  using the GUI screen  See page 84 for  details                             Sub Item   F1  OK Set an OK flag    F2  NG Set an NG flag    F3  KEEP Set a KEEP flag    F4      F5  DELETE   Delete the clip flag    F6  EXIT Exit the clip flag sub   menu                    Basic Operations of the Function Menu    51       suonejedejg     Ja deup          suonejedejg e jejdeuo    52       Item  F4  PC RMT    Setting    Enables or disables a FAM connection   The connection can be cut off while it is  maintained or remade while it is  disabled    ENABLE  Enable a connection   DISABLE  Disable a connection       PC REMOTE under maintenance  menu item M33  FILE I F CONFIG  must be set to    F KEY SELECT    in  order to use this function  see  page 148        DISABLE  is always selected when  the unit is powered off and then on  again  regardless of the previous  setting        F5      Unassigned function button           F6         Unassigned function button           Handling Discs       Handling Discs       Discs used for recording and  playback    This unit can record and play back the following  Professional Disc P formats      PFD23A  capacity 23 3 GB    e PFD50DLA  capacity 50 0 GB     1  Professional Disc is a trademark of Sony Corporation        tis not possible to use the following discs for recording  or playback     Blu ray Disc    Professional Disc for Data     PFD50DLA discs can be used only by XDCAM devices  with the DL mark  see the following illustration   They  cannot
188. d a  remote computer with an i LINK cable    i LINK cable is connected  Disconnect the i LINK cable  from either this unit or the remote computer  wait for  at least 10 seconds  and then reconnect the  disconnected cable    The unit is powered off and an i LINK cable is  connected  Power the unit on     You can enable and disable FAM connection from the  function menu  For details  see page 52        File Operations in File  Access Mode  for  Macintosh     File access mode operating environment    Operating system requirements for file operations by file   access mode are as follows      Computer operating system  Mac OS X v10 4 11 or  higher    Preparations    Do the following on the remote computer and this unit      nstall the FAM driver on the remote computer  see the  next item      To install the FAM driver   Insert the supplied CD ROM  XDCAM Application  Software  into the CD ROM drive of your computer  and  execute the dmg file in FAM Driver  gt Mac  gt FAM Driver   then follow the installation instructions     For details  refer to the ReadMe file contained on the  CD ROM disc     To check the FAM driver version   Connect this unit to your computer with an i LINK cable   and then  with a disc loaded  start the system profiler utility  of the application  The version appears to the right of     prodisk_fs    when you select    Advanced Functions   under    Software           Making FAM connections    1 If there is a disc loaded in this unit  put the unit into the  fol
189. d fast reverse modes   stop  In stop mode          109    FORCED EE WHEN DISC UNLOAD    During disc loading unloading and when no disc is inserted  select  whether to control the output signal PB EE setting    on  Do not control  the signal is always an E E signal     off  Control        114          AUDIO MONITOR OUTPUT LEVEL       Select whether to control the level of the audio signal output from the  AUDIO MONITOR R  L connectors with the LEVEL knob for the  PHONES jack    var  variable   Control    fixed  Do not control           Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    131    Menu items in the 100s  relating to the control panels       Item number  118    Item name    KEY INHIBIT SWITCH EFFECTIVE  AREA       Sub item    Settings    Select which buttons can be operated when the KEY INHI switch is set to   ON   The following sub items control different sets of buttons  independently        1 FUNCTION KEY    Select whether function buttons on the front panel are enabled     dis  disable   Disabled     ena  enable   Enabled        2 CONTROL PANEL       Select operable buttons on the front panel are enabled     dis  disable   Disabled     ena  enable   Enabled        119    VARIABLE SPEED LIMIT IN KEY    Select the playback speed range when carrying out playback in variable  speed mode from the front panel of this unit     off  off   2 to  2       2 to  2 times normal speed   on  on   0 to  1    0 to  1 times normal speed        121    FRAME PB MODE    Select the variable playb
190. d in ISO 3166 1   There are about 240 country codes     Find your own country code on the following web page     Refer to ISO 3166 1   http   www iso org iso country codes   iso_3166_code_lists htm    When the country code is less than 4 bytes  the active part  of the code occupies the first part of the 4 bytes and the  remainder must be filled with the space character  20h      Example  Japan    For Japan  the country code is JP  which is 2 bytes  or JPN     which is 3 bytes   Thus  enter the following   JP__  or  JPN _  where _ represents a space     ORGANIZATION  organization code     Enter a 4 byte alphanumeric string for the organization    code     There are no problems in recording or playing back    audio video signals  even if the ORGANIZATION is not    set     string  As a rule  the code    00    must be entered     Freelance operators who do not belong to an origination    ee 99    should enter    USER  user code   Enter a 4 byte alphanumeric string to identify the user     The user code is registered with each organization locally     It is usually not centrally registered     When the user code is less than 4 bytes  enter the user code  atthe beginning of the 4 bytes and fill the remainder of the    string with the space character  20h    This user code is determined by the organization  The  methods used depend on the organization     User code cannot be entered when no organization code    has been entered     Using UMID Data    Organization codes must be acqui
191. data is non audio    3  CH5 CH6 auto  Set as follows   4  CH7ICH8   When data is read from disc and confirmed  Follow the data     When data from disc is not confirmed  Maintain current state   824 ANALOG LINE OUTPUT SELECT   Select the analog audio signals  tracks 1 to 8  to be assigned to audio  output channels 1 and 2   tr1 2  Tracks 1 and 2 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr3 4  Tracks 3 and 4 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr5 6  Tracks 5 and 6 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr7 8  Tracks 7 and 8 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   827 AES EBU AUDIO OUTPUT SELECT   Select the audio signals to assign to AES EBU audio output channels   Sub item  1  CH1 CH2 tr1 2  Tracks 1 and 2 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr3 4  Tracks 3 and 4 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr5 6  Tracks 5 and 6 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr7 8  Tracks 7 and 8 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   2  CH3 CH4 tr1 2  Tracks 1 and 2 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr3 4  Tracks 3 and 4 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr5 6  Tracks 5 and 6 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr7 8  Tracks 7 and 8 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   828 SDI AUDIO OUTPUT SELECT Select the audio signals to assign to SDI audio output channels   Sub item  1  CH1 CH2 tr1 2  Tracks 1 and 2 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr3 4  Tracks 3 and 4 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   
192. disc  F2   Unassigned function button   EXT  Synchronize to external timecode F3   Unassigned function button   input to the TIME CODE IN 7      s  nn  ctor  F4   Unassigned function button   SDI  Synchronize to timecode F5  SYNC Sets the sync phase of HD output  embedded into HDSDI signal input signals  While the setting value is  to SD HDSDI INPUT connector  flashing  turn the PUSH SET S SEL   knob to adjust the sync phase of output  u A WOES signals with respect to the input  EO Unde ae reference signal  over the range  15 us   to the timecode data in the TS signals   Tho Gispiey Snowe 120  qe E127   F6  FINE Makes fine adjustment to the sync phase    F2  PRST RGN    Selects the following for the internal  timecode generator   PRESET  Presets an initial value for the  timecode generated by the internal  timecode generator  as specified  from the control panel or remotely  from the device connected to the  REMOTE 9P  connector  This is  valid when  INT  is selected with the  F1  TCG item on this page  The  operation is the same as  TC  when  anything else is selected   Generate timecode synchronized to  timecode read by the internal  timecode reader   VITC  Generate timecode synchronized  to VITC read by the internal  timecode reader     TC           of HD output signals  While the setting  value is flashing  turn the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to adjust the sync  phase of output signals with respect to  the input reference signal  over the range   200 ns   The display shows 0 t
193. displayed list of menu items     varies depending  on the situations      DOWN  Skips forward 100 or 50 items in  the list of menu items    SAVE  Saves a new setting to memory    EXIT  Exits the current menu         Changes a setting       Changes a setting        RESET RETURN  button      Returns the current setting to the  factory default     Answers  No  to a question                 To change the settings of menu items    Proceed as follows to change the settings of menu items     1 Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the required  item     Example  Screen display when item 005 DISPLAY  INFORMATION SELECT is selected    Current setting       KEY PARAMETER  001 P ROLL TIME   55s  002 CHARA H POS   oA  003 CHARA U POS   2E   x005 DISPLAY SEL    T amp CNT  006 LOCAL ENA   st amp eJ  007 DISC TIMER      12H  009 CHARA TYPE   white  011 CHARA SIZE   x1  012 COND DISPLY   dis  013 SYSTEM FREQ   off  016 ALARM   on             2 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the SELECT  function button  F2      This displays the setting screen 2 for the menu item  selected in step 1     Example  Setting screen display when item 005  DISPLAY INFORMATION SELECT is selected       ITEM 005  DISPLAY INFORMATION  SELECT       time data  amp  CNT             Current setting    3 Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the       function  button  F3 or F4  to change the setting     Turning the PUSH SET S SEL  knob while holding  down the SHIFT button increases the increment of  adjustment     4 To change
194. dow     See page 75 for more information about GUI information   1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Settings  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     3 Select Planning Clip Name in Clip Info  Area and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     See page 24 for more information about the clip  information area     4 Select one of the following  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     Off  Do not display a title    ASCII Clip Name  Display the ASCII format title   see page 155    Clip Name  Display the UTF 8 format title  see  page 155     Disc Operations       SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo g Ja deyD    95          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedQ  s je1deu     96       Checking user defined essence  marks    You can display the names of user defined Shot Marko to  Shot Mark  essence marks in planning metadata  UTF 8  format  maximum 32 bytes      1 Display the Planning Metadata Properties screen  see  page 95  for the planning metadata loaded into this  unit     The   gt  button is enabled when the planning metadata  contains user defined essence marks  see page 156      2 Press    and then turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The User Defined Essence Marks screen appears     User Defined Essence Marks    ShotMarkO     kick off        Touch Down        turn over        timeout        Q         oQ         gg             Formatting discs    See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Format Disc  and then press the PUSH  SET S 
195. e      To record with the internal timecode  generator synchronized to external  timecode  External Regen     Use this method to synchronize the timecode generators of  a number of recorders  to record the playback timecode of  external VTRs  or to record while maintaining  synchronization between the source video and timecode     When the Live Logging function is setto Live View mode   the run mode is always Free Run  regardless of the setting  of RUN MODE on page P5 TC of the function menu  It is  not possible to preset the timecode to be recorded     Use either of the following procedures according to the  type of external timecode     Synchronizing with timecode input to the TIME  CODE IN connector    1 Connect the timecode output of an external device to  the TIME CODE IN connector  and input a reference  video signal to the REF  VIDEO INPUT connector     2 Make the following settings on page P5 TC of the  function menu       Set TCG to    EXT        Set PRST RGN to    TC        Synchronizing with embedded LTC input to the  SD HDSDI INPUT connector    1 Input an HDSDI signal containing embedded LTC to  the SD HDSDI INPUT connector  and a reference  video signal to the REF  VIDEO INPUT connector     2 Make the following settings on page P5 TC of the  function menu       Set TCG to    SDP        Set PRST RGN to    TC        Executing either of these procedures starts the internal  timecode generator running in synchronization with the  external timecode generator    Once t
196. e  normal playback  high speed playback in the forward or  reverse directions  and jog  shuttle  and variable playback   When this unit is set to repeat playback mode  the selected  clip only is played repeatedly    To move to another clip  press the PREV  NEXT  SHIFT    PREV  or SHIFT   NEXT button  or perform a  thumbnail search     Pulldown playback   When this unit   s system frequency is set to 1080 59 941   1080 29 97P  or 720 59 94P  clips recorded as 1080   23 98P are converted by 2 3 pulldown before playback   pulldown playback      Timecode in pulldown playback   During pulldown playback  timecode is also converted to  30 frames to match the output video signals    The upper row of the time data display area displays the  original 24 frame timecode  and the lower row displays the  30 frame timecode     Playback   63             xoeg e g pue BuipiooeH y 1e1deuo    64       TC UITC  00 59 59 23  PDT 00 59 59 29             You can superimpose the 30 frame timecode after  pulldown on an external monitor  To do so  set setup menu  item 005 DISPLAY INFORMATION SELECT to    time  data only         TCR 00 59 59 23  PDT 00 59 59 29             Disc playback start position    Although this unit uses optical discs  it is designed to offer  the most convenient features of tape playback by VTRs   One of these is the playback start position  which works in  the same way as tape  as described below     After playback stop   The unit stops at the position where the STOP button was
197. e as the index picture of the clip    The following example explains how to do so from the  expand thumbnail screen     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the expand thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail  to set as the index picture     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Set Index Picture     A message appears asking you to confirm that you  want to set the current frame as the index picture     Set Index Picture  Cancel                4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     After pressing the RESET RETURN button to return  to the clip thumbnail screen  check to make sure that  the newly selected frame is displayed as the index  picture           Checking clip properties  You can check clip properties such as the title  timecode   duration  date and time of creation  and date and time of    the more recent modification     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Display the Thumbnail Menu in the clip thumbnail  screen     2 Select Clip Properties     The Clip Properties screen appears     Thumbnail Operations    Clip Properties Clip No   001 035  Tel  visionLCD  Capping Literally years of spe     Title2 R  troprpjecteurs BRAVIA   AV Format 1080SP 4ch   Frame Rate PB 59 94P   Capture 23 98P  TC DUR  00 23 00 25   0 00 09 22  Created 30 NOV 2005 13 35 00 00  Modified 20 MAY 2006 15 02 00 00   Rec Device PDW 700 SN 10001     Horizontal Scroll  amp       DE UNITS  Title1       Cl
198. e clips you want to use to a clip list  You can add  up to 300 sub clips to one clip list    This operation can be carried out in the following  thumbnail screens      Clip thumbnail screen     Expand thumbnail screen     Chapter thumbnail screen     Clip list thumbnail screen    2  Change the sub clip order  Use the Move Sub Clips  command to change the order of sub clips in a clip  list    Delete sub clips  Use the Delete Sub Clips command  to delete specified sub clips from a clip list    Trim sub clips  Use the Trim Sub Clip command to  adjust the In and Out points of a sub clip  This  function can also be used to adjust the overall  duration of the clip list    Set the start timecode  Use the Set Start Time Code  command to set the timecode at the start of a clip  list     3   Play the clip list  Use the PLAY button and other  playback controls to play the current clip list and  check its contents              Save the clip list  Use the Save Clip List or Save Clip  List as    command to save the newly created clip    list to the disc           To reedit clip lists on the disc   Use the Load Clip List command to load the clip lists you  want to edit  and perform the steps 2 to 4 in the previous  section     You can also delete clip lists on the disc     For details  see  Managing clip lists   page 92      Clip lists can be created and edited even when the write  inhibit tab of the disc is set to recording disabled  and when  REC INH on the HOME page of the function menu 
199. e control switch to    NET     see page 18         Making FTP connections    FTP connections between this unit and a remote computer  can be made with either of the following      The command prompt     FTP client software    This section explains how to use the command prompt  For  more information about using FTP client software  refer to  the documentation of the FTP client software on your  system     An FTP client that supports UTF 8 is required to use  Unicode characters other than ASCII characters   Command prompt FTP commands do not support UTF 8     To log in  If this unit is connected to a remote computer with a FAM    connection  first exit file operations on the FAM  connection  see page 114      1    Load a disc into this unit and put the unit into the  following state     Recording  playback  search and other disc  operations  see page 54   Stopped   THUMBNAIL button  see page 21   Off   Disc access by Lock or Delete All Clips  Format  Disc  and so on in the Disc Menu  see page 74    Stopped   Connections between this unit and a computer by the  Live Logging function  Disconnected   Setting of setup menu item 258 LIVE LOGGING   Values other than    live view mode    off  or    live  mode      Login is not possible unless a disc is loaded and the  unit is in the state described above     If the connection times out    This unit terminates FTP connections if no command  is received within 90 seconds of the last command  If  this occurs  log out  see the next secti
200. e data display area         Remaining disc recording capacity  Rec Run Free Run              Timecode generator mode          VITC     Time data type  UITC   UITC   INT PRESET REM  020m    12 34 47 12        Time data    amp  Recording mode indication                Remaining disc recording capacity  Displays the  amount of recording capacity remaining on the disc    Rec Run Free Run  Displays the timecode run mode   The run mode is set with RUN MODE on page P5 TC  of the function menu  see page 51         Timecode generator mode  Displays the timecode  source and generation method  preset or regenerate     These are set with PRST RGN and TCG on page P5   TC of the function menu  see page 51      D  VITC  Lights in the following cases      When VITC is read in playback mode   This has no  relations to the display in the time data display  area       When VITC recording is possible       Time data type  Displays the type of time data  displayed in the time data display area  The type of  time data is selected with CNTR SEL on the HOME   page of the function menu  see page 48                              Display Type of time data   TC Timecode   COUNTER   Elapsed recording playback time  UB User bits   VITC VITC   VIUB VIUB   TCG Timecode generator value   UBG User bits generator value                Time data  Normally displays timecode or VITC   according to the selection made with TCR on page P5  TC of the function menu       Recording mode indication  This appears when setu
201. e is regenerated    UB  Only the user bits are regenerated           607       U BIT BINARY GROUP FLAG       Select the user bits to be used in the timecode generated by the   timecode generator    000  000 not specified   Character set not specified    001  001 iso character   8 bit characters compliant with ISO 646 and  ISO 2022    010  010 unassigned 1   Undefined    011  011 unassigned 2   Undefined    100  100 unassigned 3   Undefined    101  101 page   line   SMPTE 262M page line multiplex system    110  110 unassigned 4   Undefined    111  111 unassigned 5   Undefined           Setup Menu       Menu items in the 600s  relating to the timecode  metadata  and UMID       Item number  610    Select whether or not the time code is automatically regenerated     Item name    REGEN CONTROL MODE P    Settings    auto assem  amp  insert edit  In automatic editing carried out in either  assemble mode or insert mode with this unit as the recorder   regardless of the settings of F1  TCG  and F2  PRST RGN  in  function menu page 5  the time code generator regenerates  according to the time code on the disc    auto assemble edit  In automatic editing carried out in assemble mode  with this unit as the recorder  regardless of the settings of F1  TCG   and F2  PRST RGN  in function menu page 5  the time code  generator regenerates according to the time code on the disc    manual  Regardless of whether this unit is the recorder or player  the  time code generator operates in accordance 
202. e mode   VAR  Speed  Variable speed mode   TOP 0001 xxxx Cuing up to the first frame of the  first clip    END xxxx xxxx Cuing up to the last frame of the  last clip    PREROLL Cuing up during thumbnail search                                                                         a p                            Display Operation mode  Block A  Block B   DISC OUT Disc is not loaded   LOADING Disc is being loaded   UNLOADING Disc is being unloaded   STANDBY OFF Standby off mode          Superimposed Text Information          a  Display when the unit is in Clip Continuous Rec mode     Q Playback condition mark Disc exchange cache    mark    One of three channel condition marks is displayed when  the ACCESS indicator is lit during any mode except  recording  The indication    C    appears here when the disc  exchange cache function is operating                 Display   Name Description    Green There is no problem with the  condition playback condition  This unit and  the disc can be used just as they  are  This corresponds to the     green    channel condition  indicator of a VTR     Yellow The playback condition has  condition deteriorated to some degree     There are no read errors  but you  should take the action described  in the next section  This  corresponds to the    yellow     channel condition indicator of a  VTR                          Display   Name Description    Red condition   The playback condition has  deteriorated  There are no read  errors     but you should
203. e unit is connecting to the  remote host over the specified  port        FTP Login The unit is logging in to the  remote host with specified user    name and password        Change Directory   When a path was specified  the  unit is changing to the specified  directory                 The status indicated beside each item lights in yellow  during processing for that item  and lights in green  when the processing finishes     If an error occurs   The status indicator changes to red    Correct the condition that caused the error and repeat  the operation     If you cannot connect   Check the following points      Make sure that this unit and the remote host are  correctly connected to the network       f the remote host is an XDCAM device  make sure  that it is not displaying a GUI screen       f the remote host is an XDCAM device  make sure  that a disc is inserted     When the connection is complete  the indicators of all    items have turned green   the Upload Clips via Direct  FTP screen appears     Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function        To check the connection on the remote host side  Ifthe remote hostis an XDCAM device  check that the     NETWORK     has appeared in the display or other  status display location     Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Upload to      PDW HD1500 SN3009  Current Clip Clip 0 2  Original  C0001  Copy  0003  EN 30     Remain Time 16m 39s    Total Clips    16   Disc      esu Immediatel After this clip    The progress bars show the progress of 
204. ected a Korean USB keyboard      Simplified Chinese  The keyboard layout is identical  to that of the English  United States  keyboard  Only  ASCII characters can be entered      Traditional Chinese  The keyboard layout is  identical to that of the English  United States   keyboard  Only ASCII characters can be entered    To change the keyboard language  Select the desired  language from the following values using Settings   gt Select USB Keyboard Language in the Disc Menu      English  United Kingdom      English  United States      French  France      German  Germany    e Italian  Italy      Polish  Programmers   Poland      Russian  Russia      Spanish  Spain     See  List of Supported USB Keyboards   page 185  for  the characters that can be input in each language     The keyboard language cannot be changed in the following   cases    e When the area of use is set to    J     for Japan       When the area of use is set to  UC   for regions outside  Japan   and the Disc Menu item Settings  gt Select Font is    Thumbnail Operations       SU9BINS  MD ui suonejedo G Ja deyD    83          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedo  s JaydeyD    84    set to  Korean    Simplified Chinese   or  Traditional  Chinese      The keyboard icon on the software keyboard is highlighted  when a USB keyboard has been recognized and enabled  for use with this unit  and the mouse icon is highlighted  and a mouse pointer appears when a USB mouse has been  enabled     Set Title of Clip 001 041  rex  qwe  CapsL
205. ected essence mark is set     To switch directly to the Rec Start essence mark  thumbnail screen   Before starting  set setup menu item 153 FIND MODE to     clip  amp  rec start mark     By pressing the DISPLAY button with the clip thumbnail  screen displayed  you can switch directly to the Rec Start  essence mark thumbnail screen  As long as the setting of  setup menu item 153 does not change  the DISPLAY  button switches between the clip thumbnail screen and the  Rec Start essence mark thumbnail screen    This setting allows you to use the DISPLAY button as a  shortcut to Rec Start essence mark thumbnail screen   which is convenient for checking start points in clip  recorded with the Clip Continuous Rec function    Also  when the Rec Start essence mark thumbnail screen is  displayed  each press of the THUMBNAIL button  switches between that screen and the clip playback screen   Resume function   In the clip playback screen  the PREV  and NEXT buttons jump to the previous or next recording  start points     The DISPLAY button does not switch to the Rec Start  essence mark thumbnail screen from the expand thumbnail  screen or the chapter thumbnail screen           Playing the scene you have found    After finding a clip with one of the methods explained in  the previous section     Searching with thumbnails     see  page 77   you can cue up and play the clip that you have  found     To search for a thumbnail position and cue  it up    See page 75 for more information about G
206. elect USB Keyboard Language in the Disc Menu  see  the font setting is  European Alphabet pase Bah    On this unit  you can enter any of the characters and    symbols supported by the keyboards listed below  1  When the font setting is    Simplified Chinese    or    Traditional Chinese     a  keyboard with the same layout as the English  United States  keyboard is  selected automatically     English  United Kingdom                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          
207. elected essence mark to the next  essence mark  The selection range is divided into 12  equal blocks  and the first frames of those blocks are  displayed as thumbnails  By checking the thumbnails   you can easily find the scene you want     Filter Clips function   You can select clips of a certain type from among all of the   clips on a disc  For example  you can do the following    e Select clips in a certain video format from a disc that  contains clips in different video formats      Select only clips with NG  bad  clip flags  and delete all  of those clips in one operation       Select only clips that were recorded according to  planning metadata  and use the Direct FTP function to  transfer those clips to an external device     Usability features    AC  DC  and battery power support  The unit can be used even where AC power is not  available  for example outdoors or in cars or helicopters     1  BKP L551 Battery Adaptor is required     Color LCD display   The unit is equipped with a 16 9  4 3 inch color LCD  which allows you to check the contents of the disc and use  the menu system without connecting an external monitor     Built in speakers   The unit features built in speakers  allowing you to check  recorded audio  You can check your clips and editing  results on the color LCD and speakers even when no  monitors or separate speakers are available     Tiltable front panel   The front panel is tiltable for easy rack mount and desktop  operation  You can adjust the pane
208. em quickly     See page 75 for more information about operations in  thumbnail screens       Inthe screens like clip thumbnail screen or expand  thumbnail screen  display the Thumbnail Menu     2 Select Skip Scroll  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A small popup window appears on the scrollbar to  indicate the position of the currently selected  thumbnail within the set of all thumbnails     Expand 007 235    DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00  dn 01 TEES 01 Imus      NI NI NE     DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01   007235 g      ANE NE K      DUR 0 00 00 01   DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01  cup  Seashore  DUR 0 00 00 01          Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The current position moves by an amount equal to    10  of the total number of thumbnails     When you reach a point that is close to the thumbnail  you want  turn the jog dial to move the selection frame  in units of 1 thumbnail     4 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob at the new position     The thumbnail at the position indicated in the small  popup window appears in a thumbnail screen like the  following         Expand 007 235         AM AME NR NI   Wi E d d    DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01      An NE NE Ei    DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01    KE NE NE K    DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01 DUR 0 00 00 01  cup  Seashore  pur 0 00 00 01    1 Expand thumbnail screen    To select multiple thumbnails    Move the selection frame to the first thumbnail that 
209. en appears     RETURN    SYSTEM FREQUENCY  SELECT     1080 59 94i    If the System Frequency  setting is changed   Turn Power off and on  again        2 Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the system  frequency to be used     SYSTEM FREQUENCY  SELECT    1080 501    Push F5 SAVE  Kes         3 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or the SAVE  function button  F5      The message    Turn off on POWER      appears     4 After pressing the on standby button to power off the  unit  power it on again        Setting Timecode    There are the following four ways of recording timecode    Internal Preset mode  This records the output of the  internal timecode generator  set beforehand to an  initial value  The following run modes can be  selected      Free Run  Timecode advances continually     Rec Run  Timecode advances only during  recording    Internal Regen mode  This records the output of the  internal timecode generator  initialized to timecode  following continuously upon the timecode of the last  frame of the last clip on the disc    External Regen mode  This records the output of the  internal timecode generator  synchronized to an  external timecode generator  As the external input  the  timecode input to any of the following connectors can  be selected      TIME CODE IN connector  LTC    SD HDSDI INPUT connector  VITC and LTC    B  i LINK  S400 connector  TC   External Preset mode  This directly records the input of  an external timecode generator  As the external input   the 
210. ength  in the shaded field in    Example  volume label specification      The volume label is not set in UserDiscID if it is 128 bytes  or longer     Example volume label specification       xml  version   1 0   encoding   UTF 8  7       PlanningMetadata xmlns  http   xmlns sony net pro   metadata planningmetadata   assignId  H00123     creationDate  2010 01 27T08 00 00Z    lastUpdate    2010 01 27T15 00 00Z    version  1 00  gt 4   lt Properties propertyId  assignment    class    original   update  2010 01 27T15 00 00Z  sp  modifiedByz Chris   e3    Title usAscii  Tennis Tournament    xml lang  en  gt Tennis Tournament 27 01   2010   Title   e    Meta name  MediaName  content    Australian Open 2010   2     Properties   4     PlanningMetadata      In the above example  indicates a newline   The specified volume name can be checked as the User  Disc ID in the Disc Properties screen  see page 94      If you create your own file  take care to enter it as a single  statement  with newlines only at the newline positions and  no spaces except at the indicated positions and in the  volume label      gt  sp indicates a space  and e    Overview       epen Buiuue d  g 1e deuo    157          xipueddy    158    Appendix       Important Notes on  Operation    Use and storage    Do not subject the unit to severe shocks  The internal mechanism may be damaged or the body  warped     Do not cover the unit while operating  Doing so will cause temperatures to rise inside the unit   possibly r
211. enu OFF    Settings on this unit    Remote control switch  REMOTE  see  page 18        Setup menu item 214 REMOTE  INTERFACE  9PIN          Connections and Settings       Editing Control Unit Settings  When connecting an editing control unit  BVE 700 700A   2000  to use with this unit  set VTR constants as follows                                                                                                                                                                    F1600  System VTR CONSTANT  ieduenev s cz s AT sce v RUSSIA sc 16  59 94i  AO 97 00 96 072   079  03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 5A FF 5A  59 94P   29 97P  50i 50P 25P  A1 97 00 7D 072   079  03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 4C FF 4B  23 98P A2 97 00 78 072   079  03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 48 FF 48  a  This is 15 when maintenance menu item M393  AUDIO DSP is set to       AGC limiter             9  HD1500    o  System VTR CONSTANT o  iequency Eiig 2 b  4  s je    b  e o  t le  13  14 le  16 3  59 94i  AO 96 00 96 15 15 03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 5A FF 5A 3  59 94P  S  29 97P o  50i 50P 25P  A1 96 00 7D 15 15 03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 4C FF 4B  23 08Pp 2  A2 96 00 78 15 15 03 80 0A 07 FE 00 80 48 FF 48  a  When the PDBK F1500 option is installed   Using RM 280  The following figure shows a cut editing system  comprising a PDW HD1500 as a player  a PDW F1600  unit as a recorder  and an RM 280 as an editing controller   Connections and Settings 39          suonejedejg e Jajdeyo    40    HD video monitor                               To HDSDI input
212. eral  device wiring that might have excessive voltage to this  port  Follow the instructions for this port     ATTENTION    Par mesure de s  curit    ne raccordez pas le connecteur  pour le c  blage de p  riph  riques pouvant avoir une tension  excessive    ce port  Suivez les instructions pour ce port     Aus Sicherheitsgr  nden nicht mit einem Peripherieger  t   Anschluss verbinden  der zu starke Spannung f  r diese  Buchse haben k  nnte  Folgen Sie den Anweisungen f  r  diese Buchse       MAINTENANCE connectors   These are the USB connectors for maintenance    Connect a Windows USB keyboard or mouse  see   page 83   or a USB flash drive to access planning metadata  stored on the drive  see page 94       D SDSDI OUTPUT 1 2  SUPER   SDI signal outputs  1  2  superimpose   connectors  BNC type   These output SDSDI format video audio signals   When the unit is shipped from the factory  audio signal  output is eight channels with no switching  and RP188  timecode output is set to on  You can change these settings  with setup menu item 828 SDI AUDIO OUTPUT  SELECT and setup menu item 920 SD SDI H ANC  CONTROL   The output from the 2  SUPER  connector can have  timecode  menu settings  alarm messages  and other text  information superimposed  To turn superimposition off   set CHAR SEL on the HOME page of the function menu  to    OFF        See  Items in the extended menu   page 131  for more  information     See  Basic Operations of the Function Menu   page 48   for more informat
213. esulting in failure     After use   Turn off the on standby button    If you plan not to use the unit for a long time  turn off the  POWER switch on the rear panel as well     Shipping     Remove the disc before transporting the unit       f sending the unit by truck  ship  air or other  transportation service  pack it in the shipping carton of  the unit     Care of the unit   If the body of the unit is dirty  clean it with a soft  dry cloth   In extreme cases  use a cloth steeped in a little neutral  detergent  then wipe dry  Do not use organic solvents such  as alcohol or thinners  as these may cause discoloration or  other damage to the finish of the unit     In the event of operating problems  If you should experience problems with the unit  contact a  Sony service representative     Use and storage locations    Store in a level  ventilated place  Avoid using or storing the  unit in the following places      n excessive heat or cold  operating temperature range   5  C to 40  C  41  F to 104  F    Remember that in summer or in warm climates the    Important Notes on Operation    temperature inside a car with the windows closed can  easily exceed 50  C  122  F     In damp or dusty locations   Locations where the unit may be exposed to rain  Locations subject to violent vibration   Near strong magnetic fields   Close to radio or TV transmitters producing strong  electromagnetic fields      In direct sunlight or close to heaters for extended periods    To prevent electromagne
214. et to    ON      REC INHIBIT MODE IS SELECTED  Set REC INH to  OFF   see page 48    CHECK FUNCTION MENU   PLEASE EJECT DISC   REC INHIBIT  This appears if you press the REC button when a disc  error has occurred  Correct the disc error and try  again   No Clip  b  NO CLIP  This appears when a playback  search or delete  operation is attempted on a disc with no clips  recorded on it   Insert a disc with clips recorded on it   Disc Top  9 DISC TOP  This appears if you press the PREV button or conduct  a high speed reverse search when the unit is stopped  at the start of the disc   Use forward search or playback instead   Disc End  9 DISC END  This appears if you press the NEXT button or conduct  a forward high speed search when the unit is stopped  at the end of the disc   Use reverse search or playback instead   Clip Top  CLIP TOP  This appears in single clip playback mode if you  execute a reverse search when the unit is stopped at  the first frame of a clip  To move to another clip  press  the PREV  NEXT  SHIFT   PREV  or SHIFT   NEXT  button  or perform a thumbnail search   Clip End  CLIP END  This appears in single clip playback mode if you  execute a forward search when the unit is stopped at  the last frame of a clip  To move to another clip  press  the PREV  NEXT  SHIFT   PREV  or SHIFT   NEXT  button  or perform a thumbnail search   MAX   Clips DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED TO  Delete unneeded clips  or insert a disc with enough  FOR MORE RECORDING  DELETE free space   SOME 
215. ete All Filtered  Clips  gt Delete All Filtered  Clips    Delete all of the filtered clips        Filter Clips Narrowing  Narrow down the filtering    results        Copy to Clip List Copy all of the filtered clips to a    new clip list        Upload Clips via Direct  FTP    Transfer all of the filtered clips  to an external device via a  network                 To display clip filtering conditions as Title2 titles  For clip lists created with the Copy to Clip List command     you can display the clip filtering conditions as Title2 titles     When Settings  gt Display Title in the Disc Menu is set to   On  Title2  title2    the clip filtering conditions are  displayed automatically in screens such as the Load Clip  List screen        Selecting the information displayed  on thumbnails    You can select the information to be displayed at the  bottom of the thumbnails in thumbnail screens     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Display the Thumbnail Menu in the clip thumbnail  screen     2 Select Clip Information     A window appears in which you can select the  information to display     Thumbnail Menu    Is Clip Information   gt  Return to Upper Menu  Date    Duration  Sequence Number    3 Select the items that you want to display     Date  Date and time of creation  or date and time of the  more recent modification   Time Code  Timecode of first frame   Duration  Playback time       Sequence Number  Thumbnail sequence number  Return to Up
216. eur tant qu il est raccord      la prise murale  m  me si  l appareil lui m  me a   t   mis hors tension        CAUTION  For U S A        CAUTION  ATTENTION M  VORSICHT  ADVARSEL  ADVARSEL  VARNING  VARO    For EUROPE       d prenasa  EE HERR    zara                Cette   tiquette est plac  e sur le panneau sup  rieur de l unit    de commande     AVERTISSEMENT   Une pression acoustique excessive en provenance des    couteurs ou du casque peut provoquer une baisse de l acuit    auditive    Pour utiliser ce produit en toute s  curit      vitez l   coute  prolong  e    des pressions sonores excessives     Pour les clients au Canada  Cet appareil num  rique de la classe A est conforme    la  norme NMB 003 du Canada     Pour les clients en Europe   Ce produit portant la marque CE est conforme    la Directive  sur la compatibilit     lectromagn  tique  EMC    mise par la  Commission de la Communaut   europ  enne    La conformit      cette directive implique la conformit   aux  normes europ  ennes suivantes     e EN55103 1   Interf  rences   lectromagn  tiques    mission     EN55103 2   Sensibilit     lectromagn  tique  immunit      Ce produit est pr  vu pour   tre utilis   dans les environnements    lectromagn  tiques suivants   E1  r  sidentiel   E2   commercial et industrie l  g  re   E3  urbain ext  rieur  et E4   environnement EMC contr  l    ex  studio de t  l  vision      AVERTISSEMENT   1  Utilisez un cordon d alimentation  cable secteur    3 fils    fiche femelle fiche m  
217. every  time recording starts and stops  The Clip Continuous Rec  function allows you to continue recording to the same clip  until the function is stopped or turned off  regardless of  how many times recording starts and stops  This is  convenient if you want to avoid generating a large number  of short clips  or if you want to record without worrying  about the limit on the number of clips  maximum 300      This function is available only when you are operating  equipment connected to the REMOTE 9P  or SD HDSDI  INPUT connector  It is not available on the front panel     Recording of proxy AV data   Proxy AV data is a low resolution  1 5 Mbps video  64  kbps per audio channel   MPEG 4 based version of a full  resolution data stream  Whenever this unit records full  resolution MPEG HD422 data  it simultaneously generates  and records low resolution proxy AV data  Because of its    small size  proxy AV data can be transferred quickly over  computer networks  easily edited in the field with laptop  computers D  and readily used in a wide variety of  applications  such as content management on small scale  servers     1  The supplied PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software can be used to create  simple EDLs  Edit Decision Lists      High speed searches with the jog and shuttle  dials   The jog and shuttle dials can be used to find scenes inside  clips  in the same way as the jog and shuttle dials on  conventional VTRs    In jog and variable modes  you can search in field units at  from   
218. expanded thumbnails at  equal intervals        See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of  the clip that contains the scene you want to find     2 Press the EXPAND button     The selected clip is divided into 12 blocks  and a list  appears in the expand thumbnail screen  see page 71   with the first frame of each block displayed as a  thumbnail     3 Select the thumbnail that you want to expand further     4 Repeat steps 2 and 3 up to 2 times  as required     Thumbnails cannot be further expanded when they already  have the minimum duration  1 frame      To return to the previous expansion level  Press the EXPAND button with the SHIFT button held  down     To display the expand thumbnail screen of the  previous or next clip   With the expand thumbnail screen still active  press the  PREV button or the NEXT button     Using the chapter function to find scenes    Chapters are the sections between the shot marks  Rec  Start marks  and other essence marks    Rec Start essence marks are set automatically at the start of  recording  but shot marks can be set at any scene during  recording or playback    The chapter function allows you to display thumbnails of  the chapters in a clip     Thumbnail Operations       SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo G Ja deyD    77          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedQ  s Je1deu     78    See  To set shot marks   page 55  for more information     See page 75 for more information a
219. facturer      Use only with the cart  stand  tripod  bracket  or table   specified by the manufacturer  or sold with the apparatus    When a cart is used  use caution when moving the cart    apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip over       Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when  unused for long periods of time      Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel  Servicing  is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any  way  such as power supply cord or plug is damaged  liquid  has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus   the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture  does  not operate normally  or has been dropped     To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock   do not expose this apparatus to rain or  moisture    To avoid electrical shock  do not open the  cabinet  Refer servicing to qualified  personnel only     THIS APPARATUS MUST BE EARTHED     CAUTION   The apparatus shall not be exposed to dripping or splashing   No objects filled with liquids  such as vases  shall be placed on  the apparatus     The unit is not disconnected from the AC power source   mains  as long as it is connected to the wall outlet  even if the  unit itself has been turned off     This apparatus is provided with a main switch on the rear  panel    Install this apparatus so that user can access the main switch  easily     RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  DO NOT OPEN       CAUTION  TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK     DO NOT REMOVE COVER  OR BACK
220. ft      Y X C V B N M H Shift 4 1 2 3       1  HI     Ende   _  _   Bild  Strg Alt Alt Gr Strg 0 i       gt   nts Entf                                                                         List of Supported USB Keyboards       xipueddy    185       Italian  Italy                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   
221. ftware CD ROM to  carry out simple editing with proxy AV data     For an overview of PDZ 1 and how to install the software   see  Using PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software  on   page 175  For information about how to use the software   refer to the Help provided in the software     Using the    network  connector  FTP  connection     The following shows an example of an FTP  File Transfer  Protocol  connection     To use PDZ 1 requires the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500  IP address and other network related settings to be made  beforehand     For details of the network related settings  see  To change  network settings   page 153      Connecting this unit directly to a laptop computer       Settings on this unit  Remote control switch  NET  see page 18           Setup menu item 257 NETWORK ENABLE  net          Connecting three PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500  units to a laptop computer via a LAN       PDW F1600 or  PDW HD1500                          Laptop computer                                                                   Network cable   not supplied                                                        To    network   connector                   PDW F1600 or PDW   HD1500  this unit             n Laptop computer   LI    oos  gu  6 O08  Da   O  TE    o OoS3CJCJICS                                                                                   To    network  connector                      Network cable  not supplied     Connections and Settings       Settings on all PDW HD1500  Remote c
222. function  Disconnected   Setting of setup menu item 258 LIVE LOGGING   Values other than    live view mode    off  or    live  mode      Display the XDCAM web pages in the browser of your  computer  see the previous section      To display disc properties   Click    Disc Properties    in the Disc menu    The disc properties of this unit appear in the Disc  Properties page     See    Checking disc properties     page 94  for more  information about the various properties        XDCAM HD    Status Disc Properties  Device Information       Hours Meter XDCAM HD Demo Disc          Software Version TITLEOO1          Demonstration use only          0 00 33 18          Disc Properties    43 min  Thumbnails 217 times                Maintenance  Network    Account  Setup Menu  Software Update       2008 Sony Corporation    License Registration          To display clip thumbnails   Click    Thumbnails    in the Disc menu    A page of thumbnails of clips on the disc appears   Each thumbnail page displays up to 12 thumbnails   Like the thumbnails in the unit   s GUI screens  see  page 70   the thumbnails display several information  items  including index picture changed marks  S  marks  clip flag icons  and lock icons     XDCAM HD    Status Thumbnails    Device Information  001 016  298016    Hours Meter    Software Version    Disc Properties       Thumbnails       Maintenance  Network    Account i    Setup Menu 008 016 009 016    Software Update    License Registration    EIE     lt  lt
223. g end point    Clips have numbers beginning with C  for example C0001        Recording  start point of Recording end  clip 2 point of clip 2       Clip 1 Clip 2 Clip 3 Clip 4   C0001   C0002   C0003   C0004              You can also assign titles to your clips and use the titles to  manage them  instead of the clip numbers  For more  information     Assigning user defined clip titles       page 110      Clip lists    You can use the scene selection function to select clips  from the clips saved on a disc and create a cut edit list  called a    clip list     Clip lists have numbers beginning with E  for example  E0001  Up to 99 clip lists can be saved on a disc     Sub clips  clips in clip lists    Clips  or parts of clips  that have been added to a clip list  are called  sub clips   Sub clips are virtual editing data that  specify ranges in the original clips  You can use them  without modifying the original data    The following figure illustrates the relation between clips  and sub clips        Clips on disc    Clip 1   C0001     i Clip3 i     C0003           Clip 2  C0002   Clip list  E0001  l  Sub clip 1    Sub clip 2   Sub clip 3             In the above example  the whole of clip 2 has been added  as sub clip 1  and the whole of clip 4 has been added as sub  clip 2    Sub clip 3 is part of clip 3  Therefore  when clip list E0001  is played back  clip 4 is played after clip 2  and then the  part of clip 3 shown in gray color is played     Clip list editing  current clip 
224. ge P1 VIDEO of the function menu is set to    MENU       b  Whether to set the down converter or up converter is determined using  setup menu item 212 VIDEO REMOTE CONTROL SELECT  If both  converters are selected     u  amp  d  of menu item 212   the relevant menu item  allows both converters to be set  but only the value for the down converter  is used as the return value from this unit and the unity value     Meaning of abbreviations within parentheses in   the table   HD  HDSDI output during playback of HD format video   DC  Down conversion output to SD  D1 SDI   COMPOSITE  during playback of HD format video   SD  SD  D1 SDI COMPOSITE  output during playback  of SD format video   UC  Up conversion output to HDSDI during playback of  SD format video          _  SDFine 720  SYSTEM PHASE SC  DC SD               CROSS COLOR   934  CROSS COLOR  DC    gt   H CROP 932  H CROP POSITION  DC       FOSITION 951  H CROP POSITION  UC  P   amp    DETAILGAIN  935  DETAIL GAIN  DC    954  DETAIL GAIN  UC  9  LIMITTER 936  LIMITER  DC  955  LIMITER  UC  P  CRISP 937  CRISP  DC    956  CRISP THRESHOLD  UC  P  DEPEND 938  LEVEL DEPEND THRESHOLD  ies LEVER DEPEND THRESHOLD   UC  9  FREQUENCY   939 H DETAIL FREQUENCY  DC    958  H DETAIL FREQUENCY  UC  P  1 84 Correspondence between Setting Items of the HKDV 900 and Setup Menu of This Unit       List of Supported USB Keyboards    When the area of use is set to  UC  and Select the corresponding language by selecting Settings    fe 66   1   gt S
225. gnals  Lines can be specified individually  Y C signals and odd   even fields are blanked simultaneously    Blanking in recorded signals is carried out according to these settings        1 ALL LINE           Specify the blanking for each line separately    bink  blank   Regardless of the settings of other sub items  blank all lines  which can be specified in this menu item    thru  throu   Regardless of the settings of other sub items  switch  blanking off for all lines which can be specified in this menu item           LINE 12   In 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P mode    LINE 20    Specify blanking for lines 12 to 20   bink  blank   Switch blanking on   thru  throu   Switch blanking off        LINE 9   In 50i 50P 25P  mode    LINE 22          Specify blanking for lines 9  322 to 22  and 335   bink  blank   Switch blanking on   thru  throu   Switch blanking off        726    snus  4 Ja deup    H BLANKING WIDTH    Select the horizontal blanking width of the output analog video signal   narow  narrow   Digital blanking  narrow    wide  Analog blanking  wide    When  wide  is selected  the horizontal blanking width complies with  SMPTE170M  and normally the blanking is widened and the image  becomes narrower  It is recommended to select  narow  at the editing  stage  then later  for broadcast transmission to select    wide     to output a  signal conforming to the standard  Note  however  that    narow    has to be  always selected for SDI signals        728          OUTPUT SCH PHASE    
226. h   OUT Out point time data F REV Fast reverse search   DUR Duration between In point and Out point PLAY Playback mode  servo unlocked    PLAY LOCK Playback mode  servo locked     Note   REC Record mode  servo unlocked   If the time data or user bits data cannot be read correctly  C REC Record mode  servo unlocked  9  they will be displayed with an asterisk  For example  REC LOCK Record mode  servo locked   M XL C REC   LOCK Record mode  servo locked  9     Timecode reader drop frame mark  for 59 94i  JOG STILL A still picture in jog mode  59 94P 29 97P mode only  JOG FWD Jog mode in forward direction      Indicates drop frame mode  JOG REV Jog mode in reverse direction    66 99      Indicates non drop frame mode      Timecode generator drop frame mark  for 59 94i   59 94P 29 97P mode only       Indicates drop frame mode  factory default setting      Indicates non drop frame mode        eo 0     66 99       VITC field mark           blank   Fields 1 and 3  for 59 941 59 94P 29 97P   23 98P mode  or fields 1  3  5 and 7  for 501 50P 25P  mode         Fields 2 and 4  for 59 941 59 94P 29 97P 23 98P  mode  or fields 2  4  6 and 8  for 501 50P 25P mode        Operation mode  The field is divided into two blocks as shown below     Block A displays the operation mode       Block B displays the servo lock status or playback speed        SHUTTLE   STILL    A still picture in shuttle mode       SHUTTLE    Speed     Shuttle mode                      VAR STILL A still picture in variabl
227. haracters  a to z  A to Z    The following symbols              96   amp                     comma          period         colon      semicolon    lt   2   gt      GL L     GL h      Space  edit  edit preset   Edit preset state 9  ed amp tc  edit preset  amp  tc mode   Edit preset state and settings of timecode 9     When menu item 005 is set to  off   sub status information is not displayed  when this item is set to anything other than  off         024    MENU CHARACTER TYPE    Determine the type of characters in menu text output from the COMPOSITE  OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector   or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector for superimposed display on  the monitor    white  White letters on a black background    black  Black letters on a white background    W out  White letters with black outline    B out  Black letters with white outline     Set this item by selecting the required type while viewing the monitor           028       HD CHARACTER       Specify whether to superimpose text information on the video signal output  from the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector    off  Do not superimpose    f key  Follow the function menu setting        Setup Menu          Item number  029    Item name  STORED OWNERSHIP    Settings    Specify whether to enable changing UMID ownership information settings   COUNTRY  ORGANIZATION and USER     off  Do not enable    on  Enable     See  Using UMID Data   page 176  for more information about UMID        031    R
228. he disc is write protected  eject the    disc  set the Write Inhibit tab to enable recording   and then insert the disc again  If REC INH on  HOME page of the function menu is set to    ON     set  it to    OFF     see page 48       This operation cannot be cancelled once it begins     Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Processing begins and the message    Executing      appears    When processing finishes  a message appears to  display the results    If the message reads    Incomplete      the clips that  failed were lost     Recording       xXoeg e g pue Buipiooeu v 1e deu    59       Linear Editing       Overview    You can perform the following types of editing on  recorded clips        Type of editing   Editing target    Insert editing Video tracks in a single clip        Audio tracks in a single clip   Split editing  is also possible  But the Out point must  be shared with the video tracks         Timecode in a single clip  9                Assemble editing   Final clip           a   HD1500  This function only can be performed when the PDBZ UPG02                   yoeghe q pue BuipiooeH v 1e1deuo    60       Software Upgrade Key is installed       A disc which contains clip lists cannot be used as a disc  for editing  However  it can be used as a playback disc      A disc which contains clips in different recording   formats cannot be used as a disc for editing  However  it   can be used as a playback disc if you create a clip list that   contains only clips in one of t
229. he internal timecode generator is synchronized with  the external timecode generator  the internal timecode  generator continues to run even if the external timecode  generator connection is removed    The timecode advance mode is set automatically to Free  Run  The frame count mode  for system frequency 59 941   59 94P 29 97P only  is set to the same mode as the external  timecode signal  drop frame or non drop frame      To check the synchronization to the external  signal   Press the STOP button to stop this unit  then press the REC  button    Check that the timecode value shown in the time data  display coincides with the external timecode value     To record external timecode directly   External Preset     When you use this method  the internal timecode generator  advances without being affected by the external timecode     To directly record timecode input to the TIME  CODE IN connector   Input the timecode output of an external device to the  TIME CODE IN connector  and make the following  settings on page P5 TC of the function menu      Set TCG to  EXT       Set PRST RGN to    PRESET           Superimposed Text  Information    The video signal output from the COMPOSITE OUTPUT  2  SUPER  connector  SDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER   connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  contains superimposed text information  including  timecode  menu settings  and alarm messages     Adjusting the text display    You can adjust the position  size and type of the  superimposed text u
230. he monitor video section  and on the screen of the external video monitor connected  to the unit     When the unit is powered on          REMOTE     Example alarm in time data display area          ALARM  REMOTE MODE IS SELECTED     SET REMOTE LOCAL NETWORK  SWITCH TO LOCAL               Example alarm in monitor video section    When an alarm is displayed  remove the alarm cause by  following the action to take  If the alarm display does not  disappear  contact a Sony service representative    Please note that there are some alarms which do not appear  depending on the setting of setup menu item 016 ALARM  DISPLAY  see page 126      See page 128 for more information about setup menu  operations                    Alarm message in time   Alarm message in video monitor screen Description action  data display area  ADJ  Mode  THE UNIT IS IN ADJUSTMENT MODE  This appears when the unit is in adjustment  CHECK THE SWITCHES OF 82701 ON THE   mode   HPR 23 BOARD AND S1 ON THE VPR 99 Contact a Sony service representative   BOARD    MENU Ver UP THE SETUP MENU SOFTWARE HAS BEEN Reset the settings in the setup menu  see  UPGRADED  page 130    SET THE SETUP MENU ITEMS TO THE  DESIRED SETTINGS    ILL  SETUP  INVALID SETTINGS SELECTED IN SETUP Reset the settings in the setup menu  see  MENU  page 130   If the same message appears after  SET ITEMS IN THE SETUP MENU TO THE you reset the settings  contact a Sony service  APPROPRIATE VALUES  CONTACT SERVICE   representative   IF THIS ALARM APPE
231. he recording formats    Locked clips cannot be edited    Editing across multiple clips is not possible    It is not possible to carry out assemble editing other than   on the final clip    Ifthere is no space on the disc  in assemble editing it will   not be possible to extend the clip    Preread editing is not supported    After linear editing  discs in the MPEG HD422 format   cannot be read by the versions 1 2 or earlier of the PDW    HD1500 700  To play such discs on the PDW HD1500    7700  upgrade the software to version 1 5 or higher    Even after linear editing  the underlying VANC data is   not rewritten   VANC data cannot be edited   However    essence mark data is rewritten  can be edited     Linear editing is not possible when the unit is in one of   the following modes  To perform linear editing  exit the   mode      Single clip playback mode     Clip Continuous Rec mode     Disc Exchange Cache mode     Live Ligging mode   The message  N A Clip     appears if you attempt to   perform linear editing on discs that contain clips of the   following types  If this occurs  linear editing is not   possible  Create copies  output video and audio signals   from the HDSDI output connectors  or other connectors    and record them to another disc   and then try again     Linear Editing      HD422 clips recorded with the Interval Rec  Picture   Cache  Disc Exchange Cache  or Slow  amp  Quick   Motion functions   HD422 clips that have been partially transferred by an   FTP or FA
232. he unit has two optical pickups for high speed transfers     Direct FTP function   You can use this unit as a local FTP host to send and  receive MXF files to and from other XDCAM devices   without using a computer  This function is available  through simple operations on the GUI screen     Supports SNMP for maintenance and service  This unit supports Sony s SNMP based remote  maintenance and monitoring software  This software  allows you to monitor the status of the hardware via a TCP   IP network in real time  and to record the results in a status  log     User data recording mode   User data  files other than XDCAM AV files  can be  recorded on Professional Discs as PC data via the i LINK  or FTP interface  This allows Professional Discs to be used  as data recording media  with a data storage capacity of  46 4 GB  when dual layer PFD50DLA discs are used      Supports a variety of interfaces   This unit supports the following interfaces    HDSDI video  8 channel audio input and output  SDSDI video  8 channel audio input and output    the SD HDSDI INPUT connector doubles as an SDSDI  input connector    SD composite output   AES EBU digital audio 4 channel input and output  Analog audio 2 channel input and output   Remote     RS 422A  D sub 9 pin x 1      Video remote  D sub 9 pin x 1    TBC control is available from the front panel    i LINK TS  HDV  input and output  when PDBK 201  option board is installed     Features       System Configurations                          
233. he unit s firmware   Japanese kanji cannot be entered      Names and titles must be within the specified character  length limits       Some symbols cannot be used in clip names  The keys  for those symbols are disabled when you are editing a  clip name     See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 In the Clip Properties screen  turn the PUSH  p Erop  SET S SEL  knob to select the item you want to edit   Name  Titlel D  or Title2      1 Only ASCII characters can be used for Titlel     2 Press PUSH SET S SEL  knob     An input screen appears for the selected item     If the area of use setting is    UC     for regions outside  Japan   a keyboard appears that corresponds to the font  selected with Disc Menu item Settings  gt Select Font  A  Japanese keyboard appears if the area of use setting is     J     for Japan       Set Title of Clip 001 041    20 BIN   qw  CapsLock    SShit z    English USA    U          Cancel       3 Edit the string in the edit box     To enter characters   Use the 4 MARK1     MARK2    IN or 9   OUT  buttons or turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select a  key  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Functions of special keys                            Key Function     gt  Move the cursor one character forward or  back    le  91 Move the cursor to Home or End position    Back Deletes the character in front of the cursor    Space   CapsLock   Turns the Shift key on permanently  until  pressed again   and enables input of capita
234. her information  MPEG LA  L L C   250 STEELE STREET   SUITE 300  DENVER  COLORADO 80206   http   www mpegla com    Trademarks and Licenses       About IJG  Independent JPEG  Group     This software is based in part on the work of the  Independent JPEG Group        Character display software  iType     This product includes technology from Monotype Imaging  Inc   including iType  and certain fonts        About net snmpd       Part 1  CMU UCD copyright notice   BSD like           Copyright 1989  1991  1992 by Carnegie Mellon  University    Derivative Work   1996  1998 2000    Copyright 1996  1998 2000 The Regents of the University  of California    All Rights Reserved    Permission to use  copy  modify and distribute this  software and its documentation for any purpose and  without fee is hereby granted  provided that the above  copyright notice appears in all copies and that both that  copyright notice and this permission notice appear in  supporting documentation  and that the name of CMU and  The Regents of the University of California not be used in  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the  software without specific written permission     CMU AND THE REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF  CALIFORNIA DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES WITH  REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE  INCLUDING ALL  IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  AND FITNESS  IN NO EVENT SHALL CMU OR THE  REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA  BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL  INDIRECT OR  CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
235. icient searches   XDCAM equipment records essence  marks as part of Non RealTime  metadata  and uses them to display  thumbnails     HD tri level sync   An HDTV analog reference signal  that applies to 59 94 50Hz systems   A sync signal defined in SMPTE   274M with positive  negative  and  zero values     HDSDI signal   Abbreviation of HD Serial Digital  Interface    A signal in the HDTV serial interface  defined by SMPTE 292M     Metadata   Information about the properties of  video and audio content  XDCAM  records metadata such as UMIDs and  essence marks  and the PDZ 1 Proxy  Browsing Software can be used to  record information such as titles and  comments     MXF   Material eXchange Format  A file  exchange format developed by the  Pro MPEG Forum  Equipment from  different manufacturers can  exchange files in this format     Non audio   General term for audio signals other  than linear PCM  such as Dolby E D  and Dolby Digital  AC 3  P  XDCAM can record non audio as an  input signal    1  Dolby is a trademark of Dolby Laboratories     Non drop frame mode   A mode of advancing timecode  which ignores the difference in frame  values between real time and the  timecode  Using this mode produces  a difference of approximately 86  seconds per day between real time  and timecode  which causes  problems when editing programs in  units of seconds using the number of  frames as a reference     Proxy AV data   Low resolution data with a video  bandwidth of 1 5 Mbps and an audio  b
236. icrophone input  linear editing is disabled      It is not possible to use the audio digital signal processor for multiple functions at  the same time           M394  HD L EDIT 9    Specify the linear editing mode   Standard  Software version 1 51 compatible editing mode  standard mode   Extra  Editing mode that supports normal HD422 clips  extra mode       Clips edited in extra mode cannot be edited on XDCAM devices with software    versions earlier than 1 51  or on this unit when this unit is set to standard mode        f you want to use extra mode  select extra mode on every PDW F1600 HD1500       that you connect to the editing system           Maintenance Menu       snue wN z Je deuj    149          snue wN 4 Jejdeuj    150    M3  OTHERS  Other setting items       Item    M3B  VANC RX   M3B0  VANC RX  PARAMETER PACKET    Setting  For setting HDSDI VANC data input parameters    This setting is required for recording and playback of closed captions  For details   see page 178       In 59 94i  50i  29 97P or 25P mode  selecting the line also selects the   corresponding line in the second field  for example  if line 9 is selected  line 527   is also selected for VANC packet reception     Menu item M3BO enables recording of one VANC packet when the selected line   contains any packets whose DID SDID matches the value set with this menu   item      Up to four packets are recorded per each line regardless of the DID and SDID   for the VANC set with menu item M3B1 or M3B2 Menu i
237. ideo signal output from the HDSDI OUTPUT 1   2  SUPER  connectors  This adjusts the Y  PB  and PR levels  simultaneously       2048 to 0 to 846   741 Y LEVEL  HD  Adjust the Y level of the high definition video signal output from the  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors       2048 to 0 to 846   742 PB LEVEL  HD  Adjust the PB level of the high definition video signal output from the  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors       2048 to 0 to 846   743 PR LEVEL  HD  Adjust the PR level of the high definition video signal output from the  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors       2048 to 0 to 846   745 SETUP LEVEL  HD  Adjust the setup level of the high definition video signal output from the  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors       272 to 0 to 272   746 SYNC PHASE  HD  Control the H sync phase of the high definition video signal output from  the HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors       128 to 0 to 127  747 FINE  HD  Fine control the H sync phase of the high definition video signal output    from the HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER  connectors   0 to 1023                   a   HD1500  When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed   b  Not displayed when the unit is in 23 98P mode        Menu items in the 800s  relating to audio control       Item number  802          Item name    DIGITAL AUDIO MUTING IN  SHUTTLE MODE    Settings    Set the audio muting conditions during shuttle playback   off  Not muted   on  Muted              Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    141    
238. il number total thumbnails  Displays the total number of expanded thumbnails and the  number of the selected thumbnail        Scrollbar    See the description in  Clip thumbnail screen   page 70         Clip name  Displays the name or a title of the expanded clip  see  page 69         Duration  Displays the time from the selected thumbnail to the next  one     Chapter thumbnail screen    Chapters are the sections between the shot marks  Rec  Start marks  and other essence marks that have been  recorded in clips  This screen allows you to display  thumbnails of the chapters in the selected clip     Overview    71       SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo  s Ja deyD          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedo  s Je1deu     72    Shot marks can be set by the user during recording and  playback  They can be deleted and moved    Essence marks other than shot marks are set automatically   They cannot be deleted or moved     2    Chapter of Clip 001 024         P             lE       pe   TC 00 23 00 25 TC 00 23 02 00 TC 00 23 04 00    cup C0001 pur 0 00 01 05       Q Selection frame    See the description in  Clip thumbnail screen   page 70      O Clip number total clips   Displays the total number of clips on the disc and the  number of the clip that contains the displayed chapters   If the essence mark name is a user defined name  it is  displayed between quotation marks  for example as   Chapter   Touch Down    see page 96         S1 S2 RS marks   The    S1      S2   and    RS    marks on the thumbn
239. in    Clip thumbnail screen     page 70         Sub clip number number of sub clips  Displays the total number of sub clips in the clip list  and  the number of the selected sub clip        Scrollbar    See the description in    Clip thumbnail screen     page 70         Clip list date and time   Displays the date and time when the clip list was created   or the date and time of its most recent modification  An  asterisk     appears after the date and time of creation  when the current clip list has not been saved to the disc        New File    appears when no clip list has been loaded into  the unit   s memory  and when a clip list has been cleared  from the unit   s memory        Total duration  Displays the total duration of all sub clips in the clip list     Expand thumbnail screen    This screen displays thumbnails of equally sized divisions  of the selected clip     Expand Clip 008 024 x 12  ar  Mar    TC 00 01 35 17 ile penny     901 032   map     s gt     TC 00 01 36 27    map  TC 00 01 36 14    ap        TC 00 01 38 08  map    TC 00 01 40 02    TC 00 01 38 22    may  Ll  TC 00 01 37 11    TC 00 01 39 06    TC 00 01 37 24    TC 00 01 38 19       Q Selection frame    See the description in  Clip thumbnail screen   page 70         Clip number total clips x number of divisions  Displays the number of the selected clip  the total number  of clips on the disc  and the number of times that the  selected clip has been divided to display the expansion  thumbnails     Q Thumbna
240. in the signal  recorded on the disc while performing the recording  verification function  Change the disc    Recording NOW RECORDING     Wait for recording to finish    Cache Full  CACHE FULL  This appears when the memory becomes full while   DATA IS BEING OVERWRITTEN  performing the disc exchange cache function   Change the disc immediately   Clip End  EDITING ACROSS MULTIPLE CLIPS IS   This appears when an edit across multiple clips is  NOT POSSIBLE  attempted   It is not possible to edit across multiple clips   Disc Full  DISC FULL  This appears when the free capacity of the disc is    exhausted during assemble editing   Delete unneeded clips  or exchange the disc for one  with enough free capacity        REC Format  9     REC MODE SELECTION DIFFERENT  FROM AUDIO VIDEO ON DISC   MATCH REC MODE SELECTION WITH  CLIP     This appears when editing of mixed recording formats  is enabled and an attempt is made to edit an  underlying clip in a different recording format    Reset the recording format to match the format of the  editing target clip  see page 61                                                   Preroll  9 PREROLL TIME SETTING IS SHORT  This appears when editing is impossible because the  preroll time is too short   Set setup menu item 001 PREROLL TIME to 5  seconds or longer     Last Clip     ASSEMBLE EDITING IS NOT POSSIBLE   This appears when an attempt is made to perform an LL  BESIDES LAST CLIP  assemble edit on a clip that is not the last clip on the  disc  E 
241. ing Set Clip Name        Set NAMING FORM to  free     This appears when an attempt is made to change the clip name using Set Clip Name even  though NAMING FORM is not set to  free   see page 111          No Flash Drive     This appears when an attempt is made to select  USB Flash Drive  in the media selection  screen under Load Planning Metadata Select Drive even though the USB memory is not  connected        Not Loaded     This appears when a command related to planning metadata is executed with no planning  metadata loaded   Load planning metadata and try again        Syntax Error     This appears when loading of planning metadata fails because of a syntax error  Correct the  syntax error and try loading the metadata again        Irregular Disc is Used   Use Professional Disc     This appears when the unit is unable to record or play the inserted disc   This unit can record and play Professional Discs  Insert a Professional Disc        The Disc Write Protect TAB  is set to Save     This appears when an attempt is made to format a write protected disc   Try formatting the disc after moving the write protect tab away from the Save position        The REC Inhibit Mode is  Selected   Check Function Menu     This appears when an attempt was made to format when function menu item HOME  gt F3  REC  INH is set to    ON      Set F3  REC INH to    OFF    and try formatting again        Auto Formatting was not  Completed     This appears when auto formatting fails        Video Resolut
242. ing metadata is a file that contains metadata about the  clips to be shot and recorded    To use planning metadata  you will need to save a file in  advance in one of the locations shown below  and insert  the media into this unit   Up to 99 planning metadata files  can be saved on one Professional Disc or USB Flash  drive     Professional Disc  General Sony Planning directory P  USB Flash drive  General Sony Planning directory    1  Created automatically when a disc is formatted        Manipulating planning metadata    This unit allows you to perform the following operations  on planning metadata using the GUI screen      To load planning metadata files     To sort planning metadata   e To check planning metadata properties     To clear planning metadata     To switch the title display in the video monitor screen    See  Using planning metadata   page 94  for details        Setting clip names by using  planning metadata    The following two types of clip name strings can be   written in a planning metadata file      The ASCII format name that appears in the video  monitor screen     The UTF 8 format name that is actually registered as the  clip name 2    1  It is also possible to display the UTF 8 format name  or no name  see  page 95         Chapter    2  When no UTF 8 format name string is specified  the ASCII format name  string is registered as the actual clip name     By loading a file from one of the following locations into  the unit s memory before starting to record
243. ing up operation   stop  Stops  the stop mode    still  Still playback  in jog and shuttle mode    Menu items in the 500s  relating to disc protection  Item number   Item name Settings  501 STILL TIMER To protect the disc against shock and vibrations  and to lengthen the life          of the laser diodes  the unit automatically enters standby off mode   whenever a specified time elapses in a disc stop mode  stop mode or the   still picture mode of search mode   This allows you to set the time after   which the unit exits a disc stop mode and enters standby off mode    0 5 s  0 5 sec     8 m  8 min     30 m  30 min   Can be set in the range  from 0 5 seconds to 30 minutes    off  Do not put into standby off mode           Setup Menu       snue wN Z Ja deuD    135          snus  Z Ja deup    136    Menu items in the 600s  relating to the timecode  metadata  and UMID       Item number  601    Item name    VITC POSITION  SEL 19    In 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P mode    Settings    Select the line into which to insert VITC signals  SD output   12H     16H     20H  Any line from line 12 through line 20       You can insert VITC signals in two places  To insert in two places  set  both item 601 and item 602      In 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode  J   output of wide picture information is  given priority if OUTPUT in setup menu item 731 is setto  auto  and the  VITC insertion line is set to line 16      In 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode  UC   output of wide picture information  is given priority if
244. ion      1  Power supply section       Q POWER switch      AC IN connector    POWER  v AC IN    L               POWER  main power  switch   Press the l side to power on the unit  Press the O side to  power off    When using the unit  normally leave the POWER switch in  the I  on  position  and use the on standby button on the  front panel to switch the unit between the operating state  and standby state     Before turning the main power off  always check to be sure  that the unit is in the standby state  and then press the main  power switch to the O side          ACIN connector    Connect to an AC power supply with the power cord  not  supplied      Rear Panel       seq Jo suonounJ pue seweN z Jeideuo    29          Sued Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jeideu    30    Analog audio signal input output section         ANALOG AUDIO INPUT 1  2 connectors       ANALOG AUDIO OUTPUT 1 2  connectors       ANALOG AUDIO INPUT  ANALOG AUDIO OUTPUT AUDIO MONITOR    E              1  e           AUDIO MONITOR R  L connectors                  ANALOG AUDIO INPUT 1  2 connectors  XLR 3   pin  female    These input analog audio signals    With A1 INPUT or A2 INPUT on page P2 AUDIO  and   A3 INPUT or A4 INPUT on page P3 AUDIO of the   function menu  see page 50   you can select whether the   signal input to connector 1 is assigned to audio channel lor   3  and whether the signal input to connector 2 is assigned   to audio channel 2 or 4    You can set the reference input level with the maintenance   
245. ion Differ from  it on Clip List     This appears when an attempt is made to add a clip to a clip list containing clips with a different  video resolution  number of system lines    It is not possible to add clips to clip lists containing clips with a different video resolution           No Clip Meets the Condition        This appears when no clip is found to meet clip filtering conditions           Alarms relating to audio and video signals             Alarm message in time   Alarm message in video monitor screen   Action  data display area  No INPUT  9 INPUT VIDEO IS NOT DETECTED    Check the setting of V INPUT on Page P1 VIDEO of  CHECK THE VIDEO INPUT MODE AND the function menu  see page 49    SUPPLY A VIDEO SIGNAL TO VIDEO   Input an HDSDI signal   INPUT   EMPHASIS  9 INPUT AUDIO EMPHASIS IS NOT Check the emphasis of the audio input signal   SUPPORTED   CHECK THE EMPHASIS OF THE AUDIO  INPUT SIGNAL   REF NON STD A NON STANDARD REF SIGNAL IS Input a standard signal   BEING USED FOR REF VIDEO  USE A  STANDARD SIGNAL                    a  Displayed only when setup menu item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to    on     Troubleshooting       xipueddy    169    Alarms relating to sensors and drives       Alarm message in time  data display area    FAN Stopped    Alarm message in video monitor screen    FAN MOTOR STOPPED                    Action    Contact a Sony service representative           DR FAN Stop DRIVE FAN MOTOR STOPPED   N FAN Stop FAN MOTOR ON NET 4 BOARD The unit will n
246. ip No   Clip number total number of clips   Name  Clip name Hh   Titlel  Title1   Title2  Title2       AV Format  Recording format   Frame Rate  The frame rate from the time when the  clip was shot  For clips shot using Slow  amp  Quick  Motion  PB Capture  where PB is the playback  frame rate and Capture is the shooting frame rate    TC DUR  Timecode of the first frame Recording time   Created  Date and time of creation   Modified  Date and time of most recent modification   Rec Device  Name of device that created clip  product  number     1 When the unit   s area of use  UC J MODEL SELECT   see page 33   is set to    UC     titles can be displayed in European languages     To scroll hidden parts of the string into view  When a  lt  or  gt  mark is displayed for an item  you can  press the   IN or   OUT button to scroll the display  by one character for each press    The 4 MARK1 and V MARK2 buttons scroll the  beginning and end of the string into view     To display the properties of the previous or the  next clip  Press the PREV button or the NEXT button     To return to the clip thumbnail screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To edit clip information    You can edit the name D  titlel  and title 2 of a clip by  using a software keyboard     1  The  NAMING FORM    sub item on setup menu item 036 must be set to   free   see page 127        The only characters that can be entered are the  alphanumeric characters and characters in the fonts  supported by this version of t
247. is set  to ON  However  if you need to save the clip list  set write  inhibit tab and REC INH to enable recording before you  create or edit the clip list     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing     To add sub clips    You can add sub clips to clip lists from with the clip  thumbnail screen or the clip list thumbnail screen   However  you must use the clip list thumbnail screen to  edit clip lists     Adding sub clips from the clip thumbnail screen  The following procedure explains operations in the clip  thumbnail screen  You can proceed in the same way in the  expand thumbnail screen and the chapter thumbnail  screen  Expanded blocks are added as sub clips in the  expand thumbnail screen  and chapters are added as sub  clips in the chapter thumbnail screen     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip thumbnail screen  select the clip that you  want to add as a sub clip  multiple selections possible      2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Add Sub Clips  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Add Sub Clip screen appears    The clip s  selected in step 1 appear in the upper part  of this screen  and the clip list appears in the lower  Scene Selection window  The I cursor in the Scene  Selection window indicates the location where the  currently selected sub clip s  will be inserted     002  lt  017 035  rem  TC 00 09 43 14     T    TC 00 24 56 24    Add Sub Clip    TC 00 30 40 13    y m  i    Denr    TC 01 01 28 25  j
248. isplay on the monitor    white  White letters on a black background   black  Black letters on a white background   W out  White letters with black outline   B out  Black letters with white outline    Set this item by selecting the required type while viewing the monitor        011    CHARACTER V SIZE    Determine the vertical size of characters such as timecode output from the  COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector for  superimposed display on the monitor    x1  Standard size   x2  2 times standard size    Set this item by selecting the required size while viewing the monitor           012       CONDITION DISPLAY ON  VIDEO MONITOR       Select whether to display disc condition marks in external monitor output   output from the COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI  OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER   connector      dis  disable   Do not display   ena  enable   Display           Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    125          snus  Z Ja deup    126          Item number   Item name Settings  013 SYSTEM FREQUENCY Specify whether to enable switching the system frequencies  59 94i  59 94P   SELECT MENU 29 97P  50i  50P  25P  23 98P    off  Do not enable switching the system frequencies   on  Enable switching the system frequencies   For details about switching the system frequencies  see page 43   Settings for both basic and extended menu items are saved separately fo
249. ival discs and  other discs which have been stored for extended periods   so that you can take action before the deterioration  progresses further      Deteriorating laser diodes performance  The performance of the laser diodes used in optical  heads can worsen with age  leading to deteriorating  playback conditions     For details  see  Digital hours meter   page 159  about  this setting     Refer to the Maintenance Manual for an approximate  guide to when it is time to replace optical heads     To prevent playback conditions from  deteriorating    Pay attention to the following points when handling discs       Do not open disc cartridges and touch discs directly with  your hands      Do not store for long periods in locations which are  dusty or exposed to air circulated by fans      Do not store for long periods under high temperatures or  in locations exposed to direct sunlight     If playback conditions have deteriorated   If a yellow or red playback condition mark appears  check   the following points    Whether the disc displays the same playback condition  on other XDCAM devices  If so  the surface of the  disc may be dirty or scratched  or the performance of  the recording layers on the disc may have worsened  due to age  Do not use discs with these symptoms    Whether every disc inserted into an XDCAM device  displays the same playback conditions  If so  the  performance of the laser diodes may have  deteriorated  Check the total optical output time     Superimposed
250. ks that have been set in all clips on the disc        Scrollbar  See the description in    Clip thumbnail screen     page 70         Clip date and time  Displays the date and time when the clip that contains the  selected thumbnail was recorded or last modified        Clip name  Displays the name or a title of the clip that contains the  selected frame  see page 69         Displaying menus    Thumbnail Menu    The Thumbnail Menu displays menu items that are valid  for the currently displayed thumbnail screen     To display the Thumbnail Menu    To display the Thumbnail Menu  press the MENU button    Clip thumbnail screen    with a thumbnail screen displayed  To return to the original Clip  Navigating sibling relati     018 036    screen  press the MENU button again  or press the RESET     RETURN button            TC 00 29 19 23  29 38  TC 00 29 50 04                                                             000  amp        Phones Depu    GHEHE    FWD END OSTANDBY OREC INHI                Q MENU button     RESET RETURN button              eo     l      TC 00 09 43 14 TC 00 24 24 29               POs     TC 00 24 34 27 TC 00 24 46 22 TC 00 25 42 08 TC 00 25 49 07  DATE amp TIME 30 NOV 2005 14 14 pun 0 23 22 26    Thumbnail Menu    Clip Information       Select Index Picture   Clip Properties   Add Sub Clips SHIFT SET  Delete Clip SHIFT RESET  Lock Unlock Clip SHIFT STOP          Disc Menu    The Disc Menu allows you to do the following     Set Clip Flag  gt   Skip Scroll  Thu
251. l  letters and symbols    4 Shift Enables input of capital letters and symbols   Turns off after entry of one character    Enter Confirms the edit and enables the OK and  Cancel buttons              4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     You return to the Clip Properties screen  and the  results of the editing are reflected in the clip  information     To enter text using a USB keyboard or USB  mouse   You can connect a Windows USB keyboard or a Windows  USB mouse to the MAINTENANCE connector  see  page 29   and use them together with the software  keyboard to enter text    Connect a Japanese keyboard if you have set the area of  use to    J     for Japan   2   Connect a keyboard that corresponds to the font selected  with Disc Menu item Settings  gt Select Font if you have set  the area of use to    UC     for regions outside Japan      1  Some USB keyboards or USB mice may not be recognized  In this case   the message    Unknown USB    appears   2  Only ASCII characters can be entered from a Japanese keyboard     To change the display language  font  for clip names   clip list names  and title2 clip titles  Select one of  the following languages  fonts  with the Disc Menu  item Settings  gt Select Font      European Alphabet  The keyboard language can be  selected with the Disc Menu item Settings  gt USB  Keyboard Language  see following section       Korean  The Korean keyboard is selected  automatically  You can enter Hangul characters if  you have conn
252. l Menu to  unlock the clip  see page 85  and try again    File Access CANNOT CHANGE SETTINGS DURING  This appears when an attempt is made to change the   FILE ACCESS  setting of PC RMT  ENABLE DISABLE  on page P7  OTHER of the function menu while accessing a file or  processing the command with PC REMOTE    Inhibit  PC REMOTE IS DISABLED  This appears when an attempt is made to change the   CHECK MAINTENANCE MENU M33  setting of PC RMT  ENABLE DISABLE  on page P7  OTHER of the function menu while maintenance  menu item M33  FILE I F CONFIG   PC REMOTE is  set to    ENABLE       PC REMOTE IS DISABLED  This appears when an attempt is made to change the   CHECK SETUP MENU 215  setting of PC RMT  ENABLE DISABLE  on page P7  OTHER of the function menu while setup menu item  215 i LINK mode is set to the value other than  FAM     GUI Inhibit GUI OPERATION IS INHIBITED  This appears when the THUMBNAIL button or the       CHECK SETUP MENU        DISC MENU  SHIFT SUB CLIP  button is pressed  while setup menu item 151 GUI OPERATION is set to   dis            Troubleshooting       xipueddy    165          xipueddy    166       Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen    Description action                                  Mixed REC  THIS DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED  This appears if a disc containing clips recorded in  TWO OR MORE AUDIO OR VIDEO different recording formats is inserted while mixed  FORMATS ARE RECORDED ON THE format recording mode is di
253. l to the angle that makes  the buttons easiest to use     Cache recording for seamless disc exchanges  About 30 seconds  this duration may differ depending on  the state of a disc  of video and audio data can be recorded  to the unit s internal memory cache during a disc  exchange  and then written back to the newly loaded disc   This allows seamless recording across extended recording  sessions  including recording of video feeds  with no  important scenes lost while discs are being exchanged     Cart system support   With its compact body  this unit can replace the SD PDW   1500 unit  You can mount this unit in the PDJ C1080 and  PDJ A640 XDCAM cart systems     IT friendly    Computer access to files  file access mode   Video and audio clip data are recorded as files  The FAM  function enables quick random access by computers to the  video  audio  and metadata files stored on Professional  Discs  with the ability to display thumbnail lists on the  computer screen and perform file based reads and writes     Equipped with network connector   The unit features a Gigabit Ethernet connector as standard  equipment  Via this connector  you can connect the unit to  computers and networks to enable listing of the video   audio  and metadata files recorded on the Professional  Disc  and rapid file transfers  Support for FTP commands  makes it easy to carry out network file transfers from  remote locations     Features       MBIAJOAC   Je1deuo    13       MeIAJOAQ   1e1deuo    14    T
254. l value of the numeric part of the title  00001 to 99999  five digit  number    00001       036    FILE NAMING       Sub item       1 NAMING FORM    Specify whether to allow use of clip and clip list files with user defined  names     See  Alarms relating to audio and video signals   page 169  for details about  how to make the settings     Specify the clip and clip list naming format   Specify whether to allow use of  files with user defined names     C      Standard format  Do not allow use of files with user defined names   free  Free format  Allow use of files with user defined names        2 AUTO NAMING       When  free  is selected under the sub item    NAMING FORM   specify the   format of the names of clips recorded on this unit  Specify the standard   name format  or the same name as the title listed below  or the name   specified in planning metadata    C      Use the standard format for clip names    title  Use the title set in setup menu item 035  CLIP TITLE NAMING  SELECT  for clip names    plan  Use the name specified in planning metadata        B01    RECALL SETUP BANK 1    Set to    on    to recall menu settings from menu bank 1        B02    RECALL SETUP BANK 2    Set to    on    to recall menu settings from menu bank 2           B03       RECALL SETUP BANK 3       Set to    on    to recall menu settings from menu bank 3           Setup Menu       snue wN Z 13 deyo    127          snue N 4 Jejdeuj    128                Item number   Item name Settings   B11 S
255. le avec des contacts de mise    la terre  conformes    la r  glementation de s  curit   locale applicable    2  Utilisez un cordon d alimentation  cable secteur    3 fils    fiche femelle fiche m  le avec des caract  ristiques  nominales  tension  amp  rage  appropri  es     Pour toute question sur l utilisation du cordon d alimentation   fiche femelle fiche m  le ci dessus  consultez un technicien du  service apr  s vente qualifi      Pour les clients en Europe   Le fabricant de ce produit est Sony Corporation  1 7 1 Konan   Minato ku  Tokyo  Japon    Le repr  sentant autoris   pour EMC et la s  curit   des produits  est Sony Deutschland GmbH  Hedelfinger Strasse 61  70327  Stuttgart  Allemagne  Pour toute question concernant le  service ou la garantie  veuillez consulter les adresses  indiqu  es dans les documents de service ou de garantie  s  par  s     Um die Gefahr von Branden oder  elektrischen Schl  gen zu verringern  darf  dieses Ger  t nicht Regen oder Feuchtigkeit  ausgesetzt werden    Um einen elektrischen Schlag zu  vermeiden  darf das Geh  use nicht  ge  ffnet werden  Uberlassen Sie  Wartungsarbeiten stets nur qualifiziertem  Fachpersonal     DIESES GER  T MUSS GEERDET  WERDEN     ACHTUNG   Das Ger  t ist nicht tropf  und spritzwassergesch  tzt  Es  d  rfen keine mit Fl  ssigkeiten gef  llten Gegenstande  z  B   Vasen  darauf abgestellt werden     Solange das Netzkabel an eine Netzsteckdose  angeschlossen ist  bleibt das Ger  t auch im ausgeschalteten  Zustand mi
256. level exceeds 0 dB     8  Meter display mode  Displays the audio level meter  display mode selected with AU METER on page P4  AUDIO of the function menu  see page 50                     Function menu   Use the PAGE HOME button to display this menu  and to  switch between the pages  HOME  P1 to P7   P8  D    HOME2  D   of the menu  Each page has three to six  setting items  Press the corresponding button to change a  setting     1 If a menu item is assigned using maintenance menu item M38  F KEY  CONFIG    For details  see page 48  Basic Operations of the  Function Menu  in Chapter 3        Clip information  Displays clip information     Front Panel       All remaining clips or clip list playback time    Total number of clips recorded on disc    w    Number of current clip        PDW HD1500 000  00       Clip name             Clip names are displayed according to the setting of   Settings  gt Display Title in the Disc Menu  see page 74     However  clip names are always displayed during   playback    The following characters can be displayed as clip names in   this area    e Digits  0 to 9     Alphabetic characters  a to z  A to Z     The following symbols              96   amp     6           comma         period         colon      semicolon    lt       gt    2G LL  Glh      Space       Recording format  Displays the system frequency and the video and audio  formats        HD422 1080  SOMbPsfi8CH 24B IT        Audio format    Video format    System frequency             Q Tim
257. list     To edit a clip list  you need to load the clip list from the  disc into the unit s internal memory    The clip list which is currently loaded into the unit memory  is called the  current clip list     The current clip list is always the target of sub clip creation  and editing  Clip list playback also uses the current clip  list    After creating and editing a clip list  you need to save it to  disc        Unit memory       Current clip list  Can be edited  adding  deleting  and  reordering sub clips     SAVE LOAD        Clip list playback  and thumbnail  display                   C0001  Clip 1   C0002  Clip 2   C0008  Clip 3     E0001  Clip list 1   E0002  Clip list 2   E0003  Clip list 3     E0099  Clip list 99                          Clip list playback    Clips and clip lists are saved together on a disc     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing        SueeJoS  MH ui suonejedo c JaydeyD    87          SU9919S  MD ui suoneiado g 1e1deu    88       To play a clip list  insert a disc into the unit  load the clip  list that you want to play  and press the PLAY button   Clips are played according to the data in the clip list        Creating and editing clip lists    The following table lists the steps in the creation and  editing of clip lists with the scene selection function  To  create a clip list  you always need to carry out the steps  inside the heavy lines  Other steps can be carried out as  required     1  Add sub clips  Use the Add Sub Clips command to add    th
258. lowing data is transferred  depending on whether a  command name is specified with  lt command name gt      Command name specified  Explanation of the specified  command       No specification  Command list  Input example  HELP RETR    NOOP  Does nothing except return a response   Used to check  whether this unit is running     Command syntax  NOOP  lt CRLF gt     PWD    Displays the current directory          if the directory is the  root directory    Command syntax  PWD  lt CRLF gt     CWD  Changes the current directory  moves from the current  directory to another directory     Command syntax  CWD   SP     path name    lt CRLF gt     Moves to a directory as follows  depending on whether a  directory is specified with  lt path name gt       Directory specified  To the specified directory     No specification  To the root directory   Input example  CWD General    CDUP  Moves one level up in the directory structure  makes the  parent of the current directory be the current directory      Command syntax  CDUP  lt CRLF gt     MKD  Creates a new directory     Directories can be created only in the General directory   For details  see  File operation restrictions   page 107      Command syntax  MKD   SP    lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt     FTP File Operations    RMD  Deletes a directory     Directories can be deleted only in the General directory   For details  see    File operation restrictions     page 107      Command syntax  RMD  lt SP gt   lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt     MDT
259. lowing state     Recording  playback  search and other disc  operations  see page 54   Stopped   THUMBNAIL button  see page 21   Off   Disc access by clip deletion  disc formatting  etc    Stopped   MENU button  see page 20   Off   Unsaved current clip list  Save or clear  Connections between this unit and a computer by the  Live Logging function  Disconnected   Setting of setup menu item 258 LIVE LOGGING   Values other than    live view mode         off    or    live  mode      2 Connect the  amp   i LINK  S400 connector on this unit to  the i LINK  IEEE1394  connector on the remote  computer  using an i LINK cable  see page 36      When a disc is inserted into this unit  the remote  computer recognizes this unit as a removable disc  The  following icon appears in the Finder on the remote  computer  indicating that the computer is now able to  perform file operations     M1    Untitled    Operation limitations during FAM  connections    With the exception of the EJECT button  recording  buttons and playback control buttons are disabled    Do not use the EJECT button to eject discs  Always eject  discs from the computer    Do not disconnect the i LINK cable during a FAM  connection  Doing so may result in unstable operation   Always eject any loaded disc before disconnecting the  i LINK cable        Operating on files    Proceed as follows     1 Start the Finder     Check to be sure that a drive has been assigned to this  unit     2 Operate from the Finder on the files on the
260. lt CRLF gt     SITE FUNC  Acquires the function and version of the extended  commands   Information is sent in the following format   Command syntax    main function     SP     branch  function     SP     branch function version      For XDCAM  sent in a format like    200 MXF DISK 1       200  is a response code    Command syntax  SITE FUNC  lt CRLF gt     SITE UMMD  When a C  MXF file is sent with the STOR command  the  copy source UMID is saved if this command is invoked  immediately before the STOR command    Command syntax  SITE UMMD  lt CRLF gt     SITE DF  Acquires the amount of free disc space   Command syntax  SITE DF  lt CRLF gt     SITE CHMOD  Locks and unlocks clips  Also sets permissions for  directories and files in the General directory   Command syntax  SITE CHMOD   SP     flag     SP     lt path name gt   lt CRLF gt     Specify one of the following values in  lt flag gt   according to  the specification in  lt path name gt      When a clip is specified in  lt path name gt     444  Lock     666  Unlock     When a directory in the General directory is specified in   lt path name gt     555  Forbid writing to the directory     777  Allow writing to the directory     When a file in the General directory is specified in   path   name gt     444  Forbid writing to and execution of the file     555  Forbid writing to the file  but allow execution     666  Allow writing to the file  but forbid execution     777  Allow writing to and execution of the file     Input ex
261. mat  up  to 32 characters  or UTF 8 format  up to 16 characters      If a name string contains even one non ASCII character   the maximum length of that string is 16 characters     Essence mark name string example     lt  xml  version  1 0    encoding  UTF 8  2 gt   4    PlanningMetadata xmlns  http   xmlns sony net pro   metadata planningmetadata    assignId  H00123      creationDate  2009 04 15T08 00 00Z    lastUpdate    2009 04 15T15 00 00Z    version  1 00  gt   4    Properties propertyId  assignment     class    original     update  2009 04 15T15 00 00Z      modifiedByz  Chris    e3    Title usAscii  Football Game    xml lang    en   Football Game 15 04 2009 lt  Title gt 4    Meta name  _ShotMark1  pcontent    Goal   5   lt Meta name   ShotMark2  content    Shoot   2            Meta namez  ShotMark3   pContent    Corner Kick    gt 4     Meta name  _ShotMark4    peontent    Free Kick    gt 4     Meta name  _ShotMark5   peontent    Goal Kick    gt 4     Meta name  _ShotMark6   peontent    Foul   gt       Meta name  _ShotMark7   peontent    PK   gt 3     Meta name  _ShotMark8   peontent    Ist Half    gt H     Meta name  _ShotMark9    peontent    2nd Half    gt 4     Meta name  _ShotMark0   peontent    Kick Off   5       Properties   4     PlanningMetadata   4    In the above example  a carriage return   You can check user defined essence mark name strings in  the User Defined Essence Marks screen  see page 96      When you create a definition file  enter each statement as 
262. mbnail Search  gt     Thumbnail Menu of the clip thumbnail screen    Shortcut operations  Shortcut button names are displayed next to the menu  items of commands that have shortcuts  see page 105      Shortcuts displayed within parentheses should be used  with all menus closed     Thumbnail Menu submenus     The Thumbnail Search Menu contains the basic  commands for thumbnail searches      The Thumbnail View Menu contains the basic  commands for moving to other menus      Underlined values in the Operation Setting column are             the factory defaults     Item Operation Setting   Load Clip List Load clip list into this unit   s memory    Save Clip List Save a clip list on the disc under its current name  overwriting the old    contents        Save Clip List as       Save a clip list on the disc under a new name        Delete Clip List    Delete a clip list from the disc        Clear Clip List    Clear the current clip list from the unit s memory        Load Planning Metadata Select Drive          Select a media disc or drive and load planning metadata into this  unit s memory           Overview       SU9BINS  MD ul suogejedo  s Ja deyo    73          SU9919S  f1 ui suoneiado S 1e1deu    74       Item    Operation Setting       Planning Metadata Properties    Display the properties of the currently loaded planning metadata        Clear Planning Metadata    Clear the currently loaded planning metadata from the unit s memory        Lock or Delete All Clips                S
263. me  such as  pdw     hd1500                   a  If an XDCAM device is selected as the Device Type  then the User  Name and Password are set automatically to the default  and you do  not need to make the Port and Path settings  Simply selecting the  Host Name  or as appropriate the Description  is enough to fulfill the  requirements for connection     If the User Name or Password of the device that you  want to connect to changes  set them here     Set the various items     To select an item   Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move the cursor   and then push the PUSH SET S SEL  knob    A software keyboard appears so that you can enter a  setting     Select  Connect   and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The settings are saved and the Connecting Status  screen appears        SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo g JajdeyD    Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function  1 01          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedQ  s je1deu     102    Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Connecting Status       Open Remote Host  FTP Login  Change Directory    The following table lists the various stages that appear  in the connection status screen and describes the  corresponding processing        Item Description    DNS Name  Resolving    When host was specified by a  host name instead of an IP  address  the unit is querying a  DNS server for the host s IP  address        The unit has issued a ping   communications established   command and is waiting for a  response     ping   echo back       Open Remote Host   Th
264. menu  For details  see page 52     FTP File Operations       FTP File Operations    File operations between this unit and a remote computer  can be carried out by the File Transfer Protocol  called  FTP below      Preparations    1 Connect the network connectors of this unit and a  remote computer with a network cable  see  connections illustration on page 36   Or connect this  unit to the network to which the remote computer is  connected  see connections illustration on page 36      2 Set the IP address and other network setting items for  this unit  P    For details  see  To change network settings    page 153      If network settings have already been made  Check the IP address of this unit     For details  see  To check the assigned IP address    page 153      1  This unit is able to acquire an IP address automatically from a DHCP  server  It also supports an Auto IP function to assign an IP address  automatically when access from this unit to the DHCP server times  out  You can check DHCP settings and the assigned IP address on  page M5 NETWOREK of the maintenance menu     If this unit is directly connected to a computer running  Windows Vista with a network cable  change the  setting as follows     1  Open    Network and Sharing Center   gt    Manage  network connections     Local Area Connection  in  the control panel   2  In the  Local Area Connection  Properties   uncheck the  Internet Protocol Version 6   TCP IPv6    and then click the OK button     3 Set the remot
265. menu is  set to    INT     and PRST RGN is set to    PRESET        P1 VIDEO page       F6  SETUP   BLACK       Sets the HD SD output black setup level  or black level    PRESET  Set the level to the preset  value  regardless of the manual  setting    Manual setting  While the setting value  is flashing  turn the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to set the black  setup level  in 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P 23 98P mode  over the  range x30 IRE or the black level  in  50i 50P 25P mode  over the range   210 mV              Item  F1  V INPUT    Setting    Selects the video input signal    HDSDI  HDSDI signal   SDSDI  SDSDI signal   i LINK  i LINK signal  when the PDBK   201 option board is installed    SG  Test signal from internal signal  generator  Normally this item is not  displayed  It appears when you hold  the button down for 3 seconds         P2 AUDIO page          F2  VID  PROC    Selects the method used to control the   internal video signal processor and make   related settings    LOCAL  Use the function menu to  change settings    MENU  Use the setup menu to change  settings        F3  VIDEO    Sets the output level for HD SD video   signals  range    e to  3 dB     PRESET  Set the video signal output  level to a preset value  regardless of  manual setting    Manual setting  While the setting value  is flashing  turn the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to adjust the video  signal output level     Item  F1  A1 INPUT    Setting    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 1    S
266. menu item M37  AUDIO CONFIG  see page 148      Factory default setting   4 dB     Microphone settings   If you have connected a microphone to this unit  you can  set input level  AGC  and limiter values for the  microphone with setup menu items 834  839  840  and 841   see page 143      An unpleasant sound may be output if you have connected  a microphone to the ANALOG AUDIO INPUT 1 or 2  connector and power the microphone on with the input  level too high  Check the input level setting before  connecting a microphone        ANALOG AUDIO OUTPUT 1  2 connectors  XLR  3 pin  male    These output analog audio signals    When the unit is shipped from the factory  the 1 connector   is set to audio channel 1  and the 2 connector is set to audio   channel 2  You can change these settings with setup menu   item 824 ANALOG LINE OUTPUT SELECT  see   page 142     You can set the output level with the maintenance menu   item M37  AUDIO CONFIG  see page 148    Factory   default setting   4 dB    Non audio signals are muted        AUDIO MONITOR R  L connectors  XLR 3 pin   male    This outputs an audio signal for monitoring    The monitored channel is selected with MONITR L and   MONITR R on page P2 AUDIO of the function menu     Rear Panel    See    Basic Operations of the Function Menu     page 48   for more information      3  Digital audio signal input output section         DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  IN 1 2  3 4  connectors       o Oo   12 anll   D DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  OUT 1 2  3 4  c
267. munity   This product is intended for use in the following  Electromagnetic Environments  E1  residential   E2   commercial and light industrial   E3  urban outdoors   E4   controlled EMC environment  ex  TV studio      The manufacturer of this product is Sony Corporation  1 7 1  Konan  Minato ku  Tokyo  Japan    The Authorized Representative for EMC and product safety is  Sony Deutschland GmbH  Hedelfinger Strasse 61  70327  Stuttgart  Germany  For any service or guarantee matters  please refer to the addresses given in separate service or  guarantee documents     For kundene i Norge  Dette utstyret kan kobles til et IT stremfordelingssystem   Apparatet m   tilkoples jordet stikkontakt    F  r kunderna i Sverige  Apparaten skall anslutas till jordat uttag    Suomessa asuville asiakkaille  Laite on liitett  v   suojamaadoituskoskettimilla varustettuun  pistorasiaan    For the Customers in Taiwan only  Ere EN    AVERTISSEMENT    Afin de r  duire les risques d incendie ou  d   lectrocution  ne pas exposer cet  appareil    la pluie ou    l humidit      Afin d   carter tout risque d   lectrocution   garder le coffret ferm    Ne confier  l entretien de l appareil qu    un personnel  qualifi       eu  TH    CET APPAREIL DOIT   TRE RELI      LA  TERRE     ATTENTION   Eviter d exposer l appareil    un   gouttement ou    des    claboussures  Ne placer aucun objet rempli de liquide   comme un vase  sur l appareil     Cet appareil n est pas d  connect   de la source d alimentation  sect
268. n     Thumbnail Operations       To delete all clips  1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Lock or Delete All Clips  and then select Delete  All Clips     A message appears asking you to confirm that you  want to delete all clips     3 Select OK to execute the deletion  or Cancel to cancel  it  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Locked clips cannot be deleted        Scene Selection  Clip List  Editing        What is scene selection     Scene selection is a function which allows you to select  material  clips  from the material recorded on a disc and  perform cut editing  You can do this by operating on this  unit only    Scene selection is a convenient way to perform cut  editing in the field and in other offline situations    In scene selection you create a clip list  editing data    Since the material itself is not affected  you can repeat  this any number of times    You can play back the edit list created by scene selection  on this unit    In scene selection you can add whole clips or add parts  of a clip  You can add scenes using chapters  change the  playback sequence  and amend or delete In and Out  points  All of these operations can be carried out easily  on this unit    Clip lists  editing data  created with the scene selection  function can be used on XPRI and other full feature  nonlinear editing systems     Clips   Material recorded with this unit is managed in units called  clips  A clip contains the material from a recording start  point to a recordin
269. nail Menu     3 Select Move Essence Mark     The Move Essence Mark screen is displayed     Move Essence Mark   ShotMark2 0002 0002    TCR 00 28 23 14       You can perform playback and searches in this screen     4 Use the PLAY button or jog dial to display the frame  you want     5 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     To display the chapter thumbnail screen of the  previous or next clip with chapters   With the chapter thumbnail screen still active  press the  PREV button or the NEXT button    The unit searches in the reverse or forward direction for the  next clip with chapters  beginning with the previous or  next clip     Using essence marks to find scenes    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip playback screen or the clip thumbnail  screen  press the THUMBNAIL button with the  SHIFT button held down     The Select Essence Mark screen appears   The names of essence marks that are not recorded on  the disc are displayed in gray     Select Essence Mark  ark  Shot Mark2    Rec Start  Cut       If planning metadata with user defined essence  mark has been loaded   You can select user defined essence marks  see  page 96      Select Essence Mark  Rec Start  ShotMarkO     kick off          turn over        timeout     qQ         oQ       SQ         iv     2 Select the essence mark that you want  and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The essence mark thumbnail screen displays a list of  frames where the sel
270. names by using planning metadata                   156  Setting volume labels by using planning metadata                             157   Appendix   Important Notes on Operation                                        eeeeeeesees 158  Condens ation a  deae reti nue IR Ooo 158  About tbe LCD  panel  uouas Rose eod cer epis taki dn Re eias 158   Periodic Maintenance                                        ccece eee eeeeeeeeeeeee 159  Digital hours Meter J        5 root idee eura aee Ve os tee eR Ce UE Re LE PER ee Y euss 159   Troubleshooting nn 161  Alif S ngr ae cd nii be N E a e M oec a bpe edt 161  luco dinis pris EP          M    172  To eject discs with the unit powered off                        sss 172   Specifications f             Y 172   Using PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software                                      175   E  Inteuel  adapto 176   Ancillary Data    nacio eur rtr na ke saa ganan dan ri dw xe ERE ER ERR 178  Ancillary data in HDSDI SDSDI signals                            eene 178    Table of Contents    9    10    Table of Contents    Ancillary data in MXF Des nidi edet etos Iti oreet etts 178    General MXF metadata   ae ode ae ee 178  Closed caption dale eu PER ie eg ex RR a vee an ee as 179  Correspondence between Setting Items of the HKDV 900 and  Setup Menu of This Unit                                       eeeeeessssesss 184  List of Supported USB Keyboards                                               185  Trademarks and Licenses                        
271. nd binary forms  with or  without modification  are permitted provided that the  following conditions are met    Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution    The name of Fabasoft R amp D Software GmbH  amp  Co KG  or any of its subsidiaries  brand or product names may  not be used to endorse or promote products derived from  this software without specific prior written permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDER  AS IS  AND ANY EXPRESS  ORIMPLIED WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT  LIMITED TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE  LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT   INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR  CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT  NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE        About libupnp    Copyright  c  2000 2003 Intel Corporation  All rights rese
272. nd playback EIA 708 B  standard closed caption data in HDSDI signals     HDSDI  VANC  input  EIA 708 608    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  input          EIA 708 608 recording  and playback    EIA 608 recording  and playback     page 178  or    To record EIA 608 B standard closed  caption data in HDSDI signals   page 178      EIA 708 608 standard closed caption data recorded in HD  video is output as HDSDI signals  regardless of menu  settings    EIA 608 standard closed caption data in SDSDI line 21  signals are recorded and played back  output as SDSDI or  composite signals   regardless of menu settings     HDSDI  VANC  output  EIA 708 608       EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output    Internal processing by this unit    Recording and playback after EIA 608   708 conversion    In response to closed caption input data that complies with  the EIA 608 standard  record  play and output that data  after conversion to EIA 708 format    However  settings are required for recording of ELA 608  standard closed caption data     EIA 608      708  conversion    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  input    EIA 708 recording  and playback       For details  see  To record EIA 608 B standard closed    caption data in SDSDI line 21 signals after conversion to  the EIA 708 B standard   page 178      HDSDI  VANC  output  EIA 708    Internal processing by this unit    Ancillary Data       xipueddy    179          xipueddy    180    EIA 708 608 EE output   In response to closed caption inp
273. ne button is held down while    another is pressed  for example    SHIFT   RESET   RETURN        The same shortcut may access different functions     depending on the screen that is active when it is executed              Function Operation  Clip List Thumbnail  display the clip list thumbnail screen    SUB CLIP  Expand Thumbnail  display expand thumbnail screen  EXPAND   Chapter Thumbnail  display chapter thumbnail screen  CHAPTER       Essence Mark Thumbnail  display essence mark  thumbnail screen     SHIFT   THUMBNAIL       Add Sub Clip  add sub clip     SHIFT   PUSH SET S SEL  knob       Delete Clip  delete clip     SHIFT   RESET RETURN       Lock Unlock Clip  lock or unlock clip     SHIFT   STOP       Set Inpoint  set In point       IN   PUSH SET S SEL  knob       Set Outpoint  set Out point        OUT   PUSH SET S SEL  knob       Cue up Inpoint  cue up In point        IN   PREV or   IN   NEXT       Cue up Outpoint  cue up Out point        OUT   PREV or    OUT   NEXT       Reset Inpoint  reset In point        IN   RESET RETURN       Reset Outpoint  reset Out point        OUT   RESET RETURN       Cue up  cue up     PUSH SET S SEL  knob 9       Cue up  amp  Play  cue up and play     PLAY D       Page Down  switch to next page     SHIFT     MARK2       Page Up  switch to previous page     SHIFT     MARK1       Go To End  go to the last item     SHIFT   NEXT       Go To Top  go to the first item     SHIFT   PREV       Select Multi Clip  select multiple clips     SHIFT     OU
274. next section      To install the FAM driver   Insert the supplied CD ROM  XDCAM Application  Software  into the CD ROM drive of your computer   navigate to the FAM Driver directory  and run the installer  in the directory for your operating system  then follow the  installation instructions     For details  refer to the ReadMe file contained on the CD   ROM disc     Use Version 2 10 or higher of the FAM driver  The FAM  driver on the supplied CD ROM is Version 2 10 or higher   If a FAM driver is already installed on your computer   check the version     To check the version    For Windows XP    Select    ProDisc    from    Add or Remove Programs  in the  control panel  and then click    Click here for support  information      For Windows Vista     1  Open  Programs      Programs and Functions  in the  control panel  and then right click the header  where     Name    and  Supplier  are displayed  and select   Other         2  In the Advanced Settings dialog  check  Version  and  click    OK     The version column appears  Check the  version of  ProDisc      For Windows 7   Open  Programs and Features  in the control panel  and  then check the version of  ProDisc         Making FAM connections    1 Ifthere is a disc loaded in this unit  put the unit into the  following state     Recording  playback  search and other disc  operations  see page 54   Stopped   THUMBNAIL button  see page 21   Off   Disc access by Lock or Delete All Clips  Format  Disc  and so on in the Disc Menu  
275. ng continuous timecode  122  Function buttons  F1 to F6  20  Function menu 24  48  HOME page 48  P1 VIDEO page 49  P2 AUDIO page 49  P3 AUDIO page 50  P4 AUDIO page 50  P5 TC page 51  P6 REF page 51  P7 OTHER page 51    G    Gigabit Ethernet 13   Glossary 192   GUI screen 68  operations 75    H    Handle 17  HDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER   connectors 28  remote control function 57  HOME button 21    i LINK S400 connector 28  IN  button 19  indicator 19  Index picture  changing 81  Initial Setup 33    J    Jog  dial 19  mode 65  Jog shuttle transport indicators 19    K    KEY INHI switch 18    L    LEVEL adjustment knob 18  Linear editing 60   Live Logging function 58  Loading unloading disc 53    M    Maintenance  periodic 159  MAINTENANCE connector 29  Maintenance menu 148  communication speed 154  items 148  network settings 153  operations 152  MARK 1 MARK2 buttons 19  Menu  bank setting 127  changing settings 129  configuration 123  disc menu 73  function menu 48  maintenance menu 148  returning to default settings 129  setup menu 123  MENU button 20  Metadata 176  Microphone settings 30  Mixed format recording mode 54    Move Shot Mark screen 78    N    Names and functions of parts 17  Network  assigning IP address automatically  153  connector 29  setting IP address 153  settings 153  NEXT button 22  Normal speed playback 64    O    On standby button and indicator 17  OUT   button 19   indicator 19    P    PAGE button 21  PDZ 1  connections 36  installation 175  system requi
276. ng function  OFF  ON       M3D  DATE TIME PRESET    Specifies the year  month  day  time  and time zone        M3E  USB MEMORY UTIL    For installation of software upgrade    For details  refer to the Maintenance Manual        M3F  FACTORY SETUP          For details  refer to the Maintenance Manual           a   HD1500  When the PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key is installed   M4  SETUP MAINTENANCE  Items relating to the setup menu                Item Setting    M40  EXTENDED MENU Select whether to display the extended menu     DISABLE  Do not display   ENABLE  Display        M41  CUSTOMIZE Select whether to enable the customization function of the setup menu           DISABLE  Do not display   ENABLE  Display        Maintenance Menu                   M4  SETUP MAINTENANCE  Items relating to the setup menu  Item Setting  M46  MENU M461  MENU _   Displays the status of the menu bank where the current menu settings are stored   DATA STATUS  CONTROL DISPLAY  M462  SAVE Select whether to temporarily back up  save  setup menu settings before operations such as  MENU DATA software upgrades   SAVE function button  F5   Back up  save  the settings   MENU button  Return to next highest menu level without backing up   M463  LOAD Select whether to restore  load  setting that were backed up  saved  with the  SAVE MENU  MENU DATA DATA  item        SAVE function button  F5   Restore  load  the settings   MENU button  Return to the next highest menu level without restoring        M47  SETUP B
277. nged    option     If the remote host is a computer  clips are transferred  with the UMID unchanged regardless of this setting     To reconnect to a remote host   The Reconnect button is enabled if the most recent  operation successfully established a connection to a  remote host    You can select  Reconnect  and press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob to reconnect to that host  The host is  selected automatically and the screen changes directly  to the Connecting Status screen  see step 9 in the  procedure      The Reconnect button is not enabled if the most recent  operation failed to connect to a remote host     Select   gt   and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     The Select Remote Host screen appears     Upload Clips via Direct FTP    Select Remote Host    Remote Host 1    9 Remote Host 2  9 Remote Host 3      Remote Host 4 UPnP     Hosts Discovered via UPnP  Network Config    Cancel            Select the remote host  the target device to which you  want to transfer the clips      You can register up to four remote hosts    Remote Host 1 to 3  Register these in the settings  screen    Remote Host 4 UPnP   A remote host that supports  UPnP  universal plug and play  is detected and  registered automatically  see    To enable the  UPnP function     page 100       To check remote hosts discovered by the UPnP  function   Select    Hosts Discovered via UPnP     and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob   If the UPnP function of  this unit is disabled  a confirmation screen appears
278. nhibit tab of the disc is set to  recording enabled                                   File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write Rename   Create   Delete   INDEX XML Contains data for management of the   Yes No No No No  material on the disc    ALIAS XML 9  Contains conversion tables for Yes No No No No  assigning user defined names to clips  and clip lists    DISCMETA XML   Contains metadata to indicate the Yes Yes D  No No No  disc properties    MEDIAPRO XML   Contains a list of material on the disc    Yes No No No No  basic properties  related information   and information about access  methods    SYSPRO XML Contains information about device Yes No No No No  System settings and menu settings    Other files Files other than the above     No     No                          a  Only when sub item NAMING FORM of setup menu item 036 is set to     free     b  Only files which can be written by XDCAM    Overview       suoneledo ei4 9 Jeydeu    107    suoneJedo aji4 9 1e1deu       Directories cannot be created in the root directory       The directories in the root directory  Clip  Edit  Sub   UserData  General  and PROAV  cannot be deleted or  renamed                    Clip directory  File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create   Delete  C  MXF 9 Clip file created by recording  MXF   Yes Yes D      Yes   Yes    Yes      file      0001 to 9999  C MO1 XML9    Metadata file generated automatically   Yes Yes f No9
279. nter 4 5 6  oj    off all   l    d F i   4       gt   Shift Z   X   C  V  B JIN JIM   lt  I   I  lf sni 4 1 l    3  4 all  amp   all all mi T  iG l     End V   PgDn T  Ctrl Alt SHAH SHA    Alt Ctrl 0     l 4   gt   Ins Del  When the area of use is set to    J    Notes      The keyboard is fixed as the Japanese keyboard   The keyboard ingas cannot be changed     e It is not possible to enter Japanese hiragana  katakana   and kanji       BIG S WAlla 8 Back Page   Num           EE rale alb alk ileal  log T obl  e   space  Insert  Homeliyp       Lock  pn le Ew Enter Page   7 8 9  ES ie Wy Ss  e   dla i  lt  Delete  End Upon   Home     PgUp  5    Caps Lock i S  D IIF F  K  L H     dy  EH 5 c L D 50 nj H E    4  TRTA 5 EE  PI CT Fer  SE  de                                                                                                                                                                                                             xipueddy    List of Supported USB Keyboards 1 87          xipueddy    188       Trademarks and Licenses       MPEG 4 visual patent portfolio  license    THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE MPEG 4  VISUAL PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE  PERSONAL AND NON COMMERCIAL USE OF A  CONSUMER FOR     i  ENCODING VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE  MPEG 4 VISUAL STANDARD   MPEG 4 VIDEO    AND OR    ii  DECODING MPEG 4 VIDEO THAT WAS  ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A  PERSONAL AND NON COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY  AND OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO  PROVIDER LICENSED BY M
280. nternet Explorer 8 1     1  This function may not work properly in 32 bit versions of Internet  Explorer if you are using a 64 bit version of Microsoft Windows  You  should use a 64 bit version of Internet Explorer with 64 bit versions of  Windows     To display the units XDCAM web pages    1 Connect this unit and a computer to a network  see  page 153      2 Start the browser on the computer  and enter    http            IP  address  of this unit           in the address bar of  the browser  and then press the Enter key     For example  if the IP address of this unit is     192 168 001 010     enter  http   192 168 1 10      If the connection succeeds  you will be prompted to  enter a user name and a password     Enter your user name and password  and then press the  Enter key     The user name and password are set to the following   when the unit is shipped from the factory      User name  admin   e Password  Model name     pdw f1600    or    pdw   hd1500      After the user name and password are verified  an  XDCAM web page appears     To display disc and clip properties    1    Insert a disc into this unit  and put this unit into the  following state     Recording  playback  search and other disc  operations  Stopped   THUMBNAIL button  Off   Disc access by Lock or Delete All Clips  Format  Disc  and so on in the Disc Menu  Stopped   FAM or FTP connection for file operations   Disconnected  or logged out   Connections between this unit and a computer by the  Live Logging 
281. nu item 723        651    UMID SDI OUTPUT    Select whether to output UMID in the VANC of the SDI output   off  Do not output   on  Output     See  Using UMID Data   page 176  for more information about UMID           652       UMID SD VANC LINE 9       Select the line in which UMID is output when menu item 651 is set to    on     12 H  12 line   13 H  13 line   15 H  15 line   16 H  16 line   17 H  17  line   18 H  18 line   19 H  19 line   59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode    9 H  9 line   10 H  10 line   12 H  12 line   13 H  13 line   14 H  14 line    15 H  15 line   16 H  16 line   17 H  17 line   18 H  18 line   50i 50P   25P mode     See  Using UMID Data   page 176  for more information about UMID           Setup Menu       snue wN z Je deuj    137          snus  4 Ja deup    138    Menu items in the 600s  relating to the timecode  metadata  and UMID                         Item number   Item name Settings  653 UMID HD VANC LINE Specify the HDSDI signal VANC line into which the UMID should be  inserted   9H to 17H to 20H  59 94i  50i  29 97P  25P  23 98P mode   9H to 17H to 25H  59 94P  50P mode   The output VANC line during playback follows the setting for recording   See  Using UMID Data   page 176  for more information about UMID   657 ESSENCE MARK SDI OUTPUT Select whether to output essence marks in the SDI output VANC   off  Do not output   on  Output   660 ESSENCE MARK SD VANC LINE 2    When menu item 657 is set to    on     select the line to which to output  essence ma
282. o 1023            P7 OTHER page                F3  RUN MODE    Selects the timecode run mode    FREE RUN  Timecode advances as long  as the unit is powered on  regardless  of the unit s operating state    REC RUN  Timecode advances only  during recording  When you select  this item  also set F1  TCG on this  page to  INT  and set F2  PRST   RGN to    PRESET           F4  DF NDF    Selects the drop frame mode for the  internal timecode generator and the  counter in 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode   DF  Drop frame mode   NDF  Non drop frame mode       F5  PDPSET    When the system frequency is set to   1080 59 94i  1080 29 97P  or 720    59 94P  presets the timecode of the A   frame of the pulldown sequence    24F TC  Reference timecode for A frame   30F TC  Timecode after pulldown  conversion from 24 frame timecode          F6  TCR       Selects the type of timecode to display in  the time data display area    TC  Display TC    VITC  Display VITC        Item Setting   F1  CONV IMP _   Selects whether to display convert status  on the display during convert operations   OFF  Do not display   ON  Display    F2  ERR LOG Displays an error log screen    F3  CLIP FLG Sets a clip flag for the clip being    recorded or played back using the  function button    If a clip flag is already set for the clip      Marked    is displayed in the function  menu item corresponding to one of the  F1 to F3 buttons depending on the type  of flag that has been set     A clip flag can also be set or delete
283. o replace it  Contact your Sony  service representative     Using the CD ROM Manual    Names and Functions of    Parts       Front Panel    The names and symbols of buttons and knobs on the front   panel are color coded according to function    White  Function when the button or knob is operated  independently        Chapter    Orange  Function when the button is operated with the  SHIFT button held down   Blue  Function related to thumbnail operations          On standby button and  indicator          Handle                                                        amp  EJECT      md Z5           Disc slot and EJECT  p      button                ACCESS indicator                              Audio level adjustment  section  see page 18                             Q Remote control switch               KEY INHI switch       PREV PLAY       NEXT               N       Arrow buttons  see  page 18                        es        Shuttle jog variable  control section  see                STOP REC       page 19        Hea                          gt      gt                               d                      PHONES jack       TOP F REV     U FFWD END OSTANDBY OREC INHI   2 SC MENU             Q LEVEL adjustment knob  5  Recording and playback control section  see page 22                               A       Display menu control  section  see page 20                 On standby  D  button and indicator   When the POWER switch on the rear panel is in the I  position  and when DC power is
284. ock Q S  x    5  t  R  v    8   I   J  Shit z m    English USA   sansnannszsnns    e                   Cancel         Use the proper keyboard for the area of use  Some  characters may not be entered correctly if you use a  keyboard designed for use in another area       t is not possible to enter Japanese  even on a Japanese  keyboard     USB keyboard special functions keys   In addition to the special function keys of the software  keyboard  you can use the following special function keys  on a USB keyboard        Key Function    t   When the cursor is in an edit box   Move the cursor to the start or  end    When    OK    or    Cancel    has the  focus  Moves the focus between       OK    and    Cancel           Delete Deletes the character after the cursor        Shift        Shift    Selects the string before or after the    cursor        Ctrl   C  X  V A  Z   Ctrl   C  Copies the selected string   Ctrl   X  Cuts the selected string    Ctrl   V  Pastes a copied or cut string   Ctrl   A  Selects the entire string   Ctrl   Z  Undoes the immediately    preceding operation        When the cursor is in an edit box   Moves the focus to OK    When OK or Cancel has the focus   Exits the software keyboard     Enter       When the cursor is in an edit box   moves the focus to Cancel     Esc       Moves the focus between OK and  Cancel     Tab                Thumbnail Operations    USB mouse functions   You can use the mouse to move the cursor on the software   keyboard  You can also
285. of this unit  select the  clip to copy  upload      6 Display the Thumbnail Menu     T Select Upload Clips via Direct FTP  and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob     With     selected  the Select Transfer Type screen of  the Upload Clips via Direct FTP command appears     8 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Transferring Clips  Direct FTP Function     The Select Remote Host screen appears     Select    Hosts Discovered via UPnP     and then press  the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     The detected connection destination device  the PDW   HD1500  appears in the Select Host Discovered via  UPnP screen      10 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Detailed information about the connection destination  device  the PDW HD1500  appears     11 With    Connect    selected  press the PUSH    SET S SEL  knob     Transfer of the clip begins as soon as the connection is  established    During transfer of the clip     NETWORK     appears in  the display of the connection destination device  the  PDW HD1500      When transfer of the clip completes  an Uploading  Result Report appears on the screen    Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to return to the clip  thumbnail screen     12 check the copied clip in the clip thumbnail screen of    the connection destination device  the PDW   HD1500         Shortcut List    You can access many functions from the buttons  without Dm    displaying a menu  shortcut operations      Shortcuts are available for the following functions  The  plus sign     indicates that o
286. olor Bars   ARIB color bar signal  modify width  10096       ARIB CB cannot be specified when SD recording is selected  If ARIB CB  is selected  the selection is changed to CB75  75  Color Bars            Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    139    Menu items in the 700s  relating to video control       Item number  713    Item name    VIDEO SETUP REFERENCE P       Sub item    Settings    Set the video setup amount to be added to the composite output signal  in  59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode only         OUTPUT  LEVEL    In 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P mode  UC     Add the setup level selected by this item to the output signal   0 0   7 5        In 59 94i 59 94P   29 97P mode  J        Add the setup level selected by this item to the output signal   0 0   7 5        715    VIDEO GAIN CONTROL    Adjust the video output level      2048 to 0 to 848       716    CHROMA GAIN CONTROL    Adjust the chroma output level      2048 to 0 to 848       717    CHROMA PHASE CONTROL    Adjust the chroma phase      128 to 0 to 127       718    SETUP LEVEL  59 94i 59 94P   29 97P 23 98P mode  BLACK    LEVEL  50i 50P 25P mode  P    Adjust the setup level  black level       272 to 0 to 272       719    SYSTEM PHASE SYNC    Adjust the output signal sync phase      128 to 0 to 127       720    SYSTEM PHASE SC    Adjust the output signal subcarrier phase   0 to 511       723          INPUT VIDEO BLANK 9       Sub Item    Switch blanking on or off for lines in the vertical blanking interval of input  video si
287. on     FAM connection  Write clip files to the unit from the computer or other  device that is connected to this unit     FTP connection   Use the    STOR    command to transfer clip files from the  computer that is connected to this unit    If you issue the    SITE UMMD  command immediately  before the    STOR    command  the original timecode of the  transferred file is recorded  regardless of the setting of  TCG on page P5 TC of the function menu     Menus       Menu System  Configuration    The settings for this unit use the following menus     Setup menu  The setup menu system of this unit comprises the basic  setup menu and extended setup menu     Maintenance menu   This provides audio control  and network and setup menu  settings  and also shows version information    For details  see  Maintenance Menu   page 146      Function menu    For details  see  Basic Operations of the Function Menu    page 48      Disc Menu    For details  see  Disc Operations   page 94         Chapter       Setup Menu    The setup menu system of this unit comprises the basic  setup menu and extended setup menu     Basic menu   This menu is used to make settings relating  forexample    to the following      the digital hours meter     the preroll time     thetext information superimposed on the video output  to the monitor     the menu banks for retaining menu settings    Extended menu  This menu is used to make a wide range of settings  relating to the functions of this unit  for example  the 
288. on  and repeat    steps 2 to 4     If you power this unit off during an FTP connection     the data transferred thus far is discarded     To log out    To log out after finishing file operations  enter    QUIT    at    the command prompt and press the Enter key        Command list    The FTP protocol commands supported by this unit  include standard commands  see the next section  and  extended commands  see page 120      software such as PDZ 1 on your computer     An FTP client that supports UTF 8 is required to use  Unicode characters other than ASCII characters   Command prompt FTP commands do not support  UTF 8     To execute FTP commands  you must install application    The commands supported by application software vary     2 Start the command prompt     3 Enter  ftp   SP     IP address gt      and press the Enter  key    lt SP gt  refers to a space      For example  if the IP address of this unit is set to     192 168 001 010     enter    ftp 192 168 1 10      Refer to the Windows help for more information about  the FTP command     If the connection succeeds  you are prompted to enter  a user name     4 Enter the user name    admin    and press the Enter key     When the user name is verified  you are prompted to  enter a password     D Enter the password and press the Enter key     The password is set to the model name     pdw f1600     or    pdw hd1500     when the unit is shipped from the   factory    The login is complete when the password is verified     See page
289. on to scroll the display  by one character for each press    The   MARKI and V MARK2 buttons scroll the  beginning and end of the string into view     To return to the previous screen  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To edit disc information    You can edit the user disc ID  title   and title2 by using a  software keyboard     1  Only ASCII characters can be used for the titlel     See  To edit clip information   page 82  for more  information about operations     Disc Operations          Using planning metadata    Planning metadata is a file that contains metadata about the  clips to be shot and recorded    To use planning metadata  you will need to save a file in  advance in the specified location of a media  and insert the  media into this unit     See  Setting clip names by using planning metadata    page 155  for details     To load planning metadata files    See page 75 for more information about GUI screen  operations     1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Load Planning Metadata Select Drive  and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A media selection screen appears     Disc Menu    fim Load Planning Metadata Select Drive  Return to Upper Menu    4 D Professional Disc       ye USB Flash Drive  gt        3 Select the media where your planning metadata file is  stored  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A list of the planning metadata files stored on the  media appears     Disc Menu  fm Load Planning Metadata  22 Professional Disc    PM  002 sample 04 AU
290. onization is made          a  Same as when V INPUT on page P1 VIDEO of the function menu is set to     SG       b  FAM and FTP connections always synchronize to the internal  synchronization reference signal  regardless of the setting of OUT REF     Synchronization reference signals when  you are recording  playing  or editing 720P  signals    When you are recording  playing  or editing 720P signals    set OUT REF on page P6 REF of the function menu item   to    REF     and synchronize the internal reference signal   generator of this unit to a reference signal input to the REF    VIDEO INPUT connector  The following reference   signals may be used    720 59 94P system  1080 59 94i tri level sync signal  525  black burst signal   720 50P system  1080 50 tri level sync signal  625 black  burst signal    When you connect this unit directly to the video I O  connectors of the PDW F1600 HD1500 F800 700  you  can record and dub 720P signals even if you set OUT REF  on page P6 REF of the function menu item to    INPUT        Synchronization Reference Signals       Setting System  Frequency    This unit can record and play back video at the system  frequencies of 59 94i  50i  29 97P  25P  and 23 98P P   1080  or 59 94P and 50P  720                 HD1500   When the PDBK F1500 option is installed              Selecting the system frequency    1 Set setup menu item 013 SYSTEM FREQUENCY  SELECT MENU to    on    and press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The system frequency selection scre
291. onnectors                   Q DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  IN  digital audio  input  1 2  3 4 connectors  BNC type    These input AES EBU format digital audio signals  The   left connector  1 2  corresponds to audio channels 1 and 2    and the right connector  3 4  corresponds to audio   channels 3 and 4        DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  OUT  digital audio  output  1 2  3 4 connectors  BNC type   These output AES EBU format digital audio signals   When the unit is shipped from the factory  the 1 2  connector is set to audio channel 1 2  and the 3 4 connector  is set to audio channel 3 4  You can change these settings  with setup menu item 827 AES EBU AUDIO OUTPUT  SELECT  see page 142      To treat the input and output signals of these connectors as  non audio signals  set the maintenance menu item M37   AUDIO CONFIG  gt M372  NON AUDIO INPUT   recording   see page 148  and setup menu item 823 NON   AUDIO FLAG PB  playback       4  Timecode input output section         TIME CODE IN connector     TIME CODE OUT    connector  p OUT  e        TIME CODE IN connector  BNC type   This inputs an SMPTE timecode generated by an external  device                 TIME CODE OUT connector  BNC type    This outputs the following timecode  depending on the  operating state of this unit    During playback  Playback timecode    During recording  The timecode from the internal  timecode generator or the timecode input to the TIME  CODE IN connector   When setup menu item 611 TC OUTPUT PHASE IN EE   MODE
292. ontrol switch  NET  see page 18        Setup menu item 257 NETWORK ENABLE  net             Using the  amp  i LINK  S400 connector  FAM  connection     The following shows an example of a FAM  file access  mode  connection     The PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software must be installed in  advance    The required FAM driver is also installed when you install  the PDZ 1 software     See  Using PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software   page 175   for more information about installing the PDZ 1 software     Some limitations apply to FAM connections  For details   see  File Operations in File Access Mode  for Windows     page 113            PDW F1600 or PDW   HD1500  this unit                                                                               lit          ddiliao Laptop computer  zos O       doc 8 9o  88859     o 2E0000        To   8400 connector                      i LINK cable  not supplied     Use of a shielded cable is recommended        Connections for cut editing    The following figure shows a cut editing system  comprising this unit as a player     When making the connections  also refer to the manuals  provided with the equipment to be connected     See page 39 for more information about editing control  unit settings     When using an editing control unit  Using BVE 700 700A    The following figure shows a cut editing system  comprising this unit as a player  an HDW M2000 M2000P  unit as a recorder  and a BVE 700 700A as an editing  control unit     Connections and Settings   
293. or display  see page 21         Clip thumbnail screen    Clip C0006  T  g F F E      maw Ae COS   ICoo250025  TC00234007  TCO0244511  F Ei         exa 7  TC 00 25 49 23 TC 00 27 19 04 TC 00 27  09     2    x 1 is   WOR  09 89 09  85 m        dm js  23   JOG ey pArE amp TIME 30 NOV 2005 13 38 bur 0 00 10 23  THUMBNAIL THUMBNAIL     Na n  o C  e Uniit o E yc Lit  SUB CLIP SUB CLIP  e    Sle unii 60        e Unit  DISC MENU DISC MENU       TC 00 25 06 14       006 040    Lo  M EH             Clip list thumbnail screen P    Clip List E0001    nw pw    UTR TC 00 00 04 14       v    TC 00 00 12 04    TC00 00 28 08 TC 00 00 35 15 TC 00 00 46 08 Tl    ENUN          TC 00 00 59 16 TC 00 01 06 18 TC 00 01 13 11 TC        THUMBNAIL         Mo  Li  o    p X Lit   SUB CLIP i   NZ Li  OSE ut   DISC MENU       TC 00 00 20 13      rar BH  i    t1         C 00 00 53 22     DTI N  UT O S EST I TOTAL DUR AO OKOL SS     M             b  The clip list playback screen appears when a clip list is loaded into the unit s memory  see page 92      The other thumbnail screens are     Expand thumbnail screen     Chapter thumbnail screen     Essence mark thumbnail screen       Information and controls in  thumbnail screens    About the display of clip and clip list  names  You can specify that titles should appear instead of names    in the clip name areas of thumbnail screens  You can also  change the display language     To specify that titles  if they exist     SU9BINS  MD ul suonejedo  s Ja deyo    sh
294. ormat recording mode     Features    Continuous playback may not be possible at the transition  point between two clips with different recording formats     Linear editing  Using this unit as the recorder  you can perform insert and  assemble editing of recorded clips                      IHD1500   When the PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key is installed   you can perform timecode editing only        SD upconvert function   The unit can output HD signals while playing discs  recorded as SD  allowing SD material to be utilized in an  HD environment  P              n        IHD1500   When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed     HD downconvert function   The unit is provided with a downconvert function  HD disc  playback signals can be downconverted to SD signals and  then output as SDSDI or composite signals  This allows  you to use SD nonlinear editors and monitors for editing  and program output     1080 720 cross conversion   This unit supports cross conversion output  It can output  720 while playing discs recorded as 1080  and output 1080  while playing discs recorded as 720     HDSDI remote recording   HDSDI connections can be made to camcorders with  remote HDSDI support  PDW 700 XDCAM HD422  camcorder  HDW 730 7308 750 790 F900R HDCAM D  camcorders  to enable recording synchronized to REC and  STOP operations on the camcorder     1  HDCAM is a trademark of Sony Corporation     Clip Continuous Rec function   Normally  a clip is generated as an independent file 
295. ot display the item in the setup menu     6 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To continue selecting items  Repeat steps 3 to 6     To set items more quickly   In step 3  turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to move  the         mark  and then press the ON function button   F1  or OFF function button  F2  to set items  continuously     7 Press the SAVE function button  F5      Customization indication in the setup menu  When you open the setup menu after customizing the  displayed menu item  a   C   mark appears at the upper  right of the screen to indicate that the menu has been  customized        Items in the extended menu    The following tables show the items in the extended menu    The values in the Settings columns are the values which     tem names are the names which appear on an external appear in the time data display area   The values may    monitor to which the output of the COMPOSITE    appear in a different format on an external monitor  In    OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2 this case  the external monitor values are shown in   SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector is input      An abbreviated name appears in the time data display  area when you press the NEXT button     parentheses   Underlined values are the factory defaults     Menu items in the 100s  relating to the control panels       Item number  101    Select how the unit enters the shuttle  jog  or variable speed mode     Item name    SELECTION FOR SEARCH DIAL  ENABLE    Set
296. ot stop operating  but if you continue to  STOPPED use it in this state temperatures inside the unit or the    drive will rise  possibly resulting in failure or fire   High TEMP  HIGH TEMPERATURE   HIGH TEMPERATURE IN DRIVE   HIGH TEMPERATURE ON NET 4 BOARD   HUMID  MOISTURE HAS BEEN DETECTED  Stop recording or playback  power the unit off and on  again  and wait until the HUMID display disappears   BATT EMPTY  BATTERY EMPTY  Change the battery        Unknown USB          UNKNOWN USB DEVICE        The USB connector of this unit is for maintenance  purposes and connection of USB devices  Connect a  compatible USB device        Alarms related to system frequency and recording format    The following alarms are displayed only when setup menu  item 016 ALARM DISPLAY is set to    on    or    limit           Alarm message in time  data display area                            Alarm message in video monitor screen    Action                                                             1080 59 94i RECORDING AND PLAYBACK IS NOT This appears when the system frequency of the unit  1080 29 97P POSSIBLE  differs from that of the loaded disc  Insert a disc with    SYSTEM SETTINGS DIFFERENT FROM   the same system frequency as the unit  or change the  1080 50i DISC  unit s system frequency   1080 25P  1080 23 98P  720 59 94P  720 50P  525 59 94i  625 50i  1080 59 94i DISC CANNOT BE RECORDED  This appears when mixed format recording mode is  1080 50i VIDEO RESOLUTION DIFFER FROMIT   disabled and
297. oth sides of the  front panel and pull out as indicated by the arrow        You can fix the angle of the front panel in position 1  15  degrees  or position 2  40 degrees         Return position  Position 2  40 degrees   C       Position 1  15 degrees     e             Position 0                The angle cannot be fixed if you pull the front panel past  position 2 all the way out to the return position  To fix the  front panel  return it to position 0 and then pull it out to  position 1 or position 2     To return the front panel to its original  position   Unlock the front panel by pulling it out to the return  position  You can then return it to position 0     To change the angle of the front panel    To change the angle to position 2 from position 1  pull the  front panel out to position 2    To change the angle to position 1 from position 2  first  unlock the front panel by pulling it all the way out to the  return position  Then return it to position 0  and pull out  again to position 1     Front Panel Tilt Mechanism       suonejedejgd e Jajdeyp    35          suonejedejg e Jajdeyo    36       Connections and  Settings    Production of some of the peripherals and related devices  described in this chapter has been discontinued    For advice about choosing devices  please contact your  Sony dealer or a Sony sales representative        Connections for using PDZ 1 Proxy  Browsing Software    You can use the PDZ 1 Proxy Browsing Software on the  supplied XDCAM Application So
298. ould be displayed    with higher priority than names  select one of the following  under Settings  gt Display Title in the Disc Menu   On  Title1  title1   Display in the order title1  title2  clip    or clip list name     On  Title2  title2   Display in the order title2  titlel  clip    or clip list name     To change the display language according to the area of  use  see page 33   select the desired language under  Settings  gt Select Font in the Disc Menu        Select Font  setting    Area of use  setting    Displayable  languages       J  for Japan            English Japanese       69    Overview          SueeiJoS IND ul suoneiedo  S 1e1deuo    70                Area of use Select Font Displayable  setting setting languages  UC  for regions   European English European  outside Japan    Alphabet languages  Korean English Korean  Simplified English Simplified  Chinese Chinese  Traditional English Traditional  Chinese Chinese                   Clip thumbnail screen    This screen displays thumbnails of clips on the disc in the  order that they were recorded  You can use this screen to  work with clips     deleting or locking them  selecting their  index pictures  adding them to clip lists  and so on     DUR 00 25 06 14   S    DUR 00 27 51  09    es     DUR 00 23 54 22       Q Clip name  Displays the name or a title of the selected clip  see  page 69         Selection frame   Indicates that the thumbnail is selected  To select another  thumbnail  move the frame  see page 75
299. ows you to decide the range to use and add  that range as a sub clip while viewing the video in the clip  playback screen  It does not use GUI screens  You can do  this during recording  playback  including pauses   and  searches     1 Find the point that you want to make the start point of  the sub clip  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob with the   IN button held down     An In point is set and the IN indicator lights     2 Find the point that you want to make the end point of  the sub clip  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob with the   OUT button held down     An Out point is set and the OUT indicator lights   This  determines the range of the sub clip to be added      To check the timecode of the In point or Out point  Press the   IN button or the    OUT button     To cue up the In point or Out point  Press the PREV button or the NEXT button with the     IN button or    OUT button held down     To check the duration  time from In point to Out    point   Press the   IN and    OUT buttons at the same time     Scene Selection  Clip List Editing        SueeJoS  MDH ui suonejedo  c Jeydeuj    89          SU99J9S IMD ui suonejedQ  s Jaydeyo    90    To delete the In point or Out point  Press the RESET RETURN button with the   IN or     OUT button held down     3 With the SHIFT button held down  press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A sub clip with the range specified in steps 1 and 2 is  added to the end of the clip list     When you specify a range that spans several
300. p  menu item 150 REC MODE is set to    disc exchange  cache    or    clip continuous rec     see page 133      See page 56 for more information about the disc  exchange cache function     See page 57 for more information about the Clip  Continuous Rec function     Q Disc information          Disc loaded indication usable       format    59 941    B  System frequency  Lotes     Video format    50MbPs     8CH 24BIT Jj ABIT   B  Audio format                Disc loaded indication usable format  When a disc is  loaded in this unit  a disc loaded indication appears   When no disc is loaded  the usable formats are  displayed     The background color of the disc loaded mark  indicates one of the following disc states    Blue  Disc capable of recording and playback   Yellow  Disc capable of playback only    Red  Disc incapable of recording and playback     Even if the background is blue  recording is not   possible in the following cases      When a disc with recording inhibited is loaded      When REC INH on the HOME page of the function  menu is set to    ON        The usable formats displayed when no disc is loaded  in this unit are as follows        Usable format    HD422  HD422  HD420  HD420HQ HD420SP HD420LP 9    Display    HD 422  HD 420                a  HD420LP supports playback only     When the PDBK S1500 option is installed       Usable format    HD422  HD422  HD420  HD420HQ HD420SP HD420LP 9    Display    ITI IMX  MPEG IMX 50Mbps 40Mbps   30Mbps  DVCAM  DVCAM             
301. p lists    The following procedure clears the current clip list from  the unit s internal memory     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the Disc  Menu     2 Select Clear Clip List  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A message appears asking you to confirm that you  want to clear the clip list     3 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     The current clip list returns to the unnamed state        no name       To delete clip lists    The following procedure deletes a clip list from the disc     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the Disc  Menu     2 Select Delete Clip List  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob        A list of clip lists appears        Select the clip list that you want to delete  and then  press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A message appears asking you to confirm the deletion     Delete Clip List  E0001    Delete this Clip List  OK      Cancel      4 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     To sort clip lists    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the Disc  Menu     2 Select Settings  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob        Select Sort Clip List by     and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     4 Select one of the following sort methods  and then  press the PUSH SET S 
302. p name or clip list  name           Planning Clip Name in Clip  Info  Area    Selects whether to display in the video monitor screen the title  contained in a planning metadata file that is loaded into this unit   Off  Do not display title    ASCII Clip Name  Display title in ASCII format    Clip Name  Display title in UTF 8 format        Setting Format Disc    Selects whether to disable the Format Disc command   Disable  Disable the command   Enable  Enable the command        Select Font    Selects the language  font  used to display clip names  clip list  names  and title2 clip titles        Select USB Keyboard  Language    Selects a language of the USB keyboard used on the software  keyboard           Select Mouse Pointer  Speed       Selects the speed of the USB mouse pointer used on the software  keyboard from the following values   5 Fast 4 3 Middle 2 1 Slow       To display the Disc Menu    To display the Disc Menu  press the SUB CLIP DISC    To return to the original screen  press the RESET   RETURN button     MENU button with the SHIFT button held down in one of    the following screens     Clip thumbnail screen      Clip list thumbnail screen      Clip playback screen      Clip list playback screen    Overview                                           0000    OO                                      Tr       X2  5  i tJe      SHIFT button    SUB CLIP DISC MENU button     RESET RETURN button                 Clip list thumbnail screen    Clip List E0001     lt    el   
303. packs  refer to the  operation manual for the battery charger     Notes about battery usage     Before using the batteries  be sure to charge them fully  with the special battery charger  Refer to the operating  instructions for your battery charger for more  information about how to charge the batteries   Batteries may not be completely charged if you charge  them immediately after use when they are still warm   You should wait until the batteries cool before charging  them        Attaching a battery pack    Attaching and removing of the BP GL95 Battery Pack is  described below    The BP L80S can also be attached and removed in the  same way     For details on attaching the BKP L551  refer to the  installation manual for the BKP L551       Attach the BKP L551 to the side panel               BKP L551    2 Align the grooves on the BP GL95 with the  projections on the BKP L551             BP GL95    3 Slide the BP GL95 as shown below so that the  connectors on the BP GL95 and the BKP L551 are  connected     4 Connect the DC cable of the BKP L551 to the DC IN  12V connector     Removing the battery pack    With the lever pushed in  slide the BP GL95 out as shown  below        Checking the remaining battery power  You can use the LEDs on the side panel of the battery to  check the remaining power of the battery        Initial Setup    This unit is shipped with the area of use  system frequency   recording format  and current date and time still unset   Therefore  you need to make
304. page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip list thumbnail screen  select a thumbnail   2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Trim Sub Clip  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The Clip List  Trim  screen appears   Clip List  Trim  001 034    Total 00 13 48 24  pur 00 00 21 27    IN  01 17 33 08      OUT  01 17 55 05  TCR 01 17 33 08 cup 019 035 OK    Cancel       Like the clip playback screen  this screen allows you to  play and search all clips on the disc     To display a list of In and Out point operations that  you can perform  Press the MENU button     4 When you find the point that you want to make the  start point  select    IN    and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The timecode of the new In point appears in the  timecode display  and the Total  total duration  and  DUR  clip duration  displays are updated     D When you find the point that you want to make the end  point  select    OUT    and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The timecode of the new Out point appears in the  timecode display  and the Total  total duration  and  DUR  clip duration  displays are updated     To cue up the In point or Out point   Display the Thumbnail Menu  select Cue up Inpoint or  Cue up Outpoint  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob    To cancel the In point or Out point setting   Display the Thumbnail Menu  select Reset Inpoint or    Reset Outpoint  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     The In point or Out
305. per Menu  Returns to the Thumbnail  Menu    The selected information will appear at the bottom of  the thumbnails when you display a thumbnail screen        Changing clip index pictures    The clip thumbnail screen displays thumbnails as index  pictures for clips  Normally the index picture is the first  frame in a clip  but you can set any frame in the clip as the  index picture     You can only change index pictures from the clip  thumbnail screen  The thumbnails shown in the clip list  thumbnail screen  the expand thumbnail screen  and the  chapter thumbnail screen cannot be changed     To select a clip index picture while viewing the  video    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnail of  the clip whose index picture you want to change     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu     3 Select Select Index Picture     Select Index screen appears     018 036    Select Index  Navigating sibling relati             TCR 01 09 16 13 OK       You can play and search with this screen     4 Select a frame with the PLAY button or the jog dial     5 Select OK  and then press the PUSH SET S SEL     knob     Thumbnail Operations    81       SU9BINS  MD ul suoneiado s Ja deyD          SueeiJog IND ul suonejedo  6 1e1deuo    82    To select index pictures by using the expand and  chapter functions   After using the expand function  see page 77  or chapter  function  see page 77  to find a frame  you can set that  fram
306. pliance Connector Plug  please consult a qualified service  personnel     CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  LASER KLASSE 1 PRODUKT          LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE  KLASS 1 LASERAPPARAT          This Professional Disc Recorder is classified as a CLASS 1  LASER PRODUCT     Laser diode properties  Wave length  400 to 410 nm  Emission duration  Continuous  Laser output power  135 mW  max  of pulse peak   65 mW   max  of CW   Standard  IEC60825 1  2001     Egenskaber for laserdiode  Balgelaengde  400 til 410 nm  Str  lingsvarighed  Kontinuerlig  Afgivet lasereffekt  135 mW  maks str  letoppunkt   65 mW   maks ved kontinuerlig str  ling   Standard  IEC60825 1  2001     Tekniska data f  r laserdiod  Vaglangd  400 till 410 nm  Emissionslangd  Kontinuerlig  Laseruteffekt  135 mW  max  f  r pulstopp   65 mW  max  f  r  kontinuerlig vag   Standard  IEC60825 1  2001     Egenskaper for laserdiode  B  lgelengde  400 til 410 nm  Str  lingsvarighet  Uavbrutt  Utgangseffekt for laser  135 mW  maks av pulsheyde   65  mW  maks av CW   Standard  IEC60825 1  2001        CAUTION  For U S A        CAUTION  ATTENTION  VORSICHT  ADVARSEL  ADVARSEL    VARNING  VARO   For EUROPE                   This label is located on the top panel of the drive unit   Denna etikett finns pa ovansidan av driftenheten   Denne m  rkat sidder pa drevenhedens   verste panel   Tama kyltti sijaitsee ajurilaitteen ylapinnalla     Dette merket er plassert pa oversiden av driverenheten     CAUTION  The use of optical instruments with this 
307. product will increase  eye hazard     CAUTION   Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures  other than those specified herein may result in hazardous  radiation exposure     WARNING   Excessive sound pressure from earphones and headphones  can cause hearing loss    In order to use this product safely  avoid prolonged listening at  excessive sound pressure levels     VAROITUS    LAITTEEN KAYTTAMINEN MUULLA KUIN TASSA  KAYTTOOHJEESSA MAINITULLA TAVALLA SAATTAA  ALTISTAA KAYTTAJAN TURVALLISUUSLUOKAN 1  YLITTAVALLE NAKYMATTOMALLE LASERSATEILYLLE     VARNING   OM APPARATEN ANVANDS PA ANNAT SATT AN   DENNA  BRUKSANVISNING SPECIFICERATS  KAN ANVANDAREN  UTSATTAS FOR OSYNLIG LASERSTRALNING  SOM  OVERSKRIDER GRANSEN FOR LASERKLASS 1     When installing  the installation space must be secured in   consideration of the ventilation and service operation      Do not block the ventilation slots at the left side  right side  and bottom of front side panels  and vents of the fans      Leave more than 25 cm of space in the rear of the unit      Leave more than 2 cm of space in the left side  right side and  top of the unit     WARNING  Batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as  sunshine  fire or the like     For the customers in the USA   This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the  limits for a Class A digital device  pursuant to Part 15 of the  FCC Rules  These limits are designed to provide reasonable  protection against harmful interference 
308. pter when a chapter has not been  recorded for that clip        Some Essence Mark cannot  be Deleted     The essence mark cannot be deleted   This appears when an attempt is made to delete an essence mark that cannot be deleted with a  Delete Essence Mark operation  Rec Start and Cut essence marks cannot be deleted        Some Essence Mark cannot  be Moved     The essence mark cannot be moved   This appears when an attempt is made to move an essence mark that cannot be moved with a  Move Essence Mark operation  Rec Start and Cut essence marks cannot be moved        Clip is Locked     The clip is locked   This appears when an attempt is made to delete a clip  set the clip thumbnail  or delete a shot  mark when the clip is locked        All Clips are Locked     All clips are locked   This appears when an attempt is made to execute a Lock All Clips operation when all clips are  already locked        All Clips are Unlocked     All clips are unlocked   This appears when an attempt is made to execute an Unlock All Clips operation when all clips  are already unlocked        Command Disabled           This appears when an attempt is made to perform Format Disc operation while Setting Format  Disc is set to  Disable         Troubleshooting             Alarm message in GUI  screen    Description action       A File with the Name you  Specified Already Exists   Specify a Different Name     This appears when an attempt is made to set an existing clip name while changing the clip name  us
309. pue seweN zsaideyo    23          Sued Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jeideuo    24     9 Input signal display  Displays the audio input signal                                         Display Input signal   ANA 1 Analog audio Channel 1  3   ANA 2 signal Channel 2  4   MIC 1 Input signal from   Channel 1  3   7 the microphone   MIC 2 connected ip Channel 2  4  ANALOG  AUDIO INPUT  connector   AES EBU AES EBU format digital audio signal   flashes when there is no input signal    HD SDI HDSDI audio signal  flashes when  there is no input signal    SD SDI SDSDI audio signal  flashes when  there is no input signal    SG Test signal from the internal signal  generator   No indication   Undefined audio signal  or no audio  input                Data indication  Appears when the input signals are  non audio signals        F1600   Mixing  Displays the input channels used for  audio mixing   These channels are selected with setup  menu item 819 AUDIO INPUT ARRANGE      D  Monitor channel  Displays the audio monitoring  channels set with MONITR L and MONITR R on  page P2 AUDIO of the function menu  see page 49      E  Audio channel  Displays the audio channels    Also indicates preset or variable mode by its color   see page 18     White  Preset mode   Green  Variable mode      Reference level  Displays the reference level for  recording as set in the maintenance menu       Level bars  Display the audio recording or playback  levels of channels 1 to 8  The OVER indicators light  when the audio 
310. r  different system frequencies     1080 59 94i 29 97P    1080 50i 25P    1080 23 98P  e 720 59 94P  e 720 50P  Therefore  when you switch system frequencies  all menu items are reset to  the current settings for the new mode   They are different from the setting for  the previous mode    016 ALARM DISPLAY Select whether to display alarm messages     off  Do not display alarm messages   However  certain important alarms are  displayed     limit  on  limited    Display only a minimum number of alarm messages    on  Display all alarm messages     For details about alarm message display conditions  see    Alarms      page 161         017    SUB STATUS DISPLAY SELECT    Determine the kind of sub status information to be output from the  COMPOSITE OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector  the SDSDI OUTPUT 2   SUPER  connector  or the HDSDI OUTPUT 2  SUPER  connector   off  Do not output sub status information   rmain  disc remain   Available disc space  unit  minute   clip  clip no   Order of playback of the selected clip total number of clips  pbr  playback remain   The remaining playback time of the selected clip  from the current playback position  hours minutes seconds frames    name  clip name title   The name of the clip that is currently being recorded  or played  as set in Settings    Display Title of the Disc Menu  standard  name  user defined name  title  or planning metadata name   The following characters can be displayed as clip names in this area     Digits  0 to 9  e Alphabetic c
311. r details  see  Handling of discs when recording does  not end normally  salvage functions    page 56      To adjust the audio recording levels    When carrying out audio recording at a reference  level   Set the VARIABLE switch to PRESET    The audio signals will be recorded at a preset reference  level    You can change the reference level and the input levels  with maintenance menu item M37  AUDIO CONFIG     See page 152 for more information about how to make  maintenance menu settings     Manually adjusting the audio recording levels  Set the VARIABLE switch to REC and adjust the CH 1   ALL CH and CH 2 to CH 4 knobs so that the audio level  indications on the audio level meters do not exceed 0 dB  for a maximum volume  Carry out the adjustment in E E  mode     See setup menu item 108 AUTO EE SELECT  page 131   for more information about the signal output settings in E   E mode     To set shot marks    A Shot Mark1 essence mark or Shot Mark2 essence mark  is set if you hold down the   MARK1 or    MARK2  button and press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob during  recording  If you connect a Windows USB keyboard to the    Recording       xXoeg e g pue Duipiooeu v 1e deu    55          yoeghe q pue BuipiooeH v 1e1deuo    56    MAINTENANCE connector  you can record shot marks  from Shot Mark0 up to Shot Mark9 by pressing the 0 to 9  keys on the numeric keypad    If the unit is set up to display superimposed text  information  see page 45      SHOTMARK         0 to 9   appears every time
312. re     Lower surface of the disc Write Inhibit tab          Slide in the direction of the arrow  Write Inhibit tab settings  SAVE  gt  SAVE  gt     Recording enabled Recording disabled    You can also write protect individual clips  For details  see     Locking  write protecting  clips     page 85         Loading and unloading a disc    When the on standby button and indicator are lit green   you can load and unload a disc as shown in the following  figure     On standby button and indicator  PN m To unload    Press the EJECT button        To load  Insert a disc face up   The disc is drawn in     When the EJECT button is pressed during recording   recording stops and the disc is ejected  If you do not want  to eject the disc and stop recording when the EJECT button  is pressed during recording  set setup menu item 145    Formatting a disc  Unused discs are formatted automatically when they are  loaded into this unit     To format a recorded disc  use the GUI screen     For details  see  Formatting discs   page 96      Handling Discs       suoneiedejgd e Jaydeyp    53          yoeghe q pue BuipiooeH p 1e1deuo    54    Recording and Playback Chapter       Recording    This section describes video and audio recording on the  unit     See page 48    Basic Operations of the Function Menu    in  Chapter 3 for more information     See page 123  Menus  in Chapter 7 for more information  about setup menu operations        Mixed recording of clips in different  formats on the same disc
313. red by applying to the  SMPTE registration office  When no organization code  has been acquired  it is forbidden to enter an arbitrary       xipueddy    177          xipueddy    178       Ancillary Data    This unit can play and record ancillary data multiplexed  into HDSDI signals  It can also input and output ancillary  data in MXF files when transferring files via FAM or FTP  connections  Transferable auxiliary data includes text data   captions and metadata  and control signals        Ancillary data in HDSDI SDSDI  signals    This unit can record and play back closed captions  conforming to the ELA 708 B D standard and EIA 608   B standard  and text data conforming to the ARIB  TRB23   which comprise the VANC  Vertical ancillary  data  packets     1  EIA  Electronic Industries Alliance  2  ARIB  Association of Radio Industries and Businesses    To record ancillary data    In maintenance menu item M3B  VANC RX  PARAMETER  set the lines where ancillary data is  inserted  the DID  Data Identifier word   and the SDID   Secondary Data Identifier word   see page 150      To record and playback EIA 708 B standard  closed caption data in HDSDI signals  Set the following items   e Sub items of maintenance menu item M3B0  VANC RX  PACKET    LINE  line for the VANC to be received   9LINE   example     DID  data identification word   61h    SDID  secondary data identification word   01h    To record EIA 608 B standard closed caption  data in HDSDI signals  Set the following items    
314. red for editing     Item Setting    With the maintenance menu item M39   OTHER CONFIG   M393  AUDIO DSP   select    linear edit        Audio digital signal  processor       Video input signal   Select the video input signal with V  INPUT on page P1 VIDEO of the    function menu        Audio input signal   Select the audio input signal with A1  INPUT and A2 INPUT on page P2  AUDIO  and A3 INPUT to A8 INPUT  on page P3 AUDIO of the function    menu        Input audio level Adjust the input audio level with the  CH 1 ALL CH and CH 2 to CH 4    knobs        Edit point transition   With setup menu item 317 AUDIO                         See page 152 for more information about maintenance  menu operations     See page 48 for more information about function menu  operations     See page 126 for more information about setup menu  operations     To edit clips created by application  software on devices other than XDCAM  devices    You can use application software on devices other than  XDCAM devices to create clips  and then copy them to  this unit as files  To edit such clips  set maintenance menu  item M39  OTHER CONFIG  gt M394  HD L EDIT to     Extra  extra mode         Clips edited in extra mode cannot be edited on XDCAM  devices with software versions earlier than 1 51  or on  this unit when this unit is set to standard mode       f you want to use extra mode  select extra mode on  every PDW F1600 HD1500 that you connect to the  editing system     Linear Editing    61       type 
315. rements 175  PHONES jack 18  Planning metadata 94  155  PLAY button 22  Playback 63  clip list 87  jog mode 65  normal speed 64  settings 63  shot mark settings 65  shuttle mode 66  start position 64  variable speed mode 66  Playback condition  display 47  mark 46  Power supply section 29  POWER switch 29  Preparation  Initial Setup 33  PREV button 22  Professional Disc 52  Proxy AV data 12  Proxy Browsing Software 175  Pulldown playback 63  PUSH SET S SEL  knob 20    R    Rear Panel 28  REC button 22  REC INHI indicator 22    Index       xepu     195       xepu    196    Recording 54   format 24   HDSDI remote control function   57   level adjustment 55   salvage 58   settings 54   shot mark settings 55   time 32 94  Recording and playback control   section  22  REF VIDEO INPUT connectors 29  Reference signal 26  REMOTE connector 28  Remote control switch 18  REMOTE 9P  connector 28  Repeat playback 132  RESET RETURN button 21  Returning to factory default settings  130    S    Salvage function 58  Scene   finding 77  78  Scene Selection 87  Scrollbar 70  SD HDSDI INPUT connector 28  SDSDI OUTPUT 1  2  SUPER    connectors 29   Select Essence Mark screen 78  Select Index screen  81  Set Start Time Code screen 91  Setup menu   basic menu 124   extended menu 131  SHIFT button 21  Shortcut 105  SHTL JOG button 19    Shuttle  dial 20  mode 66    Shuttle jog variable control section 19  Skip Scroll 76  Specifications 172  STANDBY indicator 22  STOP button 22  SUB CLIP  button 21  
316. required for output of E A 608  standard closed caption data by down convert playback     For details  see    To record and playback EIA 708 B  standard closed caption data in HDSDI signals      page 176      HDSDI  VANC  output  EIA 708    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output    Internal processing by this unit    EE output after EIA 608    708 conversion   In response to closed caption input data that complies with  the EIA 608 standard  output that data to EE after  conversion to EIA 708 format    However  settings are required for EE output of EIA 708  standard closed caption data     For details  see    To record EIA 608 B standard closed    caption data in SDSDI line 21 signals after conversion to  the EIA 708 B standard   page 176      Ancillary Data    EIA 608 HDSDI  VANC  EE output     708  conversion    EIA 708    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  input    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output       Internal processing by this unit    Up convert playback of SD discs containing closed caption data   When you up convert and play SD clips  ELA 608 For details  see  To record EIA 608 B standard closed  compliant closed caption data in the clips is converted to caption data in SDSDI line 21 signals after conversion to  EIA 708 format  and then played and output according to the EIA 708 B standard   page 176     the EIA 708 standard    However  settings are required for output of EIA 708   standard closed caption data by up convert play
317. rks   12 H  12 line   13 H  13 line   15 H  15 line   16 H  16 line   17 H  17  line   18 H  18 line   19 H  19 line   59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode   9 H  9 line   10 H  10 line   12 H  12 line   13 H  13 line   14 H  14 line    15 H  15 line   16 H  16 line   17 H  17 line   18 H  18 line   50i 50P   25P mode   665 ESSENCE MARK HD VANC LINE   When item 657 is set to  on   select the line to which to output essence  marks   9H to 17H to 20H  59 94i  50i  29 97P  25P  23 98P mode   9H to 17H to 25H  59 94P  50P mode   The output VANC line during playback follows the setting for recording   666 METADATA ITEM OUT Specify whether to include the information from recorded VANC packets  in data items in the DATA ITEM section of MXF files   off  Do not include VANC packet information in data items   on  Include VANC packet information in data items   668 USER META DATA OUTPUT IN Select whether to output user metadata to MXF files   MXF off  Do not output   on  Output   669 ESSENCE MARK RECORD MODE   Specify when essence marks can be recorded during connections to a             switcher   normal  Always allow essence marks to be recorded   rec  Allow essence marks to be recorded only during recording        3  Not displayed when the unit is in 23 98P mode   b   HD1500   When the PDBZ UPGO2 Software Upgrade Key is installed   c   HD1500  When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed                       Setup Menu       Menu items in the 700s  relating to video control       Item
318. rted by this unit   POSSIBLE   ILL  Index  INDEX FILE ERROR  Format the disc  or eject it  see page 96    PLEASE FORMAT DISC OR EJECT   Formatting  AUTO FORMATTING IS EXECUTING  Wait until the format has been completed and try  again   FORMAT NG  AUTO FORMATTING WAS NOT Eject the disc and insert it again  or insert another  COMPLETED  disc   DI read err CANNOT READ DISC INFORMATION   Read err PLEASE EJECT DISC   DPV ADJ err CANNOT PERFORM AUTO DRIVE          ADJUSTMENT           During front panel operations       Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen    Description action                   KEY INHI   9 KEY INHIBIT MODE IS SELECTED  This appears when the KEY INHI switch is  on    SET KEY INHIBIT SWITCH TO OFF  Set the KEY INHI switch to  off     REMOTE  9 REMOTE MODE IS SELECTED  Set the remote control switch to  LOCAL    SET REMOTE LOCAL NETWORK  SWITCH TO LOCAL    No Disc  9 NO DISC  Insert a disc and try again        Troubleshooting             Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen       Description action                                                          REC INHI   AUTO FORMATTING WAS NOT Set the disc s Write Inhibit tab to enable recording  COMPLETED   see page 53    THE DISC WRITE PROTECT TAB IS SET  TO SAVE   PLEASE EJECT DISC   THE DISC WRITE PROTECT TAB IS SET  TO SAVE   AUTO FORMATTING WAS NOT This appears when REC INH on the HOME page of  COMPLETED  the function menu is s
319. rved     Redistribution and use in source and binary forms  with or   without modification  are permitted provided that the   following conditions are met      Redistributions of source code must retain the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer     Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above  copyright notice  this list of conditions and the following  disclaimer in the documentation and or other materials  provided with the distribution    Neither name of Intel Corporation nor the names of its  contributors may be used to endorse or promote products  derived from this software without specific prior written  permission     THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE  COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS  AS  IS  AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  WARRANTIES  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED  TO  THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED  IN NO  EVENT SHALL INTEL OR CONTRIBUTORS BE  LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT  INDIRECT   INCIDENTAL  SPECIAL  EXEMPLARY  OR  CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  INCLUDING  BUT  NOT LIMITED TO  PROCUREMENT OF  SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES  LOSS OF USE   DATA  OR PROFITS  OR BUSINESS  INTERRUPTION  HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY  WHETHER IN  CONTRACT  STRICT LIABILITY  OR TORT   INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE   ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS  SOFTWARE  EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE     Trademarks and Licenses       xipueddy    191      
320. s          Using the editing functions of the  recorder  controlling through  REMOTE 9P  connector     The following figure shows a cut editing system  comprising this unit as a player  and an HDW M2000   M2000P unit as a recorder  In this example  video and  audio signals are connected by HDSDI  and control signals  are transferred via the REMOTE 9P  connector     HD video monitor    To HDSDI input connector                             PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500  i  unit  player                    a   REF VIDEO   Il  9  gt  Reference   U    i U  ES    AD    video signal                               HDW M2000     recorder  REF VIDEO    HDSDI  INPUT       INPUT                                                                                                                                                  To HDSDI  input  connector                                  HD video monitor        759 coaxial cable  not supplied         _   _      9 pin remote control cable  not supplied      D                          HDW M2000  recorder  Settings on this unit    setting  REMOTE 1  9P  button  Remote control switch   Unlit REMOTE  see page 18        Setup menu item 214  REMOTE INTERFACE  9PIN                For details of HDW M2000 M2000P settings  refer to the  HDW M2000 M2000P Operation Manual        Connections for pool coverage    The following figure shows an example of connections for  pool coverage  with the PDW 700 Professional Disc  Camcorder connected           PDW F1600 or PDW  
321. s  on Professional Discs as PC data via the i LINK or  FTP interface    This allows Professional Discs to be used as data recording  media  with a data storage capacity of 46 4 GB  when dual   layer PFD50DLA discs are used         Carrying out recording    One recording segment  from the start to the end of  recording  is called a    clip        See  Clips   page 87  for more information about clips                                                                                         7 w OF  o  OQ OZ  2930 0 5             1 Insert a disc     2 Hold down the REC button  and press the PLAY  button     Recording starts     3 To stop recording  press the STOP button     If the disc becomes full  Recording stops and the message    ALARM DISC END      appears on the monitor     The shortest clip that can be recorded is 2 seconds long   Even if recording start and stop operations are performed  within 2 seconds  a 2 second clip is recorded    The maximum number of clips that can be recorded is  300  If the loaded disc already contains 300 clips   recording operation is not possible   The message     MAX   Clips  appears in the time data display area    This unit can record video input signals that are not  synchronized to a reference signal  However  in that  case  video breakup and audio noise may occur in E E  playback    During recording  do not turn off the POWER switch on  the rear panel or disconnect the power cord  This could  cause the clip being recorded to be lost     Fo
322. s are proxy  AN data streaming and metadata editing        n Live View mode  the run mode is always Free Run  regardless of the  setting of RUN MODE on page P5 TC of the function menu  It is not  possible to preset the timecode to be recorded      The Disc Exchange Cache function and Clip Continuous Rec function  cannot be enabled in Live View mode      FAM or FTP connections cannot be established during a Live View  mode connection  Live view mode connections cannot be established  during a FAM or FTP connection           a   HD1500  When the PDBK S1500 or PDBK F1500 option is installed  connections  the device connected to the REMOTE 9P  connector cannot  b  When the PDBK 201 option board is installed  c  FTP connections can be made only when the device connected to the   REMOTE 9P  connector  D sub 9 pin  is in stop mode  During FTP             be used to control this unit     Menu items in the 300s  relating to editing operations       Item number  301    Item name    VAR SPEED RANGE FOR  SYNCHRONIZATION    Settings    Select the playback speed range when carrying out playback in variable  speed mode from a remote control unit connected to the REMOTE 9P   connector       2 42     2 to 42 times normal speed    wide     2 20 to  2 20 times normal speed                                                        EDIT POINT       311 F1600 Select methods for setting the edit presets of the digital audio channels  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET CH1 to CH4 of this unit  Make these setting
323. s being ejected during disc exchange   No SEL List P CLIP LIST IS NOT SELECTED  This appears when you press the SUB CLIP     DISC MENU button while the clip list on the disc is  not loaded into the current clip list   Load the clip list  see page 88  and try again        SB CLP mode P    TO ADD AN ESSENCE MARK  EXIT  FROM SUB CLIP MODE FIRST     This appears when an attempt is made to manipulate  the essence mark while the SUB CLIP DISC MENU  indicator is lit or to set a clip flag while the clip list is  being played back  SUB CLIP indicator is lit   Perform  the operation after pressing the SUB CLIP DISC  MENU button to turn it off              SUB CLIP NG P SUB CLIP IS INVALID  Set the In and Out points again   SET APPROPRIATE IN OUT POINTS   No List  D NO CLIP LIST  This appears when you try to delete a clip list when          there is no clip list saved on the disc   Load the disc that contains the clip list you want to  delete        Troubleshooting          Alarm message in time  data display area    Alarm message in video monitor screen    Description action             Loading List  LOADING CLIP LIST  This appears if the SUB CLIP DISC MENU button is  pressed while a clip list is loading  Wait for the clip list  to finish loading and try again    STOP ONCE  D STOP ONCE  THEN EXECUTE  This appears when the SUB CLIP DISC MENU  button is pressed while the clip list is being played  back or when an attempt is made to open the GUI  screen with setup menu item 151 GUI OPERAT
324. s disable   Disable        153    FIND MODE    Specify the frame to be cued up when the PREV or NEXT button is   pressed    clip  The first frame of the clip   R ST  clip  amp  rec start mark   The frame where a Rec Start essence  mark is set  if no essence mark is set  the first frame of the clip    SHOTMARK1  Shot Mark1          154          SINGLE CLIP PLAY MODE       Put the unit into single clip playback mode  or exit from single clip   playback mode    off  Exits from single clip playback mode   Puts the unit into continuous  playback mode     on  Puts the unit into single clip playback mode           a  The disc is ejected after recording stops     b  The unit enters stop mode when the PLAY button is pressed  It enters  freeze picture mode  jog  shuttle  or variable mode  when the SHTL JOG  button or VAR JOG button is pressed     Menu items in the 200s  relating to the remote control interface       Item number  201    Item name  PARA RUN    Settings    Select whether to use synchronized operation for two or more VTRs   dis  disable   No synchronized operationena  ena  enable   Use synchronized operation    To use synchronized operation for two or more VTRs  set item 201 to ena  on all of the VTRs        212    VIDEO REMOTE CONTROL  SELECT 9    Select whether to control the up converter or down converter when  controlling the image enhancer from the HKDV 900 or another unit  connected to the VIDEO CONTROL connector    down  Control the down converter    up  Control the
325. s for clips that  have clip flags set     To clear clip flags  Carry out steps 1 to 3  selecting a clip that has a flag set   and then select    none    in step 4     You can also use CLIP FLG on page P7 OTHER of the  function menu to set and clear clip flags  see page 51         Locking  write protecting  clips    In a clip thumbnail screen  you can lock the selected clips  so that they cannot be deleted or altered    Locking prevents the following operations on clips      Deletion     Changing the index picture     Adding and deleting shot marks   e Setting and clearing clip flags      Locked clips are deleted along with other clips when a  disc is formatted      Clips cannot be locked or unlocked when the write  inhibit tab of the disc is set to the recording disabled  position  or when REC INH in the HOME page of the  function menu is set to ON     To lock clips    See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 In the clip thumbnail screen  select the thumbnails of  the clips that you want to lock     2 Display the Thumbnail Menu   3 Select Lock Unlock Clip     4 Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     A lock icon  see page 71  appears on the thumbnail of  the locked clips     In step 1  you can also perform a shortcut operation by  pressing the STOP button with the SHIFT button held  down     To lock all clips    1 Display the Disc Menu     2 Select Lock or Delete All Clips  and then select Lock  AII Clips     A message appears asking you to confirm
326. s screen  Press the RESET RETURN button     To move from a menu level to the next  lower or higher menu level    For a menu item displayed together with  lt  or  gt   you can  move to the next lower or higher menu level by pressing  the   IN or   OUT button     Overview       SU88J0S  MD ul suoneiado s Ja deyD    75          SueeiJog IND ul suoneiedo  S 1e1deuo    76    To scroll hidden parts of the string into  view   When a  lt  or  gt  mark is displayed for an item  you can  press the   IN or   OUT button to scroll the display by  one character for each press    The 4 MARK1 and V MARK2 buttons scroll the  beginning and end of the string into view     To increment and decrement numbers    Do one of the following    e Press the   MARK1 or V MARK2 button     Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob      Turn the jog dial     To confirm selections  Press the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     Thumbnail Operations       Thumbnail Operations    You can use thumbnail screens to display clip information  and to find  protect  and delete clips  The thumbnails  provide visual confirmation of these and other operations        Selecting thumbnails    The thumbnail selection frame  see page 70  indicates the  currently selected thumbnail     To move the thumbnail selection frame  Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob     To skip quickly through thumbnails  Skip  Scroll function   When you have a large number of thumbnails  like in    expand thumbnail screen  you can use the Skip Scroll  function to skip through th
327. s that begin with          e  F  Append        to directory names     The following data is transferred  depending on whether   lt path name gt  specifies a directory or file      Directory specified  A list of the files in the specified   directory     File specified  Information about the specified file     No specification  A list of the files in the current directory  The wildcard characters          any string  and          any  character  may be used in  lt path name gt     Input example 1  LIST a Clip    Input example 2  LIST Clip   MXF    NLST  Sends a list of file names from this unit to the remote  computer  with no other information   Command syntax  NLST   SP     options or path name gt    lt CRLF gt     The following options may be specified when no path   name is specified    a  Also display file names that begin with              I  Display information other than file name  gives the same  result as the LIST command       F  Append         to directory names     The following data is transferred  depending on whether   lt path name gt  specifies a directory or file     Directory specified  A list of the file names only in the  specified directory      No specification  A list of the file names only in the current  directory     The wildcard characters          any string  and          any  character  may be used in  lt path name gt      Input example 1  NLST I  Input example 2  NLST Clip   MXF    RETR    Begins transfer of a copy of a file in the specified path
328. s when the index picture has  been changed to any frame other than the first frame of a  clip  see page 81      When you cue up a clip  the unit always cues up the first  frame  even when the index picture has been changed to a  different frame        S mark   This mark appears when shot marks or other essence  marks have been set in the clip  see page 55     The chapter thumbnail screen can be displayed for clips  that show this mark  see page 71         Clip flag icon  Displays the corresponding icon when a clip flag  OK NG   KP  KEEP   is set in the clip        Clip and frame information  Displays the clip or frame information selected with the  Clip Information item in the Thumbnail Menu  see    page 81   The factory default selection is the timecode of  the first frame or the timecode of the thumbnail frame     Q Lock icon   This icon appears when the clip is locked  protected   see  page  5   Clips cannot be deleted and their clip  information cannot be changed when this mark is  displayed     Clip list thumbnail screen    This screen displays thumbnails of the clips in the current  clip list  You can use this screen to create and edit clips  lists        lt        gt  m    TC 00 00 12 04 TC 00 00 20 13    TC 00 00 28 08 TC 00 00 35 15 TC 00 00 46 08    TC 00 00 53 22    ad woes  TC 00 01 13 11    TC 00 00 59 16 TC 00 01 06 18 TC 00 01 17 27       Q Clip list name  Displays the name or a title of the clip list  see page 69         Selection frame    See the description 
329. s when using an editor  PVE   REPLACE FOR CH1 500  BVE 600  etc   or remote control unit without a function to control   Fi600  digital audio edit presets   oie E1800 The edit presets of the digital audio channels of this unit are turned on  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET   E      and off according to the specified analog audio presets of the editor or  REPLACE FOR CH2 i  remote control unit   313 F1600 nodef  no definition   No definition  ANALOG AUDIO EDIT PRESET ch 1  analog ch1   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 1   REPLACE FOR CH3 ch 2  analog ch2   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 2   314  F1600  chi    analog ch1 ch2   Follow the edit preset of analog channel 1 or  E eon PRESET  The default settings for each item are as follows   311  ch 1  analog ch1  312  ch 2  analog ch2  313  nodef  no definition   314  nodef  no definition   317  F1600  Select the type of audio transition used for linear editing   AUDIO EDIT MODE cut edit  Cut editing  audio discontinuity at transition point  and possible  noise during playback    cross fade  Cross fade  IN OUT   lt   Nome  320 DIGITAL AUDIO PB PROCESS ON   Specify the handling of audio at edit points and at the second and    subsequent recording start points in Clip Continuous Rec recording    cut  Carry out a cut  possibly resulting in audio discontinuities at the edit  point     fade  Fade out and fade in        Setup Menu          Menu items in the 300s  relating to editing operations                                 
330. sabled  Enable mixed  DISC  format recording mode  or insert another disc   Mixed REC  P DISC CANNOT BE EDITED  This appears when an edit preset command is  MIXED AUDIO VIDEO MODE ON DISC  received  but the inserted disc contains clips with  mixed recording formats   Exchange the inserted disc for a disc that does not  contain clips with mixed recording formats   Resolution THIS CLIP CANNOT BE ADDED  Clips can be registered in clip lists only if their  THE CLIP S RESOLUTION DOES NOT resolution  number of system lines  matches the  MATCH THE CLIP LIST S RESOLUTION    resolution of clips in the clip list   LLINK  D CANNOT EDIT AV MATERIAL WHEN This appears when an edit preset command is  INPUT SIGNAL IS VIA i LINK  received  but  i LINK  is selected as the input signal   Under V INPUT on the P1 VIDEO page of the  function menu  select a signal other than  i LINK    SD Input  b  CANNOT EDIT AV MATERIAL WHEN This appears when an edit preset command is  INPUT SIGNAL IS VIA SD SDI  received  but the recording format is set to HD422  and    SDSDI    is selected as the video input signal   Under V INPUT on the P1 VIDEO page of the  function menu  select    HDSDI      NON AUDIO  D AUDIO INSERT EDITING WITH This appears when digital audio signals are set to  INDEPENDENT CHANNELS IS NOT  data  and an edit preset command is received for  POSSIBLE  individual channels in the audio input channel pairs  CHANGE  NON AUDIO INPUT    IN  CH1 2  CH3 4  CH5 6  CH7 8   To perform insert  MAINTENAN
331. sal  time  is used when recording the UMID  Use of a  universal time system enables uniform management of  source material recorded all over the world   Calculation of date differences  Source material is  recorded using modified Julian dates  MJD   which  enables easy calculation of date differences between  different source material items     Setting UMID ownership information    Proceed as follows     1 Set setup menu item 029 STORE OWNER to    on      see page 127      See page 128 for more information about setup menu  operations     The STORED OWNERSHIP  UMID ownership  information setting  screen appears     ITEM 029  STORED OUNERSHIP    ATION       COUNTRY  Sets the country code   ORGANIZATION  Sets the organization code   USER  Sets the user code    See the next item    About the UMID ownership    information    for more information about these codes     2 Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob to select the item to  set and the character input location  then press the  knob     3 Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob      or   function  button  F3 or F4  to select characters to input at the    selected location     To delete all input data  Press the RESET RETURN button     4 Press SAVE function button  F5      The message    NOW SAVING       appears  and the  ownership information is saved     About the UMID ownership information  COUNTRY  country code     Set the country code by entering an abbreviated  alphanumeric string  4 byte alphanumeric string   according to the values define
332. sc  Menu  see page 74      2 Select Save Clip List  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The clip list is saved  However  Save Clip List as    is  executed when the name displayed in the clip list  thumbnail screen is    no name      If you press the EJECT button or the on standby button  before saving a new or edited clip list  a message appears  asking if you want to discard your changes and continue   Follow the instructions in the message to continue or  cancel the operation        Managing clip lists    To load clip lists    The following procedure loads a clip list stored on the disc  into the unit s internal memory as the current clip list     See page 75 for more information about thumbnail screen  operations     1 Inthe clip list thumbnail screen  display the Disc  Menu     2 Select Load Clip List  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     A list of clip lists stored on the disc appears     Disc Menu  lip List   03 AUG2007 17 51  03 AUG2007 17 51  03 AUG2007 17 51  03 AUG2007 17 51  03 AUG2007 17 51  18 MAY2006 10 25    13 JUN2006 13 43  Display Select       e  amp  D  te Sorted by Name    3 Select the desired clip list  and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob     The name of the clip list selected here appears in the  clip list thumbnail screen  When you execute the Save  Clip List command in the Disc Menu  the clip list will  be saved under that name     To create a new clip list  Select New File and then press the PUSH SET S SEL   knob     To clear cli
333. se version  1   CD ROM manual  1   Installation manual  1   XDCAM Application Software CD ROM  1   Connector caps    Accessories not supplied  AC power cord    Specifications    For the customers in the U S A and Canada   Part number 1 551 812 41  125 V  10 A  about 2 4 m   For the customers in the United Kingdom   Part number 1 777 823 12  250 V  10 A  about 2 0 m   For the customers in European countries other than the  United Kingdom   Part number 1 551 631 61  250 V  10 A  about 2 0 m     RCC G5 9 pin Remote Control Cable  RM 280 Remote Edit Controller  PFD23A Professional Disc   PFD50DLA Dual layer Professional Disc  BP L80S Battery Pack   BP GL95 Battery Pack   BKP L551 Battery Adaptor   PDBK 201 MPEG TS Board  PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key          HD1500  PDBK S1500 SD Record And Playback Key  PDBK F1500 24P Record And Playback Key          Design and specifications are subject to change without  notice        Notes     Always make a test recording  and verify that it was  recorded successfully  SONY WILL NOT BE  LIABLE FOR DAMAGES OF ANY KIND  INCLUDING  BUT NOT LIMITED TO   COMPENSATION OR REIMBURSEMENT ON  ACCOUNT OF FAILURE OF THIS UNIT OR ITS  RECORDING MEDIA  EXTERNAL STORAGE  SYSTEMS OR ANY OTHER MEDIA OR  STORAGE SYSTEMS TO RECORD CONTENT  OF ANY TYPE    Always verify that the unit is operating properly  before use  SONY WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR  DAMAGES OF ANY KIND INCLUDING  BUT  NOT LIMITED TO  COMPENSATION OR  REIMBURSEMENT ON ACCOUNT OF THE  LOSS OF PRESE
334. seconds depending on the state of  a disc     Recording and playback operations by all buttons and  dials other than the STOP button are disabled during  cache recording    If the amount of cache data exceeds the capacity of the  unit s internal memory during a disc exchange  an alarm  message appears and the data in cache memory is  overwritten  The internal memory always contains the  latest cache data  so the clip data will be continuous after  the next disc is inserted and recording to the disc  resumes    If you insert a disc that cannot be recorded  it is ejected  automatically  Insert a disc that can be recorded       The Disc Exchange Cache function cannot be enabled  when the Live Logging function is set to Live View  mode        Recording with the HDSDI remote  control function    This section explains the settings required for recording in  HDSDI remote control mode  and how the unit operates in  this mode     The unit  camcorder  that controls this unit must also  support HDSDI remote output     Settings    Set setup menu item 214 REMOTE INTERFACE to     SDI     and set the remote control switch on the front panel  to    REMOTE       This unit enters HDSDI remote control mode  in which it  is controlled by command packets received via the SD   HDSDI INPUT connector     The following limitations apply in HDSDI remote control   mode      Commands received via the REMOTE 9P  connector  are ignored      Recording and playback operations on the front panel  are disable
335. see page 74    Stopped   Unsaved current clip list  Save or clear  Connections between this unit and a computer by the  Live Logging function  Disconnected   Setting of setup menu item 258 LIVE LOGGING   Values other than    live view mode    off  or    live  mode      2 If this unit is connected to a remote computer by FTP   log out from the FTP session  see page 117      3 Connect the  amp   i LINK  S400connector on this unit to  the i LINK  IEEE1394  connector on the remote  computer  using an i LINK cable  see connections  illustration on page 36      Windows recognizes this unit as aremovable disc  and  displays one of the following icons on the remote  computer   s task bar       Windows XP  ae    Windows Vista or Windows 7     The remote computer is now able to perform file  operations when a disc is inserted into this unit     You will not be able to log in if you put the unit into  the state described in step 1 after connecting the cable   To log in  disconnect the cable  put the unit into the  state described in step 1  and connect it again     When you make your first FAM connection   The Found New Hardware Wizard dialog appears when  you connect this unit to your computer  Select  Install the  software automatically  Recommended    and then click  the Next button  Click the Finish button when the software  installation finishes     Operation limitations during FAM connections     Front panel operations are disabled  except for  operations with the EJECT button    
336. sert editing  and at the IN point of  assemble editing  By selecting    CUT    in the essence mark  selection screen  you can search the result of editing     For details of searching using essence marks  see page 76        Playback    This section describes playback of video and audio on the  unit     Before starting playback  make the following settings and   adjustments    Selection of time data to display  Select with CNTR SEL  on HOME page of the function menu    Selection of audio channels to monitor  Select with  MONITR L and MONITR R on page P2 AUDIO of  the function menu    Volume adjustment of the monitor audio  Adjust with  the LEVEL knob    Remote local setting  Set the remote control switch  If  you set it to REMOTE  also set setup menu item 214  REMOTE INTERFACE   RM   and the connector  used appear on the display   see page 133      Clip playback modes    You can set the clip playback mode to either of the   following    Continuous playback mode  The playback target is all of  the clips on the disc  factory default setting    Single clip playback mode  The playback target is the  currently selected clip only    xoeg e g pue Buipiooeu v Jeydeyo    To select single clip playback mode  Set setup menu item 154 SINGLE CLIP PLAY MODE to    ee        on    Playback in single clip playback mode   Playback stops when it reaches the start or end of the clip   The next and preceding clips are not played  even if they  exist on the disc  The available playback types includ
337. setting  D    Shuttle mode    1  Maximum speed is about  50 times normal speed  However  the  maximum speed may vary depending on the state of the clip and the  playback position on the disc     Video performance  Sampling frequency  Y  74 25 MHz  R Y B Y  37 125 MHz    8 bits sample  MPEG 2 422P HL    Quantization  Compression    Composite output  Frequency response  0 5 to 5 75 MHz40 5  2 0 dB  S N  Y  53 dB or more  Y C delay  20 ns or less  K factor  K2T  1 0  or less    Processor adjustment range    Video level    eo to  3 dB  Chroma level     to  3 dB  Set up black level   30 IRE  210 mV  Chroma phase  30    System phase SYNC   15 us  SC  0 to  400 ns    Audio performance    Sampling frequency    48 kHz  Quantization 24 bits  Headroom    20  18    16    12 dB  selectable     Frequency response  20 Hz to 20 kHz  0 5  1 0 dB  0 dB at  1 kHz   Dynamic range 90 dB or more  Distortion 0 0546 or less  at 1 kHz     Input connectors    Digital video inputs  SD HDSDI INPUT  BNC type  x1   complying with SMPTE   259M  SD  SMPTE 292M  HD    amp  LINK  S400  6 pin type  x1   complying with IEEE  1394    Analog video inputs  REF VIDEO INPUT  BNC type  x2  loop through   HD Tri   level sync  0 6 Vp p 75 Q sync  negative   SD black burst  or SD  composite sync  0 286 Vp p 75 Q   sync negative     Analog audio inputs  ANALOG AUDIO INPUT 1  2  XLR 3 pin  female  x2    4 dBu  high  impedance  balanced    Digital audio inputs  DIGITAL AUDIO  AES EBU  IN 1 2  3 4  BNC type  x2   1 2ch  3 4
338. sible    c  Only when sub item NAMING FORM of setup menu item 036 is set to   free     d  Only files which can be written by XDCAM   e  When the    E     part of an    E 01 SMI    file name is changed  an  E MOI XML file with the same name in the    E     part is also changed  automatically     Sub directory    f  When an E E01 SMI file is created  an E MOI XML file with the same  name in the  E   part is also generated automatically    g  When an E E01 SMI file is deleted  an E MOI XML file with the same  name in the  E   part is also deleted automatically     Directories cannot be created in the Edit directory                                               File name Content Operations  Read Partial read   Write Partial write   Rename   Create   Delete  C S01 MXF 9 Proxy AV data  MXF  file generated   Yes No No   No9  No 4  automatically when a C  MXF file is  created      0001 to 9999  Other files Files other than the above z No     No      a  The    C     part can be changed to a user defined name   b  When the    C     part of a C  MXF file name is changed  a C S01 MXF file   Note    with the same name in the    C     part is generated automatically    i   x  c  When a C  MXF file is created  a C S01 XML file with the same name in Directories cannot be created in the Sub directory   the    C     part is generated automatically   d  When a C  MXF file is deleted  the C SOI XML file with the same name  in the    C     part is also deleted automatically   UserData directory  
339. signal input  D   y  output section  see eie Se S   page 30  Za A T 2     Me   WOOK CT OUTPUT  ke    3  Digital audio signal input  J    ea m    PEDES    8          HDSDI OUTPUT 1 2   SUPER  connectors       COMPOSITE OUTPUT1  2   SUPER  connectors      REF VIDEO INPUT  connectors                       saco     VIDEO CONTROL                   e    B i LINK  S400 connector                      4  Timecode input output  section  see page 30                                        VIDEO CONTROL connector     REMOTE 9P  connector          SIE  et SES               E             QD  network  connector      MAINTENANCE connectors     p SDSDI OUTPUT1  2   SUPER  connectors              i LINK  S400 connector  6 pin  IEEE1394  compliant    Connect a computer or other device  using an i LINK   cable    When the PDBK 201 option board is installed  i  LINK TS    HDV  signals can be input and output via this connector     When this unit is connected to a device with a 6 pin  i LINK connector by an i LINK cable  before  unplugging the i LINK cable  first power off the device  and disconnect the power plug from the outlet  If the  i LINK cable is unplugged with the device power plug  still connected  a current from an excessive voltage  8 to  40 V  output from the i LINK connector of the device  flows into this unit  This may cause a failure of the unit   When connecting this unit to a device with a 6 pin  i LINK connector  connect to the 6 pin i LINK  connector of the other device first   
340. sing setup menu items 002  003  005   009  011  and 012     For details  see  Items in the basic menu   page 124      Information displayed    suonejedejgd e je deu           Type of time data      Timecode reader drop frame mark   for 59 94i 59 94P 29 97P mode only        Timecode generator drop  frame mark  for 59 94i   59 94P 29 97P mode only     Time data    VITC field mark                                                       9 Playback condition  mark Disc  exchange cache    Operation mode mame             The display shown above corresponds to the factory  default settings of the unit  You can change the type of  information to be displayed in the lower line of the display  by changing the setting of setup menu item 005 DISPLAY  INFORMATION SELECT     For details  see    Items in the basic menu     page 124      Superimposed Text Information 45       Q Type of time data                                                                            suonejedejg e Ja deyo    46                            Display Operation mode   Display Meaning BlockA  BlockB   CNT Counter data C STANDBY OFF Standby off mode 9   TCR TC reader timecode STOP Stop mode   UBR TC reader user bits data C STOP Stop mode 2    zem VITO reader timecode NEXT xxx Cuing up to the first frame of the  UBR  VITC reader user bits data next clip    TCG TC generator timecode PREV xxx Cuing up to the first frame of the  UBG TC generator user bits data current clip    IN In point time data FFWD Fast forward searc
341. splayed      This setting is valid only for channels where  mic  is selected with  setup menu item 834 AUDIO INPUT LEVEL  Regardless of this  setting  the limiter is  off  for channels where  line  is selected                       a   HD1500  When the PDBZ UPGO2 Software Upgrade Key is installed  b  When the PDBK 201 option board is installed    Menu items in the 900s  relating to digital process       Item number  920       Item name  SD SDI H ANC CONTROL       Sub item    Settings  Select whether to add information to the SDI output        1    AUDIO 5CH 8CH    off  Do not add digital audio data channels 5 to 8   on  Add digital audio data channels 5 to 8              RP188 ATC       off  Do not add RP188 timecode data   on  Add RP188 timecode data           Setup Menu       snue wN Z Je deuj    143    Menu items in the 900s  relating to digital process       Item number  923    Item name    AUTO SQUEEZE 9    Settings    Select whether to use auto squeeze mode   off  Do not use   on  Use        930    DOWN CONVERTER MODE  DC     Select the down converter mode   crop  Select the edge crop mode   I box  Select the letter box mode   squez  Select the squeeze mode        931    DOWN CONVERTER LETTER BOX  MODE  DC     Select the aspect ratio of the down converter output when menu item  930 is set to  I box     16 9  Set the aspect ratio of the HD SD converter output to 16 9   14 9  Set the aspect ratio of the HD SD converter output to 14 9   13 9  Set the aspect ratio of the HD
342. start playback  press this button  turning it on    When pressed during recording  stops recording and enters  stop mode  If you do not want to stop recording when this  button is pressed  set setup menu item 145 MODE KEY  ENABLE DURING RECORDING to    stop           NEXT button   Press this button  turning it on  to jump to the next clip  and   show the first frame  This button is also used together   with other buttons for the following operations    Forward direction high speed search  Hold down the  PLAY button  and press this button  A high speed  search in the forward direction is carried out    Displaying the last frame of the last clip  Hold down the  SHIFT button  and press this button     1  When setup menu item 153 FIND MODE is set to    clip  amp  rec start mark    this button jumps to the frame where the next Rec Start essence mark is set  and displays the video of that frame        STOP button   To stop recording or playback  press this button  turning it  on  The frame at the stop point appears    The unit enters standby off mode when you press this  button with the SHIFT button held down  It returns from  standby off mode to the original state when you press this    Front Panel    button again with the SHIFT button held down   The lit or  unlit status of the STOP button does not change      This button flashes when setup menu item 105  REFERENCE SYSTEM ALARM is set to    on    and the  correct reference video input signal  as specified by OUT  REF on page P6 R
343. t dem Stromnetz verbunden     CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  LASER KLASSE 1 PRODUKT  LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE  KLASS 1 LASERAPPARAT                Dieser Professional Disc Recorder ist als CLASS 1 LASER  PRODUCT eingestuft     Daten der Laserdiode  Wellenl  nge  400 bis 410 nm  Emissionsdauer  Ununterbrochen  Laser Ausgangsleistung  135 mW  max  Impulsspitze    65 mW  max  Dauerstrich   Standard  IEC60825 1  2001        CAUTION  For U S A        CAUTION  ATTENTION  VORSICHT  ADVARSEL    ADVARSEL  VARNING  VARO    For EUROPE       eem                Dieser Aufkleber befindet sich oben auf der Antriebseinheit     WARNUNG   Zu hoher Schalldruck von Ohrh  rern und Kopfh  rern kann  Geh  rsch  den verursachen    Um dieses Produkt sicher zu verwenden  vermeiden Sie  l  ngeres H  ren bei sehr hohen Schalldruckpegeln     F  r Kunden in Europa   Dieses Produkt besitzt die CE Kennzeichnung und erf  llt die   EMV Richtlinie der EG Kommission    Angewandte Normen    e EN55103 1  Elektromagnetische Vertr  glichkeit   St  raussendung    e EN55103 2  Elektromagnetische Vertr  glichkeit   St  rfestigkeit    F  r die folgenden elektromagnetischen Umgebungen  E1    Wohnbereich   E2  kommerzieller und in beschr  nktem   MaBe industrieller Bereich   E3  Stadtbereich im Freien  und   E4  kontrollierter EMV Bereich  z B  Fernsehstudio      WARNUNG   1  Verwenden Sie ein gepr  ftes Netzkabel  3 adriges  Stromkabel  einen gepr  ften Ger  teanschluss einen  gepr  ften Stecker mit Schutzkontakten entsprechend den 
344. t point is set when you press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob with the   IN or   OUT button held  down  The In or Out point setting is deleted when you  press the RESET RETURN button with the   IN or      OUT button held down      3  Shuttle jog variable control section         SHTL JOG button     VAR JOG button       Jog shuttle transport indicators  SHTL JOG  e   ee      Z    Jog dial                Shuttle dial             For details of playback operations with these buttons and  dials  see    Playback operation    on page 64        SHTL JOG button   Press this button  turning it on  to perform shuttle playback  with the shuttle dial or jog playback with the jog dial   When pressed during recording  stops recording and  selects shuttle jog mode  If you do not want to stop  recording when this button is pressed  set setup menu item  145 MODE KEY ENABLE DURING RECORDING to     stop           VAR JOG button   Press this button  turning it on  to perform variable  playback with the shuttle dial or jog playback with the jog  dial    When pressed during recording  stops recording and  selects variable jog mode  If you do not want to stop  recording when this button is pressed  set setup menu item  145 MODE KEY ENABLE DURING RECORDING to   stop         Jog shuttle transport indicators  These show the playback direction in jog  shuttle  or  variable speed mode      lt   green   Lights during playback in the reverse direction      gt   green   Lights during playback in the forward  dire
345. tem frequency is 50i 50P 25P        M377  OUTPUT LEVEL             Set the reference level for audio output signals    4dB  OdB   3dB   6dB  EBUL    EBUL can be selected only when the system frequency is 50i 50P 25P        Maintenance Menu       M3  OTHERS  Other setting items                         Item Setting   M38  F KEY For details  refer to the Maintenance Manual    CONFIG M380  HOME2 Assign a function menu item to page HOME2 of the function menu as a user   setting    M381  PAGE8 ASSIGN Assign a setup menu item to page P8 of the function menu as a user setting   M382  PAGE8 NAME Specify the name of a setup menu item assigned with M381  PAGE8 ASSIGN   M38F  NV RAM Save the settings of M380 to M382   CONTROL   M39  OTHER M390  MIXED REC Select whether to enable mixed format recording mode    CONFIG DISABLE  Do not enable     ENABLE  Enable        M391  VITC REC    Select whether to record the VITC in the input HDSDI signals in the LTC user bits  area    DIS  Do not record    ENA  Record        M392  PB POS    When you switch between the clip playback screen and the clip list playback  screen  specifies the clip or sub clip playback start position    KEEP  Play from the position where playback stopped    FORCED TOP  Play from the first frame of the first clip or sub clip        M393  AUDIO DSP    Select the function for which the audio digital signal processor shall be used     linear edit  Use for linear editing  microphone input is disabled       AGC limiter  Use for m
346. tems M3B1 and MSB2   enable recording of up to four VANC packets in the selected line  respectively    regardless of the DID SDID value    It is not possible to set the same line with menu items M3BO  M3B1  and M3B2    If the same line is specified  priority is given in the order of M3BO  M3B1  and   M3B2  for example  if the same line is specified with M3BO and M3B1  the   setting with M3B1 is ignored       When VANC data is output to HDSDI playback signals  the number of the  output VANC line is the same as that of the input VANC line      When a UMID or essence mark line is selected with M3B1 or M3B2  UMID or  essence mark output takes priority  To disable UMID or essence mark output   set setup menu item 651 or 657 to  off                     Sub item  1 LINE Selects the lines for the VANC to be received   OFF  9LINE to 20LINE  59 94i 50i 29 97P 25P 23 98P mode   OFF  9LINE to 25LINE  59 94P 50P mode   2 DID Specification of the DID of the VANC to receive  O00h FFh  3 SDID Specification of the SDID of the VANC to receive  00h FFh       M3B1  LINE1 SEL    Selects the lines to be received for the HDSDI VANC data   OFF  9LINE to 20LINE  59 94i 50i 29 97P 25P 23 98P mode   OFF  9LINE to 25LINE  59 94P 50P mode        M3B2  LINE2 SEL       Selects the lines to be received for the HDSDI VANC data   OFF  9LINE to 20LINE  59 94i 50i 29 97P 25P 23 98P mode   OFF  9LINE to 25LINE  59 94P 50P mode           M3C  POWER SAVE CONTROL    Specification of whether to enable the power savi
347. that point are canceled  and the setting operation is  terminated     Setting the timecode to the current time    1 Set RUN MODE on page P5 TC to FREE RUN and  DF NDF to DF  in 59 941 59 94P 29 97P mode only      2 Perform steps 1 to 4 of  Setting an initial timecode  value  to set the timecode to a time slightly ahead of  the current time     3 Press the SET function button  F5  at the instant when  the current time matches the displayed timecode     Setting user bits    You can record up to 8 hexadecimal digits of information   date  time  event number  etc   on the timecode track     Setting Timecode    Select UB by pressing the CNTR SEL function button  F4   in step 1 of  Setting an initial timecode value  and carry  out steps 2 to 5  Settings are made in hexadecimal  0 9   A F     You can record ID codes in user bits     To record timecode that follows  sequentially upon the last recorded  timecode  Internal Regen     You can record timecode so that it is continuous from one  clip to the next on the disc    Set TCG on page P5 TC of the function menu to INT  and  PRST RGN to TC or VITC  When this setting is in force   the unit reads the timecode of the last frame of the last  recorded clip on the disc before starting to record  and  internally generates timecode that follows upon the  recorded timecode    The frame count mode  for system frequency 59 94i   59 94P 29 97P only  is set to the same mode as the last  recorded timecode on the disc  drop frame or non drop   fram
348. the transfer  If  multiple clips are being transferred  a count of the clips  that have been successfully transferred appears    If the remote hostis an XDCAM device  the disc usage  also appears   It does not appear if the remote host is a  computer      If a file of the same name already exists at the  transfer destination   The file name is changed so that it does not conflict  with the file at the destination    The name of the file on the transfer source  this unit   appears in the  Original  field  and the name of the file  on the transfer destination appears in the  Copy   field  P    1  If the clip name is a standard name  it is changed to the unused clip  name with the smallest number   Example  If names C0001 to C0020  are in use  the name  C0021      If the clip name is a user defined name  a serial number is appended  to the clip name   Example  If the name is  EveningNews       EveningNews 1          To cancel the processing   Do one of the following      Select    Abort  Immediately   and then press the  PUSH SET S SEL  knob      If you are transferring multiple clips  select    Abort   After this clip     and then press the PUSH  SET S SEL  knob   The transfer of subsequent clips  will be cancelled after transfer of the current clip  finishes       Set the remote control switch of the unit to LOCAL     When several files are to be transferred  the entire  transfer task is cancelled when the first transfer failure  occurs  Subsequent clips are not transferred   
349. tic interference from  portable communications devices   The use of portable telephones and other communications  devices near this unit can result in malfunctions and  interference with audio and video signals    It is recommended that the portable communications  devices near this unit be powered off        Condensation    If you move the unit from a very cold place to a warm  place  or use it in a damp location  condensation may form  on the optical pickup  Then  if the unit is operated in this  state  recording and playback may not be performed  properly    Do the following to prevent this from happening      When you move or operate the unit in an environment  where condensation may form  be sure to insert a disc in  advance    Whenever you turn on the on standby button  check that  the HUMID indicator does not appear on the color LCD   If it appears  wait until it disappears before inserting a  disc        About the LCD panel    LCD panels are manufactured with extremely high  precision technology that yields effective pixel rates of  99 99  or higher  However  very rarely  one or more  pixels may be permanently dark or permanently lit in  white  red  blue  or green     This phenomenon is not a malfunction  Such pixels have  no effect on the recorded data  and the unit may be used  with confidence even if they are present        Periodic Maintenance       Digital hours meter    The digital hours meter can provide eight items of  information about the operational history
350. timecode input to any of the TIME CODE IN  connector can be selected     To record timecode after setting an initial  value  Internal Preset   Proceed as follows with the function menu  For setting the    timecode  set TCG on page P5 TC of the function menu to  INT and PRST RGN to PRESET                                                                                                           Time data display area  Function menu    Function buttons    Setting an initial timecode value    1 Press the CNTR SEL function button on the HOME  page of the function menu  and select TC     Setting System Frequency   Setting Timecode       suoneiedejgd e je deu    43          suonejedejg e Jajdeyo    44    2 Press the TCG SET function button  F5      The first digit of the time data display starts flashing        3 Press the       or     function button  F1 or F2  to select  a digit to be set     The selected digit starts flashing     I    Use the PUSH SET S SEL  knob or   or   function    button  F3 or F4  to set the value for the selected digit     To set the next most significant digit  10s place   Turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob while holding down  the SHIFT button     Repeat steps 3 and 4 to set all digits that should be set     To set to 00 00 00 00  Press the RESET RETURN button     5 Press the SET function button  F5       If RUN MODE on page P5 TC is set to FREE RUN   the timecode starts running     To cancel a setting   Press the EXIT function button  F6   Any new settings to  
351. tings    dial  dial direct   Press the SHTL JOG or VAR JOG button or  except  during recording editing  turn the jog dial or shuttle dial   key  via search key   Press the SHTL JOG or VAR JOG button        102    MAXIMUM SPEED    Specify the search speed in F FWD F REV mode  forward and reverse   high speed search  and shuttle mode    35 20  F FWD F REV mode   35 times normal speed  Shuttle mode   20  times normal speed   MX 20  EFWD F REV mode  Maximum speed  Shuttle mode   20 times  normal speed   MAX  F FWD F REV mode  Maximum speed  Shuttle mode  maximum  speed    Maximum speed is about  50 times normal speed  However  the  maximum speed may vary depending on the state of the clip and the  playback position on the disc        105    REFERENCE SYSTEM ALARM    Select whether to display a warning when the reference video signal is  not being supplied  or when it differs from this unit s system frequency   off  No warning    on  Flash the STOP button as a warning        107    REC INHIBIT LAMP FLASHING    Select whether to flash the REC INHI indicator when recording is  prevented  see    REC INHI  recording inhibit  indicator   page 22    off  Light the REC INHI indicator   on  Flash the REC INHI indicator        108    AUTO EE SELECT    When a disc is inserted and PB EE on the HOME page of the function  menu is set to  EE   select the operation modes in which input video and  audio signals are automatically handled in E E mode    S F R  stop f fwd f rev   In stop fast forwar
352. to     ENABLE     see page 149      If you want to disable mixing of clips with different  recording formats  leave this item set to    DISABLE      However  regardless of the mixed format recording mode  setting  it is always possible to mix clips in the following  format groups      HD420 HQ  SP  and LP     1080 59 941 and 1080 29 97P     1080 50i and 1080 25P       Preparations for recording    Make the following settings and adjustments before   starting to record    Video input signal selection  Select with V INPUT on  page P1 VIDEO of the function menu    Audio input signal selection  Select with A1 INPUT and  A2 INPUT on page P2 AUDIO  from A3 INPUT to  A8 INPUT on page P3 AUDIO of the function menu     Timecode and user bits settings  See  Setting Timecode    page 43     Selection of time data to display  Select with CNTR SEL  on HOME page of the function menu    Selection of audio channels to monitor  Select with  MONITR R and MONITR L on page P2 AUDIO of  the function menu    Volume adjustment of the monitor audio  Adjust with  the LEVEL knob    Remote local setting  Set the remote control switch  If  you set it to REMOTE  also set setup menu item 214  REMOTE INTERFACE     RM     and the connector  used appear on the system information of the display    see page 133      SD up convert function    You can input SD signals to the SD HDSDI INPUT  connector and record them as HD signals     User data recording    You can record user data  files other than XDCAM AV  file
353. tput  Composite  line 21  output    Ancillary Data       xipueddy    183       Correspondence between  Setting Items of the  HKDV 900 and Setup  Menu of This Unit       Setting item of    Menu item of this unit s setup                                              HKDV 900 menu   HD Master 740  MASTER LEVEL  HD  9   HD Y 741  Y LEVEL  HD  9   HD Pb 742  Pb LEVEL  HD  9   HD Pr 743  Pr LEVEL  HD  9   HD Setup 745  SETUP LEVEL  HD  9   HD Sync Phase  746  SYNC PHASE  HD UC        HD Fine 747  FINE  HD UC  9   D1 Master No menu item corresponds to this setting  item    D1 Y No menu item corresponds to this setting  item    D1 B Y No menu item corresponds to this setting  item    D1 R Y No menu item corresponds to this setting  item    D2 VIDEO 715  VIDEO GAIN CONTROL  DC SD  9   D2 CHROMA 716  CHROMA GAIN CONTROL  DC   SD  9   D2 HUE 717  CHROMA PHASE CONTROL  DC   SD  9   SETUP 718  SETUP LEVEL BLACK LEVEL  HD     DC SD UC  9       SD Sync Phase    719  SYSTEM PHASE SYNC  DC SD                                                              Setting item of   Menu item of this units setup   HKDV 900 menu   H V RATIO 940  H V RATIO  DC    959  H V RATIO  UC  P   GAMMA No menu item corresponds to this setting  item    CROP 930  DOWN CONVERTER MODE   950  UP CONVERTER MODE P   LETTER BOX  930  DOWN CONVERTER MODE   950  UP CONVERTER MODE P   SQUEEZE 930  DOWN CONVERTER MODE   950  UP CONVERTER MODE P             a  The setting becomes effective for the output only when VID  PROC on  pa
354. tr5 6  Tracks 5 and 6 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   tr7 8  Tracks 7 and 8 assigned to audio output channels 1 and 2   2  CH3 CH4 tr1 2  Tracks 1 and 2 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr3 4  Tracks 3 and 4 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr5 6  Tracks 5 and 6 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   tr7 8  Tracks 7 and 8 assigned to audio output channels 3 and 4   831 TS OUT AUDIO MODE P Select the number of output channels for i LINK TS  HDV  signals           4ch  4 channels  2ch  2 channels       Setup Menu       Menu items in the 800s  relating to audio control       Item number  834    Item name  AUDIO INPUT LEVEL       Sub item    Settings  Select the analog audio input source     To display this item on the PDW F1600 or PDW HD1500 with the PDBZ   UPGO 2 Software Upgrade Key installed  set maintenance menu item  M393  AUDIO DSP to    AGC limiter     When maintenance menu item  M393  AUDIO DSP is set to    linear edit   this item is not displayed        CH1    line  Line input  mic  Microphone input          CH2    line  Line input  mic  Microphone input       839    AUDIO AGC LIMITER MODE    For automatic input level adjustments performed on the analog audio   signals recorded on channels 1 and 2  select whether to perform the   adjustments in stereo mode or independently for channels 1 and 2    mono  Perform automatic adjustments independently for channels 1 and  2    stereo  Perform automatic adjustments in stereo mode        To
355. ttle mode directly by turning the dial  set setup  menu item 101 SELECTION FOR SEARCH DIAL   ENABLE to    dial            1  Maximum speed is about  50 times normal speed  However  the  maximum speed may vary depending on the state of the clip and the  playback position on the disc     When setup menu item 101 SELECTION FOR SEARCH  DIAL ENABLE is set to    dial     after using the shuttle dial   return it to the center position  If the shuttle dial is not in  the center position  it is possible occasionally for vibration  from other operations to activate the dial  and start  playback in shuttle mode     Front Panel     4  Display menu control section          RESET RETURN button       MENU button     PUSH SET S SEL  knob  Q Function buttons  F1 to F6       Display         PUSH SET S  SEL                                    m ugs S Sv 8     So _S4i  10422_ 1080 ES  ect 248  5D 50  INEUT    ITC UITCIINI PRESET R RUN  REM  0204    WZ glaz  NZ                   DISPLAY button    SHIFT button  PAGE HOME button    EXPAND button  CHAPTER button               Function buttons  F1 to F6    These buttons are enabled when the function menu  see  page 48  is visible  Each press of a button changes the  setting of the corresponding item in the menu    For convenience  this manual refers to these buttons as  buttons F1 to F6  in order from the top        Display   Displays menus  audio level meters  and data such as time  data or clip information  The DISPLAY button lets you  switch to the
356. ub Item   Lock All Clips Lock all clips   Unlock All Clips Unlock all clips   Delete All Clips Delete all clips        Disc Properties    Display the properties of the currently loaded disc  Or edit the user  disc ID  title 1  and title 2        Format Disc    Format  initialize  the currently loaded disc        Download Clip via Direct FTP    Used to send clip to and from remote devices and remote computers        Settings       Sub Item       SET Key on Thumbnail    Selects the behavior of the unit when the PUSH SET S SEL  knob is  pressed with one thumbnail selected    Cue up  amp  Still  Cue up the selected thumbnail    Cue up  amp  Play  Cue up and play the selected thumbnail        Sort Clip List by       Selects a method to sort the clip list    Name  A Z   Sort in ascending alphabetic order    Date  Newest First   Sort by date and time of creation  newest clip  list first        Sort Planning Metadata  by       Selects a method to sort the planning metadata    Name  A Z   Sort in ascending alphabetic order    Date  Newest First   Sort by date and time of creation  newest  planning metadata first        Display Title    Selects whether to display clip and clip list titles    On  Title1  title1   Display the title in the following order of priority   Title1  Title2  Clip name or Clip list name    On  Title2  title2   Display the title in the following order of priority   Title2  Title1  Clip name or Clip list name    Off  Do not display the title  Always display the cli
357. umbnails provide more  information about the content of the clip than the index  pictures of the first frames  This can also be used to cue up  long clips    This button also becomes a function button  F5  when the  function menu is visible     See page 77 for more information about the chapter  function     Front Panel    21       seq Jo suonounJ pue seweN z Jeideu           Sued Jo suonounJ pue sewen z Jejdeuo    22     5  Recording and playback control section       PREV button    PLAY button     NEXT button  STOP button  REC button    PREV PLAY NEXT STOP          top F REV     FFWD END GSTANDBY GREC ij  Q STANDBY indicator B    Q REC INHI indicator             ea         ileal ail                        PREV  previous  button   Press this button  turning it on  to show the first frame of   the current clip  While the first frame of a clip is shown    pressing this button jumps to the beginning of the previous  clip  D  This button is also used together with other buttons  for the following operations    Reverse direction high speed search  Hold down the  PLAY button  and press this button  A high speed  search in the reverse direction is carried out    Displaying the first frame of the first clip  Hold down  the SHIFT button  and press this button     1  When setup menu item 153 FIND MODE is set to    clip  amp  rec start mark      this button jumps to the frame where the previous Rec Start essence mark  is set and displays the video of that frame        PLAY button   To 
358. unction Menu       suoneiedeJd e 1ejdeuj    49          suonejedejg e Jajdeyo    50             Item Setting   F5  SPEAKER Enables or disables output from this  unit s speaker   OFF  Do not output  ON  Output   F6  LEVEL MT Specifies the position at which to       superimpose audio level meters in the   video monitor screen  in full screen   display mode     OFF  Do not superimpose    LEFT  Superimpose the audio level  meters of 2 channels on the left side    RIGHT  Superimpose the audio level  meters of 2 channels on the right  side    LEFT 4   Superimpose the audio level  meters of 4 channels on the left side    RIGHT 4   Superimpose the audio level  meters of 4 channels on the right  side    LEFT 8   Superimpose the audio level  meters of 8 channels on the left side    RIGHT 8   Superimpose the audio level  meters of 8 channels on the right  side     Item  F6  A8 INPUT          Setting    Selects the audio input signal to assign   to audio channel 8    SDI  Audio signal embedded into SDI  signal   ANALOG2  Analog 2 audio signal   AES EBU4  Signal input to the DIGITAL  AUDIO AES EBU  IN 3 4 connectors       P4 AUDIO page       Item  F1  A5 VOL    Setting    Sets the volume of audio channel 5  9   The volume can be adjusted within the  range from    200 to  200     e to  12 dB   by turning the PUSH SET S SEL  knob        F2  A6 VOL    Sets the volume of audio channel 6  9  The volume can be adjusted within the  range from    200 to  200     e to  12 dB   by turning the PUSH 
359. unction allows you to continue recording to the same clip  until the function is stopped or turned off  regardless of  how many times recording starts and stops  This is  convenient if you want to avoid generating a large number  of short clips  or if you want to record without worrying  about the limit on the number of clips  maximum 300   A  Rec Start essence mark is recorded whenever recording  starts  which makes it easy to find the recording start points   see page 79        A new clip may be created the next time you start  recording if it is impossible to continue recording to the  same clip because of signal noise or some other reason      The Clip Continuous Rec function cannot be enabled  when the Live Logging function is set to Live View  mode        xXoeg e d pue Buipiooeu v 1e deu    To enable the function  Set setup menu item 150 REC MODE to    clip continuous           rec      For details about operation  see  Basic menu operations    page 126      To record   Send a  REC  command from a controlling device   connected to either of the following connectors      REMOTE 9P  connector     SD HDSDI INPUT connector  Put the unit into HDSDI  remote control mode      To stop recording  Send a  REC PAUSE  command   To stop the function    Recording 57          yoeghe q pue BuipiooeH p 1e1deuo    58    Do one of the following to stop the Clip Continuous Rec   function   A new clip will be generated the next time you   start recording       Perform a clip operation  lock
360. ut data that complies with  the EIA 708 608 standard  output to EE    However  settings are required for EE output of closed  caption data in HDSDI signals     For details  see  To record and playback EIA 708 B  standard closed caption data in HDSDI signals    page 176  or  To record EIA 608 B standard closed  caption data in HDSDI signals   page 178          HDSDI  VANC  input  EIA 708 608    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  input           Closed caption data in SDSDI line 21 signals are output to  EE  output as SDSDI or composite signals   regardless of  menu settings     EE output of closed caption data in HDSDI signals is  delayed by 1 frame with respect to EE output of the video  signals     HDSDI  VANC  output  EIA 708 608          EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  output  Composite  line 21  output    Internal processing by this unit    Optional functions    By installing the PDBZ UPG02 Software Upgrade Key in  this unit  you can expand the unit s closed caption data  conversion functions     Recording and playback after EIA 608   708 conversion  and down convert playback    In response to closed caption input data that complies with  the EIA 608 standard  record  play and output that data  after conversion to EIA 708 format  By performing down  convert playback  you can also play and output EIA 608  standard closed caption data     EIA 608     708  conversion    EIA 608  SDSDI  line 21  input    EIA 708 recording  and playback    Ke  Down convert playback       However  settings are 
361. utomatically  E E  output is not cross converted     Playback    SD up convert function    By installing the PDBK S1500 option  you can output HD  while playing discs recorded as SD     HD down convert function    You can always output SD while playing discs recorded as  HD     To specify the frame to use as the  thumbnail image    You can display a list of thumbnails of all clips on a disc   and use it to check the recorded content  see page 76    When the unit is shipped from the factory  it is set up to  display the first frame of each clip as the thumbnail  As  required  you can select another frame to display as the  thumbnail    For example  if there are several seconds of color bars  recorded at the start of the clip  selecting a frame several  seconds after the end of the recording of color bars can  make it easier to identify the clip     The GUI screen allows you to select thumbnail frames  while viewing the video     For details  see  Changing clip index pictures   page 81      You can also use setup menu item 143 INDEX PICTURE  POSITION to specify a different default frame  You can  specify the initial frame in any of the first few seconds  after the initial frame  The setting range is 0 seconds to 10  seconds        Playback operation    This section describes the following types of playback    Normal playback  Playback at normal speed   Playback in jog mode  Variable speed playback  with the  speed determined by the speed of turning the jog dial   Playback in sh
362. uttle mode  Variable speed playback  with  the speed determined by the angular position of the  shuttle dial   Playback in variable speed mode  Variable speed  playback  with the speed finely determined by the  angular position of the shuttle dial    Normal playback    First insert a disc     For details of how to insert a disc  see  Loading and  unloading a disc   page 53                                                                        access                            SE ARAR    7d                  PREV button      PLAY button      NEXT button      STOP button      Jog dial   Q Shuttle dial       MARK1 button and    MARK2 button             To start playback   Press the PLAY button    Playback starts    When two or more clips are recorded on the disc  they are  played back continuously     No audio is output when non audio signals are played  back     To jump to the next or previous clip  then start  playback   Use the PREV button  NEXT button  jog dial  or shuttle  dial     To stop playback   Press the STOP button    If you play back to the end of the last clip  playback  automatically stops    If  in this state  you press the PLAY button  the message     Disc End   appears on the display    To carry out playback again  move back to the desired clip  using the PREV button  jog dial or shuttle dial     To set shot marks   While playing back a disc  you can set essence marks such  as Shot Mark1 and Shot Mark2 in desired frames    To set a Shot Markl or Shot Mark2  hold
363. when the equipment is  operated in a commercial environment  This equipment  generates  uses  and can radiate radio frequency energy and   if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction  manual  may cause harmful interference to radio  communications  Operation of this equipment in a residential  area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the  user will be required to correct the interference at his own  expense     You are cautioned that any changes or modifications not  expressly approved in this manual could void your authority to  operate this equipment     All interface cables used to connect peripherals must be  shielded in order to comply with the limits for a digital device  pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of FCC Rules     This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules  Operation  is subject to the following two conditions   1  this device may  not cause harmful interference  and  2  this device must  accept any interference received  including interference that  may cause undesired operation     For customers in Canada  This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES   003     3    4    For the customers in Europe   This product with the CE marking complies with the EMC  Directive issued by the Commission of the European  Community    Compliance with this directive implies conformity to the  following European standards    e EN55103 1  Electromagnetic Interference Emission      EN55103 2  Electromagnetic Susceptibility Im
364. with the settings of F1   TCG  and F2  PRST RGN  in function menu page 5    assemble  amp  insert  Whether local or remote and regardless of the  settings of F1  TCG  and F2  PRST RGN  in function menu page 5   the time code generator regenerates according to the time code  played back from the disc           611    TC OUTPUT PHASE IN EE MODE    Select the timecode output mode for output from the TIME CODE OUT   connector in E E mode    thru  through   Output the timecode input to the TIME CODE IN  connector as it is    v in  video input phase   Output the timecode with the same phase as  the input video signal phase    v out  video output phase   Output the timecode with the same phase  as the output video signal phase           612    TC OUTPUT MUTING IN SEARCH  MODE    Select whether to suppress the output from the TIME CODE OUT  connector in jog shuttle mode    on  Suppress    off  Do not suppress        618    UPCONV EMBEDDED VITC 9    Select the source of the VITC embedded into output HDSDI when up  converting during playback of SD discs    VITC  Select the VITC of the SD disc    LTC  Select the LTC of the SD disc        619    vitc 9    Select whether to record the VITC generated by the internal timecode  generator during IMX recording    off  Do not record the internally generated VITC    on  Record the internally generated VITC     Even if this item is set to    off     VITC is recorded if the input video signal  contains VITC and the VITC line is set to  thru  in me
365. work device is being accessed  In  this state  operation from the front panel is not  possible    LOCAL  Enables operation from the front panel    REMOTE  Enables remote control of this unit from the  following devices      Devices connected to the REMOTE 9P  connector  on the rear panel     Devices connected to the SD HDSDI INPUT  connector with SDI remote control functions     Devices connected to the  amp  i LINK  S400  connector   Use setup menu item 214 REMOTE INTERFACE to   select which of the connectors is used for remote control    see page 133      See  Setup Menu  on page 123 for more information  about how to make extended menu settings        KEY INHI switch   This turns key operation inhibit mode on or off   Use setup menu item 118 KEY INHIBIT SWITCH  EFFECTIVE AREA to specify the keys to inhibit     Q PHONES jack   The jack is a standard stereo jack  Connect stereo  headphones to monitor the audio during recording   playback  and editing   Non audio signals are muted   The  monitored channel is selected with MONITR L and  MONITR R on page P2 AUDIO of the function menu  see  page 49      Q LEVEL  volume  adjustment knob   Adjust the volume of headphones or speakers with the  knob  You can also cause this to simultaneously adjust the  output volume from the AUDIO MONITORR L  connectors on the rear panel  To do this  set setup menu    item 114 AUDIO MONITOR OUTPUT LEVEL to    var          Disc slot and EJECT button  Insert a disc in the disc slot  To remove the dis
366. x  PASV  lt CRLF gt     TYPE  Specifies the type of data to be transferred   Command syntax  TYPE   SP     type code  options  delimited by  lt SP gt   gt    CRLF       lt type code gt  can be any of the following  However  for  XDCAM  data is always transferred as  T   regardless of  the type code specification     A  ASCII    N  Non print    T  Telnet format    C  ASA Carriage Control    E  EBCDIC    N  Non print    T  Telnet format    C  ASA Carriage Control       IMAGE  Binary   default     L  LOCAL BYTE    SIZE  byte size    Input example  TYPE      STRU  Specifies the data structure   Command syntax  STRU   SP    lt structure code gt    lt CRLF gt      lt structure code gt  can be any of the following  However   for XDCAM  the structure is always    F     regardless of the  structure code specification      F  File structure  default      R  Record structure     P  Page structure    FTP File Operations    Input example  STRU F    MODE  Specifies the transfer mode   Command syntax  MODE   SP    lt mode code gt   lt CRLF gt      lt mode code gt  can be any of the following  However  for  XDCAM  the mode is always  S   regardless of the mode   code specification      S  Stream mode  default      B  Block mode     C  Compressed mode    Input example  MODE S    LIST  Sends a list of files from this unit to the remote computer   Command syntax  LIST   SP     options     SP     path   name    lt CRLF gt       options   can be any of the following      a  Also display file name
367. xpressly prohibits the duplication of any  portion of this manual or the use thereof for any purpose  other than the operation or maintenance of the equipment  described in this manual without the express written  permission of Sony Corporation     PDW F1600 sony Corporation    PDW HD1500 Printed in Japan   SYL  http   www sony net  2010 03 32  3 282 295 07  1  Printed on recycled paper      2008    
368. you  want to select  Then  with the SHIFT button held down   turn the PUSH SET S SEL  knob    To cancel the multiple selection  move the selection frame  without the SHIFT button held down     Clip  Navigating sibling relati     018 036          M    TC 00 29 19 23 TC 00 29 38 25 TC 00 29 50 04 TC 00 30 25 11       8  TC 00 30 40 13  01 28   09 43  TC 00 24 24 29    TC 00 24 34 27 TC 00 24 46 22 TC 00 25 42 08 TC 00 25 49 07  DATE amp TIME 30 NOV 2005 14 14 pun 0 23 22 26             Searching with thumbnails    By using the thumbnails that appear in the various  thumbnail screens  you can easily cue up and play clips  and sub clips     Using thumbnails to find clips    The clip thumbnail screen displays thumbnails of all clips  recorded on the disc  You can use this screen to cue up the  selected clip and to carry out playback  see page 79      See  Selecting thumbnails   page 76  for more  information     Using the expand function to find scenes    The expand function allows you to divide a selected clip  into equally sized blocks  and to display thumbnails of the    first frame in each block  This is a quick and efficient way  to review the selected clip and search for target scenes   You can specify 12  144  or 1728 divisions     RK Sears  i y T  pss pos pos  us   Ly    The maximum number of blocks may be other than 1728  when the recorded duration of the clip is short  In this case   the frame interval of expanded thumbnails is fixed at 1  frame  This allows you to view 
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
8 Conectar la estación base  Philips MCM330 User's Manual  MANUEL D`INSTRUCTIONS POUR AFFICHEURS SÉRIE  Descargar Manual del Usuario  5 - SEW-Eurodrive  Brenthaven Edge II Jet Black Sleeve  Radio receivers type DB317 and DBR1-M4 User manual  JBL HTI88 Subwoofer  StarTech.com 1394-46-15 firewire cable  iRP4100    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file